AP Statistics Teacher Guide
AP Statistics Teacher Guide
AP Statistics Teacher Guide
AP Statistics
Teachers Guide
Michael Legacy
Greenhill School
Addison, Texas
2008 The College Board. All rights reserved. College Board, Advanced Placement Program, AP,
AP Central, AP Vertical Teams, connect to college success, Pre-AP, SAT, and the acorn logo are registered
trademarks of the College Board. AP Potential is a trademark owned by the College Board. PSAT/NMSQT is
a registered trademark of the College Board and National Merit Scholarship Corporation. All other products
and services mentioned herein may be trademarks of their respective owners. Permission to use copyrighted
College Board materials may be requested online at: www.collegeboard.com/inquiry/cbpermit.html. Visit
the College Board on the Web: www.collegeboard.com.
ii
About AP Statistics
Contents
Welcome Letter from the College Board.............................................................v
Equity and Access....................................................................................................vii
Participating in the AP Course Audit................................................................xi
Preface . .......................................................................................................................xii
Chapter 1. About AP Statistics..................................................................................1
Overview: Past, Present, Future.............................................................................................. 1
Course Description Essentials................................................................................................. 4
Key Concepts and Skills .......................................................................................................... 6
iii
About AP Statistics
Chapter 1Letter
Welcome
AP teachers are paying off, producing ever greater numbers of college-bound seniors who are prepared
to succeed in college. Please accept my admiration and congratulations for all that you are doing and
achieving.
Sincerely,
Marcia Wilbur
Executive Director, Curriculum and Content Development
Advanced Placement Program
vi
About AP Statistics
1. Andrea Venezia, Michael W. Kirst, and Anthony L. Antonio, Betraying the College Dream: How Disconnected K12 and Postsecondary
Education Systems Undermine Student Aspirations (Palo Alto, Calif.: The Bridge Project, 2003): 8.
2. Frank Levy and Richard J. Murnane, Education and the Changing Job Market. Educational Leadership 62(2) (October 2004): 83.
3. In addition to studies from University of CaliforniaBerkeley and the National Center for Educational Accountability (2005), see the
classic study on the subject of rigor and college persistence: Clifford Adelman, Answers in the Tool Box: Academic Intensity, Attendance
Patterns, and Bachelors Degree Attainment (Washington, D.C.: U.S. Department of Education, 1999).
4. Advanced Placement Report to the Nation (New York: College Board, 2005).
5. Wayne Camara, College Persistence, Graduation, and Remediation, College Board Research Notes (RN-19) (New York: College Board,
2003).
vii
Chapterand
Equity
1 Access
1. Student motivation
Many potentially successful AP students would never enroll if the decision were left to their own initiative.
They may not have peers who value rigorous academics, or they may have had prior academic experiences
that damaged their confidence or belief in their college potential. They may simply lack an understanding
of the benefits that such courses can offer them. Accordingly, it is essential that we not gauge a students
motivation to take AP until that student has had the opportunity to understand the advantagesnot just
the challengesof such course work.
Educators committed to equity provide all of a schools students with an understanding of the
benefits of rigorous curricula. Such educators conduct student assemblies and/or presentations to parents
that clearly describe the advantages of taking an AP course and outline the work expected of students.
Perhaps most important, they have one-on-one conversations with the students in which advantages and
expectations are placed side by side. These educators realize that many students, lacking confidence in
their abilities, will be listening for any indication that they should not take an AP course. Accordingly,
such educators, while frankly describing the amount of homework to be anticipated, also offer words of
encouragement and support, assuring the students that if they are willing to do the work, they are wanted
in the course.
The College Board has created a free online tool, AP Potential , to help educators reach out to
students who previously might not have been considered for participation in an AP course. Drawing
viii
About
EquityAP
and
Statistics
Access
upon data based on correlations between student performance on specific sections of the PSAT/NMSQT
and performance on specific AP Exams, AP Potential generates rosters of students at your school who
have a strong likelihood of success in a particular AP course. Schools nationwide have successfully
enrolled many more students in AP than ever before by using these rosters to help students (and their
parents) see themselves as having potential to succeed in college-level studies. For more information, visit
http://appotential.collegeboard.com.
Actively recruiting students for AP and sustaining enrollment can also be enhanced by offering
incentives for both students and teachers. While the College Board does not formally endorse any one
incentive for boosting AP participation, we encourage school administrators to develop policies that will
best serve an overarching goal to expand participation and improve performance in AP courses. When
such incentives are implemented, educators should ensure that quality verification measures such as the
AP Exam are embedded in the program so that courses are rigorous enough to merit the added benefits.
Many schools offer the following incentives for students who enroll in AP:
Chapterand
Equity
1 Access
AP teachers discretion
Standardized test scores
Course-specific entrance exam or essay
Additionally, schools should be wary of the following concerns regarding the misuse of AP:
About AP Statistics
Purpose
College Board member schools at both the secondary and college levels requested an annual AP Course
Audit in order to provide teachers and administrators with clear guidelines on curricular and resource
requirements that must be in place for AP courses and to help colleges and universities better interpret
secondary school courses marked AP on students transcripts.
The AP Course Audit form identifies common, essential elements of effective college courses, including
subject matter and classroom resources such as college-level textbooks and laboratory equipment. Schools
and individual teachers will continue to develop their own curricula for AP courses they offerthe
AP Course Audit will simply ask them to indicate inclusion of these elements in their AP syllabi or
describe how their courses nonetheless deliver college-level course content.
AP Exam performance is not factored into the AP Course Audit. A program that audited only those
schools with seemingly unsatisfactory exam performance might cause some schools to limit access to
AP courses and exams. In addition, because AP Exams are taken and exam grades reported after college
admissions decisions are already made, AP course participation has become a relevant factor in the college
admissions process. On the AP Course Audit form, teachers and administrators attest that their course
includes elements commonly taught in effective college courses. Colleges and universities reviewing
students transcripts can thus be reasonably assured that courses labeled AP provide an appropriate level
and range of college-level course content, along with the classroom resources to best deliver that content.
xi
Chapter 1
Preface
Welcome! You are about to undertake a truly wonderful adventure. As an AP Statistics teacher, you stand
at the beginning of a dynamic and exciting experience. Your students will analyze data using calculators
and computers, conduct classroom experiments, and perform individual and group projects, making the
AP course much different from the statistics course(s) you and I might have taken during our collegiate
career. Your students will be active and engaged learners, and you will be right in the thick of it. It may
seem a challenging task at times, but this guide and the broader statistics community are here to help you
get your feet on the ground.
This course is the equivalent of a one-semester, introductory, noncalculus-based college course in statistics.
Most students who take AP Statistics will also take college courses in the physical, biological, and social
sciences, and the AP course will provide an excellent foundation for subsequent college work.
The purpose of this Teachers Guide is to help new teachers prepare for and teach an AP Statistics course,
as well as to offer more experienced instructors some fresh ideas to enliven their courses. I have tried to
anticipate and answer many of your questions and to point you to various resources that your colleagues
have found helpful. Scattered throughout the guide you will also find advice from other AP Statistics
teachers who generously share what they have learned.
Chapter 1 begins with an overview by Kenneth Koehler from Iowa State University, chair of the AP
Statistics Development Committee. His perspective on the role of AP Statistics and his insights about
teaching the subject provide an excellent orientation to the course. Following the overview, you will find
a description of what is included in the AP Statistics Course Description and a discussion of key concepts
and skills that students should learn. The chapter closes with a free-response problem from the 2005 exam
that highlights the connections between the Topic Outline and the AP Exam questions.
Chapter 2 contains a plethora of advice about getting started, with topics such as recruiting students,
communicating with parents and colleagues, choosing a textbook, connecting with the broader statistics
community, and using AP Centrala Web site that contains and links to many essential resources, such
as the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group. The chapter concludes with three detailed examples of
data analysis that are in the spirit of, but perhaps more extensive than, the investigative-type activities that
students might be expected to encounter during the course.
Chapter 3 contains advice and guidance for creating your own syllabus. Eight sample syllabi from
experienced statistics instructors (six high school teachers and two college statisticians) are included. I
encourage you to read all of the syllabi, even those where the primary textbook differs from your own.
Each has many gems to offerideas and tips for teaching tough concepts, activities, projects, and favorite
AP Exam questions for review.
The AP Statistics Exam is the focus of chapter 4. Here you will find more advice from experienced teachers,
as well as strategies for preparing your students for the exam. Finally, chapter 5 lists additional resources
for teaching AP Statisticsbooks, videos, useful Web sites, suggested reading for the postAP Exam
period, statistical software, and references for your professional library.
xii
About AP Statistics
Preface
Teaching statistics can be a very rewarding and exhilarating experience. It is a class in which you should
always expect the unexpected, so you will need to stay on your toes. To understand everything from
medicine to politics to sports, a citizen today must be statistically literate. You will never have to ask
yourself, Do my students really need to know this?
In closing, I would like to offer my heartfelt thanks and recognition to the people who have contributed
to this edition of the AP Statistics Teachers Guide. The instructors who shared their syllabi represent
an impressive level of expertise and wisdom in teaching this course. The members of the AP Statistics
Development Committee, who gave generously of their time and talent, offering comments on my early
drafts, have markedly improved the book. Ellen Chien, during the time she worked at Educational Testing
Service (ETS), was stellar in helping shepherd this guide to a timely completion. Finally, I must express my
gratitude to Jeff Haberstroh of ETS for his guidance and support over the years. The success of AP Statistics
is due in no small part to his behind-the-scenes dedication, work, and organization.
Michael Legacy
Michael Legacy is a teacher of AP Statistics and the K12 math department chair at Greenhill School
in Addison, Texas. He has served the AP community as a member of the AP Statistics Development
Committee and as an AP Reader and Table Leader. He is also a frequent presenter at College Board
conferences and AP Summer Institutes. Michael was statistics content editor for the Texas series Laying
the Foundation: Connecting to AP Mathematics, funded by the ODonnell Foundation (Dallas), and a 2005
recipient of the Special Recognition Award from the College Board Southwestern Region for contributions
to the AP Program.
xiii
Chapter 1
About AP Statistics
Overview: Past, Present, Future
The AP Statistics curriculum provides a modern introduction to working with data and statistical
reasoning. It is equivalent to that found in the best college courses, with respect to the development of
basic probability concepts for modeling randomness, collection and exploration of data, application of
statistical reasoning in decision making, and emphasis on effective communication. Statistics, the science
of gathering and interpreting data, is an essential part of most fields of science and many business and
government activities. In addition to helping prepare students for advanced study and challenging careers,
the ability to critically evaluate information has valuable lifelong benefits for making decisions about
important personal issues such as diet, health care, and investments.
Recognizing its central importance, many colleges have made statistics a part of their general education
requirements. Although some university students take their first statistics course within a statistics or
mathematics department, many others receive their introduction to the subject through courses offered by
programs in business, engineering, education, or one of the physical, biological, behavioral, environmental,
or social sciences. The uses of statistics are quite varied, but they are all based on a fundamental set of
concepts and procedures for gathering data, summarizing information, and making decisions in the face of
uncertainty. The AP Statistics curriculum was developed from these fundamental concepts and procedures
after many years of careful consideration by experienced college and secondary school statistics teachers.
AP Statistics emphasizes working with data to investigate questions of interest to students. The
course makes use of mathematical concepts taught in algebra and geometry courses to quantify random
variability, provide formulas for probabilities, and model relationships between measured quantitiesbut
this is only one aspect of the curriculum. The broader emphasis is on clearly defining the questions to be
investigated, gathering and organizing data, producing informative graphical and numerical summaries,
modeling relationships, making decisions while accounting for uncertainty in the data, and clearly
communicating results in the context of a study. Course projects may be developed from data students
collect to investigate their own life experiences, data collected for other courses, or articles in the popular
press. There are endless possibilities, including environmental issues, effectiveness of nutrition and exercise
programs, medical studies, sports, marketing claims, trends in support for education, political opinion
polls, and so on. This is what makes the course fun and exciting.
Whether it is taught in college or as an AP class, the first course in statistics is generally a very
challenging one for both students and teachers. Do not be misled by the lack of a calculus requirement.
The combination of talents demanded by this course provides significant challenges. For many students,
this may be the first time they are required to integrate skills in communication, mathematics, data
organization, computation, graphics, and inductive reasoning. They must also deal with precise use
of statistical terminology that is based on words that can have quite different meanings in everyday
language. Furthermore, there are often no exactly correct or incorrect solutions. Different approaches to
Chapter 1
analyzing the same data may reveal different insights, none of which is completely right or completely
wrong, although some approaches may be more informative than others with respect to the objectives
of a particular study. Providing students with meaningful learning experiences in making decisions and
carefully communicating results, in addition to teaching basic statistical concepts and procedures, is a tall
order, and there is no substitute for careful preparation.
About AP Statistics
The AP Curriculum
The Topic Outline in the 2009, 2010 AP Statistics Course Description gathers the components of a modern
introduction to statistics into four major categories, the introductory headings of which are reproduced
here. The percentages in parentheses for each content area indicate the coverage of that area in the AP
Statistics Exam.
I. Exploring Data: Describing patterns and departures from patterns (20%30%)
Exploratory analysis of data makes use of graphical and numerical techniques to study patterns and
departures from patterns. Emphasis should be placed on interpreting information from graphical and
numerical displays and summaries.
II. Sampling and Experimentation: Planning and conducting a study (10%15%)
Data must be collected according to a well-developed plan if valid information on a conjecture is to be
obtained. This plan includes clarifying the question and deciding upon a method of data collection
and analysis.
III. Anticipating Patterns: Exploring random phenomena using probability and simulation (20%30%)
Probability is the tool used for anticipating what the distribution of data should look like under a given
model.
IV. Statistical Inference: Estimating population parameters and testing hypotheses (30%40%)
Statistical inference guides the selection of appropriate models.
Chapter 1
We are living in a rapidly changing information age that places great value on the ability to collect,
process, and evaluate data and to make decisions in the face of random uncertainty. AP Statistics teachers
have an exciting opportunity to help students begin to acquire the essential skills to successfully deal with
the challenges this age imposes on higher education and career development and to become informed
citizens and effective, lifelong learners.
Kenneth J. Koehler
Chair, AP Statistics Development Committee
Iowa State University, Ames
As you read the Course Description, keep in mind the following points:
Do not be tempted to go straight to the Topic Outline. It is important that you not skip over the
introduction, the purpose, and the goals of the course. These statements and the content overview
provide a structure and perspective that are the heart and soul of the course.
About AP Statistics
The list of formulas and tables of values in the Course Description will be furnished to the students
taking the exam. You will want to provide copies for students to use throughout the course. It might
be helpful to print these out on different colored papers so that students can retrieve them easily from
their notebooks. Some teachers also have laminated sets that students use for their tests during the year.
Compare the Topic Outline to the table of contents of your textbook. The outline is organized
thematically, whereas your textbook may have some other organizational approach. For example,
some teachers start the year with sampling and experimental design even though most texts start
with data analysis.
Students are expected to use technological tools throughout the course. This essentially means graphing
calculators with statistical capabilities and computers. Students should have a graphing calculator at
all times during the year as well as for the exam itself. Read carefully the statement on technology in
the Course Description, especially the final paragraphs on acceptable calculators and unacceptable
enhancements to such calculators. For example, adding text to the calculator that gives information
about the necessary conditions for inference or steps to execute some statistical process is forbidden.
Although computers are fundamental tools of modern data analysis, it may not be possible for
your students to gain much experience with them owing to competition for this limited resource in
many schools. Recognizing this, it is critical that students have experience reading and interpreting
standard computer output that might be provided on the exam. Several examples of this type of
output are found among the multiple-choice and free-response questions in the Course Description.
In addition, most introductory textbooks written for this course have many examples and exercises
that use computer output from standard statistical packages such as Minitab , Data Desk , JMP, or
their student versions. Students are not necessarily required to understand every single part of the
computer output (more output is sometimes given than is needed for the question), but they must be
able to pick out, understand, and interpret those components that pertain to the subjects included in
the Topic Outline. A salient point here is that most computer output is quite generic. The component
parts of the various packages are easily recognizable to knowledgeable readers, and the individual
differences are minor. This should be reassuring to students, as they can be confident that they will
be able to interpret any computer output presented to them. Using different examples of output will
help your students recognize the similarities among the commonly used software packages.
The Topic Outline in the Course Description gives the scope of the coverage of the course. Although
a good textbook will be your primary source of instruction and information, you will want to look
for ways to enrich your course with outside resources, such as online applets and demonstrations,
statistical news articles, videos, and data-gathering activities. Many of these supplemental sources are
outlined in chapters 2 and 5 of this guide and are mentioned in the sample syllabi in chapter 3. Also,
you will want to gather a variety of statistics textbooks to use as resources for additional examples
and explanations.
As a supplement to the Course Description, read the Statistics Course Perspective by Chris Olsen.
This can be found on the AP Statistics Course Home Page (apcentral.collegeboard.com/stats) under
AP Statistics Course Information.
The study of statistics blends the rigor, calculations, and deductive thinking of mathematics; the real-world
examples and problems of the social sciences; the decision-making needs of business and medicine; and the
laboratory method and experimental procedures of the natural sciences. Teaching AP Statisticspreparing
motivational lessons with real examples of how statistics are used in practice, directing laboratory-type
activities, designing experiments and surveys, helping students with the necessary technology, and, last
but not least, thoroughly understanding statistics yourselfmay require more preparation than any other
course you have taught. These multidisciplinary aspects and applications of statistics are what eventually
should make it the most rewarding of the courses you teach.
Chapter 1
About AP Statistics
Collection of Data: Sampling and Experimentation
For many teachers, this can be one of the most challenging units to teach. It is vocabulary-intensive
and involves ideas that most students find difficult to grasp immediately. It also means that you as the
teacher must do a lot of advance preparation: this is no place to wing it. The terminology alone may
be new for the first-time teacher of the course: treatments, control groups, experimental units, blinding,
randomization, bias, placebo, and the concepts of replication, blocking, and confounding, among
others. Make sure you understand the terms and their relevance in the scheme of things. This cannot be
emphasized enough. If you are unsure, your students will be so as well. Some teachers in their first year or
two of teaching this course have become more comfortable with the terminology by practicing lessons out
loud before standing in front of the class.
One thing you might find helpful is to read the appropriate chapters from several textbooks. Note that
the terminology is not completely standardized. Different books may use slightly different terms. This is
okay since the focus in the course and on the exam is on understanding the underlying concepts. Also
look at the scope of the experimental design questions on the AP Exam. Before you teach this unit, it
might be instructive to actually go through all of the sampling and design questions on recent AP Exams
(available at AP Central), write up your solution to each, carefully read the model answer given in the
scoring guidelines, and then grade your work based on those standards. This exercise will help you review
important concepts and vocabulary essential to the topic.
Give your students lots of opportunities to write about designs. Draw problems from different sources,
such as those listed in the Supplementary Textbooks section in chapter 5 of this Teachers Guide.
Students should understand that for valid statistical analyses of data, the method of data collection is
critical. The way the data are collected will largely determine the subsequent analysis methodology; hence,
careful attention should be given to this aspect of the study. The main issue should be how we can best
answer the question at hand. The data collection method is especially important, for example, for survey
questions in the social sciences. A survey consisting of vague or poorly worded questions will be difficult to
interpret. The introduction of bias, in a myriad of forms, may derail any possible conclusions. Meaningful
generalizations from samples to populations can only occur by virtue of an appropriate random sampling
plan. Students should be able to describe a good random sampling plan or a randomization method in the
case of experimentation. They should also be aware of the differences between observational studies and
experiments, specifically with respect to the possibility of tentatively identifying a causal relation between
variables and to the scope of any possible inferences that can be drawn from the data. In general, students
should be able to plan a study in light of these considerations, as well as analyze and interpret such a
study, recognize any limitations on the scope of inference, and offer constructive criticism, such as ways to
improve the study.
Representation of Data
Numerical and graphical representations of data are the starting point for both descriptive and inferential
statistical analysis. To get information from data, it has to be organized in ways that allow a researcher
to ask questions of interest to her or him. Whether data result from observations of individual subjects,
from experimentation, or possibly from a simulation, the center, variability, shape of the distribution, and
unusual or interesting features of data are of fundamental importance. As well as providing information
about the distribution of data values, simple pictures of data can also uncover measurement errors,
provide reality checks on assumptions about populations, and suggest possible avenues for future analysis.
Students should be able to represent data in a variety of forms, describe data distributions both graphically
and numerically, make comparisons among distributions, use the data to check conditions necessary for
inference, and draw conclusions.
Chapter 1
Probability
Probability, the mathematics of chance and variability, provides foundational ideas such as events,
independence, and probability distributions, as well as a mathematical language for communicating these
ideas in the AP Statistics course. An understanding of simulations, sampling distributions as probability
distributions, and statistics as random variables, together with a basic knowledge of the algebra of random
variables, provides a conceptually solid foundation to answer questions such as, Why do we add variances,
and why does it matter?, and How often would I get results like this if I used this method many times?
An examination of the syllabi presented in chapter 3 will clearly indicate that this is not a probability
course. What students do need is a working vocabulary that allows active classroom discussion of statistical
ideas based on the underpinning probabilistic principles. Probability calculations are an essential element
of statistical inference procedures. Since samples are subject to random variability, probability provides us
with a way to quantify that variability and identify meaningful differences. For example, suppose you have
two equal groups of surgery patients, with one group receiving the standard postsurgical care and the other
group, a new postsurgical regimen. Suppose also that the difference in mean lengths of time it takes the
two groups to recover from the surgery is markedly different. What is the probability that, owing simply
to the random assignment of the patients, the difference in the mean lengths of recovery time for the two
groups could be so large? In other words, what is the probability that, if the two treatments were equally
effective, we would see a difference as large, or larger, than this one? This is called the P-value. Students
must not only know how to calculate the P-value for an inference test but must also be able to interpret this
value in the context of the problem.
Statistical Inference
Statistical inference is the central focus of the course. The successful student should have a firm grasp of
the nature and logic of statistical inference as it unfolds in observational studies and experiments, from
planning to P-value. Random sampling provides the basis for generalizing ones findings beyond the
sampledata at hand to the population of interest. Proper experimental design is a tool for controlling
extraneous variables and reducing the ambiguities of experimental results. The formal inferential
techniques of confidence intervals and hypothesis testing, the main methods for drawing conclusions
abouta population from sample data, lead to the assessment of the statistical significance of the study or
experiment. Students must master the mechanics of choosing an appropriate inference method and
computing the numerical values (either by hand or with a calculator), but more importantly, they should
beable to communicate and interpret those results to a reader in a coherent conclusion.
About AP Statistics
Rural
2
3
2334
3
4
4
5
56667
02224
56889
1
Stem: tens
Leaf: ones
(a) Write a few sentences comparing the distribution of the daily caloric intake of ninth-grade students
in the rural high school with the distribution of the daily caloric intake of ninth-grade students in
the urban high school.
(b) Is it reasonable to generalize the findings of this study to all rural and urban ninth-grade students
in the United States? Explain.
(c) Researchers who want to conduct a similar study are debating which of the following two plans
to use.
Plan I: Have each student in the study record all of the food he or she consumed in one day. Then
researchers would compute the number of calories of food consumed per kilogram of body weight
for each student for that day.
Plan II: Have each student in the study record all of the food he or she consumed over the same
7-day period (one week). Then researchers would compute the average daily number of calories of
food consumed per kilogram of body weight for each student during that 7-day period.
Assuming that the students keep accurate records, which plan, I or II, would better meet the goal of the
study? Justify your answer.
Chapter 1
Commentary
This problem asks students to compare the caloric intake for a random sample of 20 students from one
rural high school with a random sample of 20 students from one urban high school. The variable measured
was the number of calories per kilogram of body weight consumed in one day by each student. A back-toback stemplot displayed the calories/kg consumed for each student on one day.
In part (a), students are asked to compare the distributions from both schools. Referring back to the key
concepts above, this is representation of data. The response should include a clear, correct, comparative
statement for each of the three characteristics: shape, center (position), and spread. Comparative language
must be used: for example, the median daily caloric intake of ninth-grade students in the rural school is
higher than the median caloric intake for those in the urban school. Just making a list of the appropriate
numbers for each distribution is insufficient to answer the question.
In part (b), students are asked whether it is reasonable to generalize the findings of the study to all
rural and urban ninth-grade students in the United States. Here the question is getting at elements from
collection of data: the design of the study and the generalizability of the results. The response should
clearly indicate that generalizing is not appropriate, because only one rural school and one urban school
were used. The sampling unit was the school, not the subjects chosen for the study or the area from which
the subjects were selected.
In part (c), students are presented with two possible sampling plans in consideration of a similar study.
Plan I uses only one day; plan II uses a 7-day period with a 7-day average computed for the number of
calories consumed by each student. Students are directed to choose the more appropriate plan and justify
their choice. The student should indicate that plan II will better meet the goal of the study because it
accounts for the effect of day-to-day variability and provides a more precise estimate of the average daily
intake. A correct justification would indicate an understanding of what might cause systematic day-today variability in the difference between rural and urban students in the number of calories consumed on
different days of the week (different amounts of calories consumed on a weekday versus a weekend day,
for example). A student response that simply says that 7 days are better than one day is insufficient for
justification.
As you look back over this question and response, please note several important details.
The question draws from several parts of the coursedata analysis and sampling design, in
particular. This is characteristic of the integrative nature of many AP Statistics Exam questions. One
part of a question might be about describing data, and another part might use the same data for
conducting an inference procedure. One part may relate to inference and another part to sampling
design. A question may start with a straightforward probability calculation that eventually takes the
student through the binomial distribution and ends with a part about sampling distributions.
There is not much in the way of computation. Students have calculators to help them, so most of the
credit they can earn for a problem goes beyond the ability to correctly compute. Brilliant arithmetic
will not overcome bad analysis and poor communication, but good analysis and communication can
usually overcome errors in arithmetic.
Communication is critical (much more about this in chapter 4). Note that the question asks students
to explain and justify their choices. It is not sufficient to just write down the choice of plan II. To
receive full credit, students must explain or justify in a direct comparison why this is a better choice
than plan I.
10
About AP Statistics
The purpose of this chapter has been to explain what the AP Statistics course consists of, how it is reflected
in the AP Exam, and the general conceptual skills it is expected to develop in students. This information
has been assembled with broad strokes, giving a comprehensive view of where you are headed. The next
chapter concentrates on specifics, with detailed advice on resources for new AP teachers, administrative
issues, personal preparation for teaching, and data analysis models.
11
Chapter 2
Advice for AP Statistics
Teachers
This chapter is devoted to providing a wide range of practical advice as you prepare to teach AP Statistics.
It covers such concerns as the support needed from your school administration; recruitment of students;
how to work with colleagues and parents; personal preparation for teaching the course; help provided for
the new teacher by the College Board; and some model activities for your classroom. Do not be discouraged
by the length of this chapter; it is long because there are many different aspects to consider in managing the
course and dozens of ways to craft a successful learning vehicle. There is no single right way to teach this
class. Remember also that the acquisition of resources, the improvement of your knowledge base, and your
increased comfort level in teaching the course are long-term efforts. Think of this as a journey: you are
about to take your first steps down a road that has been, for me, a most enjoyable trip.
Statistics, more than any other mathematical discipline, uses data gathered in other fields: the natural,
biological, and social sciences; business, health, and politics; and even the humanities. In addition,
the concepts and methods of statistics are used in many other disciplines to understand processes
and make decisions. This state of affairs is reflected in todays high school curriculum. Teachers of
history, psychology, and other social science courses utilize graphic presentations of data, and natural
science courses engage students in the techniques and reporting of laboratory experiments, frequently
analyzing experimental data. AP Statistics develops a systematic overview of the subject, showing how
data exploration, data production, and probability all come together in the weaving of sound inferential
arguments. Laboratory scientists may teach that part of statistics that is the most useful in their discipline,
whereas social scientists may teach a different subset. No single group of users of statistics is inclined to
teach the larger picture of statistical reasoning and how the various techniques used by different disciplines
fit into it. Teachers of statistics can provide that conceptual overview.
13
Chapter 2
1
Recruiting Students
In accordance with the College Boards Equity and Access policy (see page vii at the beginning of this
guide), students taking AP Statistics should reflect the diversity of the overall school population. The
College Board discourages gatekeeping by screening students based on test scores only. AP courses are
not just for the smartest and most able students in the school. A highly motivated student who shows a
commitment to excellence should be strongly considered for admittance to an AP class. A challenging,
engaging, and rigorous class can many times inspire a student to achieve at a high level. The goal of
breaking down the barriers to broaden participation in the AP Program is both laudable and achievable.
As an AP Statistics instructor, you will need to decide on the criteria for admission to your class. It
is not easy for any teacher to make the decision that a student is mature enough, both mathematically
and developmentally, for the rigors of college-level work. In the AP Statistics class, students will need to
understand some concepts whose presentation is necessarily in a mathematical form and be able to follow
and participate in discussions of these concepts. This requires more than just an algorithmic knowledge
of the mathematics. The mathematically mature statistics student must be able to let the actual formulas
14
Involving Parents
Our school has a long and successful involvement with AP courses, and students parents and guardians
are comfortable with the policies we have set. It is important nonetheless that there be open and ongoing
communication with families. Maintaining a strong relationship with parents and guardians is extremely
beneficial to the students overall success.
At the start of the school year, I post a Topic Outline and course goals on the schools Web site.
Additionally, I discuss the course and my expectations at our Meet the Teacher Night in September.
During this time, I explain that this is not a typical math course. Students will be expected not only to
deal with computations but to evaluate and communicate results in written formnot something they
have likely experienced in previous math courses. I include several free-response questions to illustrate the
level of analysis that will be required. I have also seen brochures that other statistics teachers have prepared
and then used both to recruit students for the class and also to send home at the beginning of the year as
an informational flyer.
15
Chapter 2
1
Several years ago I went to our college counseling office and selected a dozen course catalogs from
schools that our students typically attend. In about an hour, I had a list of a significant number of college
majors that required at least one course in statistics as part of the degree program. I have this available for
attendees at the Back to School Night, as well as for students who are interested in taking the course. It is
also critical that you talk to your school counselors. It is to your advantage to make them allies and help
them to better understand your course and what type of students would most benefit from enrolling.
A simple way to enlist parental support might be to prepare a brief description of important topics over
the next three to five weeks, a summary of upcoming due dates for projects or outside work to be turned
in, and a calendar of daily assignments. This could easily be posted on the schools Web site or sent out
via regular mail. If you can do this every three weeks, or even every six weeks, it keeps the folks on the
homefront in the loop. Parents are encouraged to contact me if they have questions about the program or
concerns about their childs progress.
At my school, teachers write comments on the students three times a year (the midterm marking
period in each twelve-week trimester). This is an arduous task, but it gives me an opportunity to inform
parents about how their child is doing, to provide an overview of material that we are studying or will
study, and to remind them of important deadlines for projects, unit tests, reviews, and the trimester exams.
Although your school may not expect such extensive student commentary and parental communication,
I think that staying in touch with families is an essential part of making your program successful. Getting
parents and guardians to buy into your program and helping them to understand what is expected of their
child in an AP class means that you will have more support at home and there will be fewer surprises if the
going gets difficult.
16
Textbooks
The single most important decision you will make as you approach the teaching of AP Statistics is your
choice of a textbook. The AP Statistics teacher must choose a text that contains appropriate content for
the course, fits comfortably with modern technology, and is at a suitable reading and mathematical level.
If you are new to the teaching of the subject, you should seek the counsel of experienced AP Statistics
instructors, as well as university and college teachers actively involved in statistics education. The
AP Statistics community has many experienced high school teachers, as well as a gratifying number
of professors of statistics and professional statisticians who have been and will continue to be extremely
helpful as you negotiate the shoals of textbook selection. (See chapter 5, Resources for Teachers, for a
comprehensive review of the most often cited textbooks.) The AP Statistics Course Home Page
(apcentral.collegeboard.com/stats) also contains up-to-date reviews of statistics textbooks, as well as other
resources. Further valuable textbook advice may be solicited from experienced teachers of AP Statistics via
the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group (EDG). Information about joining the EDG can be found
later in this chapter.
Although you will rely on your primary textbook, you should also try to build a repository of
supplementary materials. I encourage you to maintain a collection of textbooks for reference. The extra
examples and different approaches that various authors provide can be valuable as you review course
content and plan your lessons. Whereas statistics textbooks are published at particular points in time, the
resources for an AP Statistics class are as timely and up-to-date as newspapers, newsmagazines, books,
and scientific journals. Increasingly, newspapers are reporting insightfully on health, social concerns, and
scientific issues; they are also including references to their sources (for example, in todays issue of the
New England Journal of Medicine . . .). Many of these sources have an online presence, and more detailed
information than is reported in the newspapers may be found on their Web sites. Chapter 5 lists some of
17
Chapter 2
1
the resources that might be used to supplement the textbook. Classroom activities can also be enhanced by
a range of contemporary educational materials, including videotapes and DVDs, computer- and Web-based
instructional materials, CD-ROMs, and calculator-based measuring devices. Many textbooks targeted for
AP Statistics also have extensive teacher-support materials to accompany the text, both in printed form and
on the publishers Web sites.
18
An Applet a Day
The graphing calculator is an excellent tool for statistical calculations needed in the AP Statistics course. However,
for visualizations and discovery two online applet resources that have become invaluable are Online Statistics
(www.onlinestatbook.com) and the Rossman/Chance Applet Collection (www.rossmanchance.com/applets).
The first site is totally interactive, with exercises and examples for students. Students not only choose an
answer to a question but are expected to explain the answer. Solutions are provided. The simulations are
wonderful, and students can truly see the central limit theorem come alive in their own creations. The full range
of topics from any introductory statistics book is covered on this site.
The second site gives students a variety of ways to sample, using pennies or Reeses Pieces, to name just
two. Students really enjoy watching the candy machine select the colors. The interactivity allows students to
change parameters and sample sizes, which truly facilitates the discovery approach to learning. Students can
access these sites on their home computers, which is an added benefit when lab time is not available.
Robin Levine-Wissing, Glenbrook North High School,
Northbrook, Illinois
Personal Preparation
Generally, effective preparation for teaching AP Statistics consists of a four-part strategy. The first step
is to assess your own knowledge of statistics and make a plan to fill in the gaps. The second part is to
acquaint yourself with the information available about how to teach introductory statistics, which includes
fascinating research on how students think about and learn probability and statistics. The third element
is to begin to collect the material that you will use in the classroom. The final component is to find ways
to communicate with and stay connected to other teachers of introductory statistics so that you can keep
abreast of new developments in statistics education and share what you have learned. The sections below
contain suggestions about how to accomplish all this, from me and other teachers who have been there.
19
Chapter 2
1
One of the best ways to learn how to think statistically is to study examples of how great statisticians
analyze data. Good examples are readily available and can be found on some of the Web pages already
mentioned, as well as in Chatterjee et al., A Casebook for a First Course in Statistics and Data Analysis; Peck
et al., Statistics: A Guide to the Unknown; Chance magazine; and the Statistics: Decisions Through Data
videotapes developed by the Consortium for Mathematics and Its Applications (see chapter 5 for
full citations).
Getting Yourself Ready
As you prepare to teach this course, you may find, as I did, that some areas are very familiar and others much
less so. Concentrate on your weaker points. If you have forgotten certain topics, take a class if necessary. At
least work through your textbook before you teach it. Better yet, go to a one-week AP Summer Institute prior to
teaching the course. Seek recommendations from colleagues about which ones they have attended and found
useful.
It is equally important to become part of a network of AP Statistics teachers. You dont want to go it alone.
A local group of AP Statistics instructors may already exist; if not, you can create a support group to help each
other during the year. Here in North Carolina, we formed the MCSTATS (Mecklenburg County Stats) group,
which met once a month and shared information on pacing, activities, tests, and so forth. Experienced teachers
can help you get through the first year or two. A local university may also have at least one instructor who is
willing to provide some much-appreciated academic insight into content and concepts. Through the work of
David Royster, with support from Rich Lambert, we have an AP Statistics evening several times a year at the
University of North CarolinaCharlotte. Finally, be sure to join the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group
(EDG). Even as a lurker, you will find the messages informative. A searching of the EDG archives will yield
many sources of information.
There are incredible options for teaching this course in terms of textbooks, technology, projects, and activities. It
may feel overwhelming during your first couple of years. Research as much as you can, with the understanding
that there is not one perfect choice. If you have taught another AP course (for example, AP Calculus), know that
this is a very different experience. Although that might be initially unnerving, it is also exciting.
Sheila McGrail, Charlotte Country Day School,
Charlotte, North Carolina
20
Gather Materials
Good statistics teaching is as much an attitude as a set of skills. Statistics, more than any other
mathematical discipline, transcends its theoretical base to serve other scientific disciplines. As John
Tukey, the legendary statistician, remarked, one of the best things about statistics is that one gets to play in
everybody elses backyard. A teacher of statistics is constantly alert to how data may be and are collected
and used in all the backyards in the neighborhood. You will find that teaching an AP Statistics course
changes the way you look at the world.
Experienced statistics teachers have file folders containing examples they have gathered from
newspapers, magazines, television, and electronic and online sources. Begin your own collection. Opinion
polls are routinely reported in newspapers, as well as reports about scientific experiments of public and
personal interest. Frequently these reports contain references to their sources, many of which are available
online with expanded information. Make one file folder for each of the items listed in the AP Statistics
Topic Outline. Each time you come across an example in the newspaper, on television, or in a book, or hear
a good idea from a colleague, put it in the appropriate folder.
The Mathematics Teacher, familiar to all members of the National Council of Teachers of Mathematics,
often has articles on teaching statistics. The American Statistician, a publication of the American Statistical
Association, frequently contains articles accessible to the teacher of introductory statistics, especially in
the Teachers Corner section. STATS and Chance are two other excellent sources of articles. Another very
good resource is the Journal of Statistics Education (see chapter 5 for full descriptions of these publications).
When you find data that might interest your students, place that article in the appropriate file. You
should also have a folder for possible student projects and ideas on how to organize such projects. When
constructing lessons or problems of interest to your students, your cache of data, newspaper reports, and
journal articles will be priceless! A word of warning: your collection of file folders can easily turn into a
complete file cabinet as sources are discovered, located, and revisited. Be sure to cull outdated sources
and reverify URLs. Also, make it a habit to record the bibliographic information for articles when you
cut them out.
21
Chapter 2
1
Data Sources
Need data? No problem! Students enjoy collecting information about themselves. Its easy, fun, and readily
available. Here are some suggestions:
Categorical Data
Elementary school attended
Eye color
Favorite food
Favorite music genre
Favorite subject or class
Greatest fear
Worst-tasting food
Univariate Data
Amount of money in pocket or purse
Height in inches
Number of letters in name
Number of minutes spent talking with parents or guardians in a day
Number of people in family
Number of phone numbers saved in cell phone
Shoe size by gender
Time it takes to get ready for school
Time spent on last nights homework
Time spent on the computer in an average week
Time spent watching television in an average week
Weight of backpack (use the nurses scale)
Bivariate Data
Height versus shoe size
Height versus wingspan
Resting pulse rate versus number of hours spent working out per week
Time on quiz versus grade
Penny Smeltzer, Westwood High School,
Austin, Texas
Mathematics instructors who teach statistics sometimes feel isolated, in that they are frequently the
only one in the department teaching this subject. This isolation can be easily alleviated! Although you may
be the only teacher of statistics, you are not the only user of statistics in a high school. You will find that
your colleagues in the sciences, social sciences, economics, physical education, and health fields use data in
their teaching but very often do not analyze it with any sophistication. Ask them to collect data from their
laboratory experiments and have them describe the statistics that students need to know in order to analyze
those experiments. Ask to borrow a lab manual so you can see the kind of data that are collected. Teaching
is easier when it is collaborative!
22
The Teaching Resource Materials and Teaching Resource Reviews sections on the Statistics Course
Home Page include articles written by teachers in the field. For example, one outstanding resource
in this list is the AP Statistics Web Guide by Ruth Carver and Susan Peters. This excellent
compilation is organized by the AP Topic Outline, with linkable interactive Web sites, lesson
plans, and activities developed by statistics teachers.
23
Chapter 2
1
Free-response questions and scoring guidelines for past AP Exams, as well as a complete Practice
Exam available as a free download to teachers whose syllabi have been approved in the Course Audit
process.
A link to the College Board Store, which features a variety of print materials, including Released
Exams and specialized modules for particular units of study, such as sampling and experimentation.
24
25
Chapter 2
1
and the correct response was red. The other group was also presented with colors, but the printed words
did not match the color of the word. For example, the word red might be printed in blue, the word brown
printed in green, and so on. The task of the subjects in this second group was also to name the color of the
word, ignoring the word itself. That is, if the word green was printed in blue, the subject should correctly
respond with blue.
The experiment was designed to investigate the theory that reading is so automatic in adults that the
subjects reading would interfere with the correct identification of the color. If this theory of interference is
correct, the subjects presented with the colors matching the words should correctly identify the color of the
word faster. The data from this experiment are reproduced below. Each student in both of the experimental
groups was presented with 100 words. For each word, the student continued to respond until the correct
color was identified and then moved on to the next word. The total time in seconds to name the color of all
100 words is recorded for each student. Times have been rounded to the nearest second.
Times for the Two Experimental Groups
Different color
40
45
90
69
75
59
102
78
21
86
Same color
37
33
45
43
53
37
47
53
40
An initial look at graphical displays of these data suggests that the reading is consistent with the theory
of interference with the identification of the colors.
Times with Different Colors
1 02
03
50 04
9 05
9 06
85 07
6 08
0 09
2 10
The above back-to-back stemplot shows that the time measurements produced from the presentation
where the colors matched the words were consistently smaller than when the colors and words did not
match. The median time for correctly identifying 100 colors when the color matched the word (43 seconds)
26
27
Chapter 2
1
must first check the conditions necessary for the confidence interval procedures to be valid. It is important
that students check all relevant conditions before conducting any inference procedure. Do the conditions exist
that justify our choice of a particular inference procedure? A good discussion of assumptions versus conditions
can be found in an article by Dave Bock on the AP Statistics Home Page under Teaching Resource Materials:
Is That an Assumption or a Condition?
What conditions must be verified to construct a confidence interval to estimate the difference in two
means?
Independent samples are randomly drawn from two distinct populations, or the two groups are
In general, the underlying populations should be normally distributed. This matters most for small
samples. If n is small, say less than 30, the observed data should not show extreme skewness, and
there should not be any outliers.
Check: The dotplots constructed previously do not suggest asymmetry in either underlying
population, and there do not appear to be any outliers present. (One could look at the stemplots
as well.)
An alternative approach is to construct a normal probability plot for each treatment. This plot graphs
each data value against its corresponding z-score in the distribution. These are not easy to do by
hand, so it is expected that students will use their calculators to construct the plots.
If the distributions of the data are approximately normal, the resulting plot will be roughly linear.
We can see in the plots below that this appears to be the case for the Stroop data.
28
Thus, it appears that the t procedure for two independent samples is appropriate.
s1 2
n1
s2 2
n2
The 95 percent confidence interval for estimating the difference in the two population means (different
minus same color treatments) is: 5.03 PD PS 41.74 with df = 10.56. Most students will likely do their
work for this type of problem using the statistical test on their calculator and read the above df value from
the calculator, whereas others will do their work by hand and use the degrees of freedom based on 1 minus
the smaller sample size minus 1 (df = 8). This latter value is a bit conservative in that it tends to produce
an interval with slightly higher than desired coverage probability. (Note that the interval was obtained by
using the nonpooled option on the calculator, which is valid whether or not the population variances are
equal. The pooled option is a special version of the two-sample t statistic that assumes the two populations
have the same variance. The best advice for comparing two means is, dont!)
We are 95 percent confident that the interval from 5.03 to 41.74 seconds captures the true difference in
mean times to correctly identify the color of the word in 100 repetitions. The construction of a confidence
interval should always have an accompanying interpretation of the resulting values.
Notice that zero lies outside the confidence interval. From this we conclude that the difference in the
mean times produced from presenting the colors with the correct verbal description and the mean times
produced from presenting the colors with the incorrect verbal description differ significantly. In fact, the
95 percent confidence interval gives us a set of plausible values for those differences. If zero had been in the
interval, it is plausible that there is no meaningful difference between the two populations. There would be
insufficient evidence to conclude that a difference actually existed. It is important for students to understand
that failure to conclude a difference exists is NOT confirmation that the two groups are the same!
In summary, it seems that the investigators were correct in their conjecture that the dissonant word/
color treatment produces times that tend to be greater than those produced by the consistent word/color
treatment. The subjects were college psychology students, and they were randomly assigned to the two
treatments. Thus, it appears that for the psychology students who participated in this experiment, the
differences in the times are reliably different. If the college psychology students can be regarded as a
random sample from the adult populationa proposition that is by no means obviousit may be that
these results would generalize to the adult population.
29
Chapter 2
1
30
As a starting point, lets consider a linear model. The Minitab output below represents the fitting of a
simple linear model to the data.
The regression equation is
Weight = -358 + 5.45 Length
Predictor
Constant
Length
Coef
358.16
5.4549
SE Coef
52.77
0.5552
T
6.79
9.82
P
0.000
0.000
SS
390653
93087
483740
MS
390653
4047
F
96.52
P
0.000
There is more information in the computer output than an AP student is responsible for knowing. It is
important for a student to be able to sift through the output and find the relevant numerical values.
31
Chapter 2
1
An examination of the residual plot (below) shows that there is a pattern in the residuals. Such a curved
pattern indicates that a linear model is not likely to be the best fit for these data.
There are many possible transformations that might improve the model, and most textbooks give
strategies for making a good choice. In this example, we will concentrate on the use of logarithms to
straighten the data. This is something that is particularly helpful to my students, since straightening data is
something they do in physics, when they gather data for motion down an incline.
The scope of the AP Statistics course limits itself to the linearization of data. The course does not address
fitting quadratic, cubic, quartic, or logistic models to data. You might consider looking at these during any
postexam time you have.
There are several reasonable methods we might try to straighten the datataking the log of the
response variable, taking the log of the explanatory variable, or taking the log of both variables. It
sometimes takes a bit of trial and error to come up with a best-fitting model. This process involves taking
the log of a variable (we could use either common or natural logs) and examining the resulting scatterplot
for linearity and the residual plot for no pattern.
After some trial and error, we will take the natural log of the response variable, weight. An
examination of the resulting scatterplot for the transformed data indicates a more linear relationship
between length and ln(weight).
32
The residual plot above indicates that this model is a better fit. There does not appear to be a readily
apparent pattern in these residuals, as there was in the residual plot for the original model.
33
Chapter 2
1
Important Notes
1. The residual plots in computer output often differ from those that are normally created on the
calculator. Computer software is likely to plot the residuals against the fitted (predicted) values from
the model, whereas most calculators will plot the residuals against the original or transformed xvalues. The reason for this difference is that the computer software assumes a multivariable analysis
is being carried out, whereas the calculator assumes a simple linear regression. In a simple linear
regression, calculator plots of the residual versus x and the residual versus y-hat give the student
equivalent information; this is not so in a multiple regression. Be sure to point this out to students.
2. On the AP Exam, it is not expected that students will be doing as much calculator-intensive
transformation work as this problem implies. A more typical scenario might present a problem
situation with one or more possible models to fit the data and accompanying computer output and
plots. Students would be expected to work with the given models to answer questions. It would not
be unusual if they were asked to decide which model is the most appropriate to use to answer the
question and then to justify their choice of model.
3. Most current textbooks include a fair amount of computer output. Students should be able to read
and interpret a variety of output from different software packages. Make sure they are exposed to
such during the year.
After the transformation, the Minitab regression for the alligator problem is given below.
The regression equation is
ln(weight) = 1.49 + 0.0341 Length
Predictor
Constant
Length
Coef
1.4854
0.034111
SE Coef
0.1369
0.001441
T
10.85
23.68
P
0.000
0.000
SS
15.276
0.627
15.903
MS
15.276
0.027
F
560.51
P
0.000
If we choose to adopt this model using ln(weight) and length, we would test hypotheses and construct
confidence intervals using the transformed model. However, we are more likely to use the model to
predictthe weight of an alligator based on its length. It is important to note that students do not need to
back-transform the model; however, they will be expected to be able to back-transform any predictions into
the original scale.
For example, using the transformed model of ln(weight )
an alligator that is 90 inches in length.
n)
ln(weight
n)
ln(weight
n
weight
n
w
eight
34
1.49 0.0341(90)
4.559
e 4.559
95.49 pounds
35
Chapter 2
1
Students should be able to discuss assigning subjects by various randomization methods: a random
number table, drawing numbers or names from a hat, or flipping a number cube or coin, for example.
The important feature is that the chance of being assigned to each treatment group is the same for each
participant.
Why is randomization important in this experiment? Why not just let the subjects choose to which
group they will belong? Without random assignment of the plantar fasciitis patients to the two exercises,
it is possible that the two treatment groups could differ in some way that affects the outcome of the
experiment. For example, suppose the patients in one of the treatment groups knew each other and shared
a similar work environment. Their company decides to install carpeting throughout the workplace,
replacing the hard surfaces that had previously existed. If all these workers were in the same treatment
group, the researchers would not know if the reduction in reported pain is attributable to the treatment
or to the carpet installation. Any observed difference in the results for the two exercise groups would be
confounded with the effects of installing the carpet. Randomization is insurance against any such pattern,
whether we are aware of it or not.
The control group for comparison purposes in this experiment is the standard treatment of the
Achilles stretch. Should there be an additional do-nothing (placebo) group? The addition of such a placebo
group would enable researchers to determine if either type of exercise had more benefit than no exercise.
No placebo group is necessary for this experiment. The objective is only to determine whether the new
treatment is better than the current one. The burden of proving efficacy is common in medical trials, and
to gain approval one must always show that the proposed new treatment is better than the standard one.
Is blinding possible in this experiment? It is not possible to blind the participants, as they are being
directed to perform one of the stretches. The evaluators of the results should not know which participant
was assigned to which treatment group, so that their conclusions are not biased in favor of one of the
treatments.
To what population might any results be generalized? Suppose we found that the plantar fascia stretch
was more effective than the Achilles stretch. If we truly have a random sample of all plantar fasciitis
sufferers, then the results of this experiment could be generalized to that group. If, on the other hand, the
random sample came from athletes, then the results of this experiment do not directly apply to nurses or
teachers, for example, because they were not part of the experiment.
What inference procedures can be conducted?
Researchers often wish to examine the difference between populations with regard to the proportion
falling into a particular response category. Typically, observational studies draw independent random
samples from two distinct populations, e.g., males versus females, or smokers versus nonsmokers. On the
other hand, if we were to sample husbands versus wives, there is little reason to believe that whatever
we might measure about these two populations is unrelated. In experiments, the process of random
allocation yields the two groups. In the plantar fasciitis example, the populations are the hypothetical
populations of those who could have been given the treatment; they are represented by the two treatment
groups generated by the randomized comparative experiment. Can it be concluded that the new stretching
procedure was better at increasing mobility in sufferers of plantar fasciitis, or could any difference in the
two groups be attributed to the natural variation that exists among sample statistics? This question calls
for a hypothesis test.
The parameter of interest in our study is the true difference in the proportions of plantar fasciitis
patients in the two treatment groups who had increased mobility in the foot.
36
Independent samples are randomly drawn from two populations or are generated by a random
comparative experiment.
Condition check: While we are told that the patients were randomly selected, the key element in
an experiment is that some randomization process is used to create the two independent treatment
groups. In this case, we are told that subjects were randomly assigned to either the Achilles stretch
group or the plantar fascia stretch group.
If the data are sampled without replacement, the sample should not exceed 10 percent of the
population.
Condition check: We do not know the size of the population of plantar fasciitis sufferers from which
the sample was drawn. However, our inference would be valid if that population size were to exceed
1,200, which is a reasonable assumption.
Both groups are big enough that at least 5 successes and 5 failures are observed in each.
Condition check: In the plantar fascia stretch group there were 52 successes and 8 failures, and in
the Achilles stretch group there were 44 successes and 16 failures.
Different books use slightly different conditionssome use 10 or 15 instead of 5. What is important is
that the student checks some value.
The sample statistic p1 p2 (the difference between the sample proportions) estimates the parameter
p1 p2 (the difference between the population proportions). To find the standard error, we assume that the
null hypothesis is true so that p1 p2 pc , the combined estimate of the common population proportion,
success1 success2
and calculate pc
.
n1 n2
52 44
60 60
p1 p2 ( p1 p2 )
pc (1 pc ) pc (1 pc )
n1
n2
96
120
0.80
1.835
37
Chapter 2
1
How rare is this value? Could a difference this large have happened by random chance? What is the
probability of getting a value at least as extreme as z = 1.835 if there really is no difference between the two
treatments (that is, the null hypothesis is true)? This is called the P-value.
For this situation, the P-value = p(z > 1.835) = 0.0333. If there really was no difference between the
proportion of subjects in the Achilles stretch group and the proportion of subjects in the plantar fascia
stretch group who experienced increased mobility, we would have observed a difference at least this large
only about 3 percent of the time. If our decision rule were to reject the null hypothesis if the difference
could have occurred by random chance less than 5 percent of the time (that is, the Type I error is .05),
we would state that there is enough evidence to conclude that the plantar fascia stretch was effective in
significantly increasing mobility. If we had set a criterion to reject if the difference could have occurred by
chance less than 1 percent of the time, we would have failed to reject the null hypothesis. In this instance
we would not conclude that the plantar fascia stretch was effective in significantly increasing mobility.
Suppose the question was, How much actual difference is there between the proportions of plantar
fasciitis patients in the two treatment groups who experienced increased mobility; that is, what is the gap
between the two population proportions? We could estimate that difference with a confidence interval.
A 98 percent confidence interval for estimating the difference in the above experiment is given by
(0.034, 0.301). Note that while 0 lies within the interval, there are other plausible values for the difference
in population proportions in addition to zero.
Caution: Failing to reject the null hypothesis does not mean that the two stretch methods are the same.
We are just unable to conclude that a difference exists. To many students, this is confusing. Hypothesis
procedures are used to assess the evidence against the null hypothesis, not to assess the evidence in support
of it. Failure to find evidence against the null hypothesis does not prove the null hypothesis to be true.
You will also need to help students understand how to write their conclusions. They seem to have more
trouble stating a conclusion when they fail to reject a null hypothesis. In the nonrejection case, students should
avoid phrases such as accept the null or retain the null when writing their conclusion. Examine past AP
Exam problems and browse several textbooks to see various ways that correct conclusions can be written.
Some textbooks have analogized conducting a hypothesis test to a jury trial. Finding a defendant not
guilty does not necessarily mean that the defendant is innocent. The evidence just was not strong enough
to get a conviction. Using the jury analogy in class can be very beneficial as an introduction to the idea of
a significance test. This analogy can also be used to illustrate Type I and Type II errors, the consequences
of such errors, power, and even the initial assumption that the null hypothesis is true (presumption of
innocence).
Now that weve looked at how to start up your AP Statistics course, and how to prepare to teach this
challenging subject, lets turn to the question of developing a syllabus. In the next chapter Ill give some
tips on course organization, and eight experienced statistics instructors will share their syllabi and offer
suggestions for teaching strategies, grading policies, helpful resources, and student activities that you might
consider for your own classroom.
38
Chapter 3
Course Organization
Syllabus Development
No single AP Statistics course would be appropriate for all students and all learning environments. Some
teachers will have well-prepared, engaged, highly motivated students; a new textbook; and lots of resources,
including a computer lab. In other years and other schools, the situation may be a bit less rosy. That is
why this chapter aims to teach by example. One of the best ways to approach creating your own syllabus
is to see what other instructors have done in a wide range of circumstances. That is the purpose of the
eight sample syllabi presented in this chapter. In the meantime, some general guidelines to help you in the
creation and refinement of your own course syllabus are presented below.
Setting Expectations
This is a college-level course with demanding content. Students should be prepared from the outset to work
hard so that there are no surprises down the road. They need to be dedicated and to work conscientiously
outside of class. I tell my students to expect a minimum of 30 to 40 minutes of homework each night. In
addition to daily class work, they are responsible for the AP problem sets that I have assembled (which
consist of two to three previous AP Exam questions to be completed and turned in each week), as well as
several long-term projects.
Course Planner
When developing your syllabus, you should read the AP Statistics Course Description carefully. Keep it, as
well as your textbook, close at hand while you are planning. Its also important to make sure the syllabus
meets the AP Statistics Curricular Requirements: go to apcentral.collegeboard.com/courseaudit for
information on submitting your syllabus for audit review.
Once you have read the Topic Outline in the Course Description, reviewed the table of contents of your
textbook, checked the curricular requirements on AP Central, and read through the various syllabi in this
chapter, it is time to tackle the arrangement of your own academic year. Ample review time is necessary
prior to the AP Exam in May. You might want to look at your plan in reverse; that is, using your school
calendar and the date of the exam, plan backward from that time. For example, because our school is on
trimesters, I look at the year in thirds. I make a grid of 12 weeks on a page and map it out by textbook
sections, with the last segment ending approximately a week prior to the AP Exam. After accounting for
school holidays, trimester exam periods, and the ever-present special school event schedules, I work my
way back to the beginning of the year. Included in my grid are lesson days, test days, review days, computer
days (it is a struggle to get the lab), and several data-gathering days.
You may need to make allowances for the fact that certain sections of your textbook require more time
than others. Different items in the Topic Outline take varying amounts of time. In some lessons I may
39
Chapter 3
1
be able to check two items off the list in a day, but others may take a week. I may actually spend less time
reviewing than other instructors do, because my students have already received a great deal of practice with
AP free-response questions throughout the year. If you are a new teacher of this course, I would suggest
aiming for two weeks of review, if possible.
During this review time I tend to concentrate on sample multiple-choice questions and some of
the more challenging investigative tasks. I also give students one of the AP Statistics Released Exams to
complete and score (giving them insight into the scoring process as well as putting them in the examtaking environment). It is important for them to see a complete set of multiple-choice questions and realize
that this section emphasizes concepts over computation. There is a marked difference between the 1997
and 2002 Released Exams. The advent of calculators with statistical capabilities has changed the nature of
many of the questions, and most of the calculator-driven multiple-choice questions on the 1997 exam had
been eliminated by 2002. The latter exam is much more representative of what students should expect to
see each May. The 2007 exam has now been released, and a complete Statistics Practice Exam is available
on AP Central to teachers whose syllabi have been approved in the Course Audit process, providing more
problems for you to use.
Working with previous AP Exam questions throughout the year and discussing the scoring guidelines
communicates the level of preparedness that will be expected on the exam. It also emphasizes that success
is not derived from calculations alone. Justifying procedures and interpreting results in a math class will be
a new experience for many students. Give them lots of practice. Have them strive for clarity in their writing
as well. Reviewing the model solutions in the published scoring commentaries is always instructive for
students. It is helpful to give some of these old problems as timed-writing exercises.
First Things First
As I designed my syllabus, I knew I wanted to include a minimum of one data-centered activity each week
(such as comparing the dexterity of students left and right hands, or determining how many candies must be
sampled before finding a green one), so I made that a priority in planning what to teach and when. Inspiration
for activities came from statistics books, the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group, and suggestions
from experienced teachers. The next task was to convince my district to provide funds to buy supplies for the
activities, such as Barbie dolls from thrift stores, multicolored candy, duct tape, dried beans, dice, cards, ice
cream, and inflatable beach balls that looked like the earth. Finally, it was time to map out the course. With
the aid of a school calendar and textbook, I blocked out two weeks of review time at the end of the year and
allowed for school activities and vacations. The remaining instructional days were budgeted by the amount of
emphasis each topic was given in the AP Course Descriptionbut I made sure there was at least one datafocused exercise each week. Flexibility in planning a syllabus is essential, however, so after each years AP
Exam I analyze my students strengths and weaknesses and adjust instructional days accordingly.
Joyce Smart, Logan High School,
Logan, Utah
You will also need to decide how much of a role the calculator will play in your classroom. You
will want to include some calculator-based activities, which are useful for data exploration, conducting
simulations, and easing the tedium of excessive arithmetic. However, do not let students use the calculator
as a shortcut or an excuse for not showing their work! When working with probabilities, z values, and
t values, it is a good idea to switch back and forth between using the calculators built-in probability
distributions (found with the calculator keystrokes 2nd DISTR) and using the tables available for the
AP Exam (tables A, B, and C in the Formulas and Tables section of the Course Description). Students
should have facility with both approaches, but some may have a decided preference. The pitfalls of using
calculator-speak are discussed in chapter 4.
40
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
As you read the sample syllabi in this chapter, search the Web, visit the AP Statistics Course Home
Page, and go to workshops, you will undoubtedly come across many interesting and exciting activities that
you will want to try, but as a new teacher of the course you may need to exercise some restraint. Your first
responsibility is to complete the course in a timely fashion. Some of these activities might be better left to
subsequent years when you have the course content under your belt and a better notion of pacing. Rarely
do we get the timing exactly right the first year.
Student Projects
Many teachers of introductory statistics say that student projects are an indispensable part of their course.
A student project is one in which a student or a group of students define a problem, collect data on that
problem, analyze their dataincluding the use of appropriate graphical displaysand write a report on
their conclusions or present an oral report to the class. Try to incorporate such projects into your plans.
Until students get their hands dirty, many may not appreciate the fine points of doing research that
involves the collection and analysis of data. Letting your students wrestle with data they have gathered
themselves can be very instructive and makes the course more personal. You might consider doing one
simple project each semester during the first year and expanding after that. Remember that you will have
to grade projects and still keep up with the current material. To keep from being overwhelmed by the
grading, one new teacher who had a very large class assigned a project in which students were required
to work with a partner. The students still benefited from collecting and analyzing data, but the teachers
grading workload was cut in half. The debates students have with each other when developing a report are
also highly effective learning experiences.
Projects can be short or can require many weeks to complete. You will find many examples of projects
in the Student Activities sections of the sample syllabi presented in this chapter. A number of projects are
described in the 2002 AP Statistics Teachers Guide as well. The 2002 guide is something a veteran teacher
of the course should have in his or her possession. You might be able to borrow one from a colleague in
your area. You can also look at experienced teacher Web sites to find lots of examples. I suggest starting
with Al Coonss site (www.bbn-school.org/us/math/ap_stats). One further source is the AP Statistics
Course Home Page, where a link to the section After the Exam: Activities and Projects appears under
the Teaching Resource Materials heading. A good suggestion is to keep some of the best projects from your
previous year(s) to use as examples in the next. This will usually raise the quality of student work.
Learning by Doing
Nothing helps students consolidate their knowledge like a project. As much is learned from the iterative process of
designing the study and collecting data as from writing the final paper. Full-blown projects might include sections
on research questions/variables, sample selection/randomization, data collection methodology, data presentation,
statistical test/analysis, a discussion of results, weaknesses/suggested improvements, and conclusion.
Projects are time-consuming and should be spread over several weeks. The most instructive ones allow
students to find topics related to their own interests while still meeting the teachers detailed expectations.
Expect multiple proposals that grow in length. Allowing students to evaluate others proposals is very effective.
Large sample size is less important than the process. Simple random samples are rarely available. Many real
questions are first studied with small sample sizes. Surveys or using published data takes less time, but actually
measuring (how far golf balls travel when hit with different clubs) or counting (do women drive SUVs more often
than men?) can be more satisfying.
Check each paper against your list of expectations, but grade holistically as you would for a history paper (see
A Guide for Scoring Free-Response Statistics Questions in the AP Statistics Course Description (pp. 2930 in
the 2009, 2010 edition). Examples of projects can be found by searching the Web for AP Statistics project or
at my class Web site: www.bbn-school.org/us/math/ap_stats.
Al Coons, Buckingham Browne & Nichols School,
Cambridge, Massachusetts
41
Chapter 3
1
Evaluation
When you use challenging material such as past AP Exam questions on your own tests and quizzes, make
sure that your grading reflects the level of rigor of such questions. If performance on these questions counts
as part of a students grade, it is best to score them using the published guidelines and weight them as a
percentage of the test. Relatively speaking, in my class the median score on a test tends to fall pretty much
in the middle of the B range.
If you use AP Exam questions throughout the year and count them as part of the students grades,
youshould consider a grading policy that does not rely on a strict percentage-based system90 to 100
percent = A, 80 to 89 percent = B, and so on. Students who earn even 80 percent of the points on an
APStatistics Exam could well be on their way to earning an AP grade of 5. Assuming you are scoring
a student response with the published rubric, a student who is earning 3 out of 4 points on each freeresponse question is doing well.
For example, my AP problem sets (two to three previously used questions due each week) count for
5 percent of the grade in the first trimester, 10 percent in the second, and 30 percent in the third. Students
thus have a vested interest in completing them, but their grade is not jeopardized early in the year while
they are learning how to write a good response for the question. Even then, the percentage grades (out of
28 points) for the seven AP sets completed in the first trimester can be adjusted so that the median class
grade approximately corresponds to a B/B- range. By the third trimester, the AP sets are due every six days
or so and in aggregate effectively count as much as one of the tests.
Whatever grading policies you use, they should be fair, flexible (so that you can ask challenging
questions), and clearly communicated to the students. For example, it is important to think about and
establish your expectations when it comes to using published AP Exam questions. Will they serve as review
problems only, or will they count as part of the students grade? Remember that students also have access
to the scoring guidelines published on the College Board Web site, so giving AP questions as take-home
assignments bears some risk. Will students be allowed to use their notes and textbooks in answering these?
May they collaborate? In my school, students may ask either of the two statistics teachers for a hint if they
are unsure how to proceed, but they may not use each other or any sources outside their notes
and textbook.
42
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
43
Chapter 3
1
44
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 1
Katherine Halvorsen, Instructor of Record
Allison Crawford, Laboratory Instructor
Smith College
Northampton, Massachusetts
College Profile
Location and Environment: Smith College is dedicated to the vision of its founder, Sophia Smith, who
wrote in 1871 that her intention in endowing a college for women was to develop as fully as may be the
powers of womanhood, and furnish women with the means of usefulness, happiness and honor now
withheld from them. Smith is located one hundred miles west of Boston in Northampton, Massachusetts,
a vibrant community of 35,000 inhabitants. Most students live on campus in the Smith house system.
Smith is a member of Five Colleges, Inc., a consortium of colleges in the Pioneer Valley that also includes
Amherst College, Hampshire College, Mount Holyoke College, and the University of Massachusetts
Amherst. With permission, students may register for classes at any of these institutions.
Some of the most popular majors at Smith are government, psychology, economics, and English. Other
majors with large enrollments include art, history, biology, engineering, anthropology, neuroscience,
sociology, and Spanish.
The study of statistics at Smith is thriving, with about 300 students a year enrolled in introductory
courses offered in departments ranging from Mathematics and Statistics to Economics, Government,
Psychology, and Sociology. About 5070 students each year take upper-level courses, including Regression
Analysis, Research Design, Econometrics, and Mathematical Statistics. Majors in mathematics can
concentrate in statistics, and majors in other fields can complete a minor in applied statistics. At least one
course in introductory statistics is required for majors in biology, engineering, neuroscience,
and psychology.
Type: Private liberal-arts college for women
Total Enrollment: There are approximately 2,800 students, of which about 300 are away from campus
annually, participating in junior-year programs or internships abroad and across the United States. About
20 percent are first-generation college students. The studentfaculty ratio at Smith is 9 to 1.
Ethnic Diversity: Approximately 30 percent of students have minority standing (Asian American,
14 percent; African American, 7 percent; Latina, five percent; Native American, 1 percent; multiracial,
1 percent). Six percent are international students coming from 26 countries.
AP Policy
Smith College participates in the College Boards Advanced Placement Program. AP credit may be used
with the approval of the Administrative Board only: (1) to undertake an accelerated course program;
(2) to make up a shortage of credit incurred as a result of dropping a course for reasons of health; or
(3) to make up a shortage of credits incurred through failure. Credits are recorded for scores of 4 or 5 on
most AP Exams. A maximum of one year (32 credits) of AP credit may be counted toward the degree.
Students who complete courses that cover substantially the same material as those for which AP credit is
recorded may not then apply that AP credit toward the degree requirement. The credits to be recorded for
each examination are determined by the individual department.
45
Chapter 3
1
Personal Philosophy
Students learn statistics by using statistics in contexts that have meaning for them. The subject only has
value to the extent that they can see where and how it fits into their personal or working lives. Therefore,
they must be able to relate what we are doing in this course to questions they have asked, or discussions
they have had, outside of statistics class. To that end, I bring to class a wide range of studies reported in
newspapers, magazines, and journals, as well as on the Web, in order to connect with as many students
as possible. We discuss the design and analysis of these studies, and for their term project, students pose
their own research question, design a study, collect and analyze the data, and present the results at a
poster session on the last day of class. Students need to find their own voices in writing about statistical
issues, and I emphasize the importance of communicating clearly, in writing, the methods and findings of
statistical analyses.
Class Profile
MTH 245, Introduction to Probability and Statistics, provides an introduction to statistics primarily for
mathematically mature students who are majoring in the sciences or mathematics. They have already taken
at least one semester of college calculus or one year of high school calculus. Students who received a 4 or a
5 on the AP Statistics Exam are encouraged to enroll in the second-level statistics courses, either Research
Design or Regression Analysis. A little over half of the 40 students who typically enroll in MTH 245
major in biology, biochemistry, environmental science, or neuroscience. Another 15 percent major in the
mathematical sciences; 15 percent come from the social sciences; 15 percent have not yet declared a major;
and the remaining 5 percent include students from the other sciences and the arts. Many of these students
plan graduate school and careers in biology, neuroscience, medicine, or other sciences. Some of the math
majors plan to become high school mathematics teachers. Most students take the course in their first or
second year at Smith, and they start using what they are learning almost immediately, in courses such as
neuroscience, genetics, ecology, and population biology.
Classes meet Monday, Wednesday, and Friday for 70 minutes. Students are expected to attend class, as
participation is an important part of the learning process and essential to stimulate discussion. Labs meet
for 80 minutes on Tuesday and Wednesday afternoons, and students must sign up for one of these sessions.
Lectures are delivered by the instructor of record, and the two lab sections are taught by a lab instructor.
Laboratory activities form an integral part of the course and are used to explore statistical concepts in
greater depth. This may include collecting and analyzing student-generated data and writing reports that
interpret the results of analyses in nontechnical language. The labs have their own homework assignments
that usually are due at the next lab period.
Course Overview
The aim of this course is to provide students with a thorough understanding of four central topics in
statistics: study design, exploratory data analysis, probability models, and statistical inference. The
prerequisite is any of the following: Calculus I, Discrete Mathematics, one year of high school calculus, or
permission of the instructor. Students who have not taken calculus or discrete mathematics but have taken
four years of high school mathematics should enroll in Statistical Methods for Undergraduate Research
(MTH 190). Students with three years of high school mathematics should enroll in Statistical Thinking
(MTH 107). MTH 245 satisfies the basis requirements for a statistics course in the Biology and Psychology
Departments (basis courses at Smith are the courses all majors have to complete before taking more
advanced courses to satisfy the degree requirements in their major).
46
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Text
Text for the course is the fifth edition of Introduction to the Practice of Statistics by David S. Moore and
George P. McCabe. Students find the textbook very readable. It is full of outstanding examples of real
statistical studies in the sciences and social sciences. We discuss most of the topics covered by the text,
but we modify the order and start with chapter 3, Producing Data, because we want the students to start
thinking about their course projects right away.
The rest of the course is best summarized in the following information that is adapted from material
addressed directly to the students and provided on the first day of class.
Learning statistics is like learning a new language. There are new ideas, new vocabulary, and new rules.
The pace of this course is moderate but relentless, so it is essential that you do not fall behind. The exams,
quizzes, homework, and project assignments are scheduled to encourage steady, consistent application on
your part. It is crucially important that you read ahead in the book as well as review the material after
we have discussed it in class. There is no better way to learn statistics than to tackle problems in the text,
working examples and wrestling with the exercises (many of which have solutions at the back of the book).
Class time is spent discussing your questions, looking at other examples, and engaging in activities. We
also show you how to use statistical software to do the extensive computations most statistical problems
require. The computer is usually faster and more accurate than we are at doing arithmetic and graphs, but
we have to know what arithmetic and which graphs will be useful.
We recommend that you form study groups of three or four students and get together outside of class
to discuss the homework. Each of you should try the problems on your own and then meet to discuss your
work. This allows you to develop your own way of thinking about statistics problems before hearing how
others think and helps you to gain self-confidence.
We also suggest that you create a three-ring binder devoted to this course so that you can collect all of
the course notes, lab notes, handouts, project drafts, homework papers, tests, quizzes, and related materials
in one place.
Statistical Software
We use Minitab statistical software that is available in many computer labs on campus. Minitab has an
online manual, and we will show you how to use the program and how to use the online help facilities.
Additionally, your textbook publisher offers statistical applets and practice quizzes online, which we
explore during class. We also use practice quizzes from the ARTIST Web site [see Teachers Resources
at the end of this syllabus], and we will let you know when those are available.
Calculator Policy
You must bring a scientific calculator to class and to each test and quiz. You are not allowed to share a
calculator with another student during either a test or a quiz. You do not need a graphing calculator, but
your calculator should be able to take logs and exponents.
47
Chapter 3
1
Homework
Homework is an important way to reinforce concepts learned in class. Problems are assigned each week,
and the assignments, with their due dates, are posted on Moodle. We strongly encourage you to complete
these and to work other problems if you need more practice. You may discuss the homework problems with
your colleagues, but you must write up your own solutions. Homework problems are due at the beginning
of class on the due date and must be handed in on time to receive full credit. Homework handed in during
class or at the end of class is automatically late, and late homework will not be accepted after the first class
following the due date. Absence from class does not permit you to hand in homework after the due date
without penalty. If you know you must miss class on the due date, your homework may be handed in early.
Quizzes
Weekly quizzes are given every Wednesday during the first 10 minutes of class. Part of the content of
these quizzes is directly related to the reading assignments due that day, and the questions are very easy
if you have, in fact, done the reading. This helps ensure that everyone is at the same level when a topic is
discussed. The rest of the quiz content is review material and serves to keep your skills honed. In statistics,
perhaps even more than in other endeavors, you learn by doing. There will be no makeups, but your lowest
quiz score will be dropped. Quizzes count only 10 percent toward your final grade. They are intended to
provide just enough extra motivation for you to do your reading on time and to review your notes after
every class. If they succeed in doing this, they are likely to reduce your workload, not increase it.
Tests
The two midterm examinations will be held on February 23 and March 30. You are allowed to bring some
personal notes to these tests. We will give explicit instructions before each test. The final examination
will be self-scheduled during the final examination period in May. If you have special needs concerning
test-taking, please discuss them with Professor Halvorsen. Recall that Smith College has had an academic
honor code since 1944, and all students are bound by it. Cases of dishonesty or plagiarism will be sent
to the Academic Honor Board. Makeup exams may be given to students who notify Ms. Halvorsen, in
advance, that they cannot take a scheduled midterm and who have an appropriate explanation for their
absence. Makeup exams may be oral or written at the discretion of the instructor.
Term Projects
You are expected to complete a research project of your own choosing during the term and to present
your results in a poster on the last day of class. These projects consist of collecting and analyzing data
and writing about your results. You should start thinking right away about research questions you want
to explore. Students work in teams of two or three on the projects. We will give you detailed project
instructions and also make these instructions available on Moodle.
Grading
In grading your written work, we look for problem solutions that are technically correct and reasoning that
is clearly explained. Numerically correct answers alone are not sufficient on homework, tests, or quizzes.
We value neatness and brief, clear answers that explain your thinking. If the grader cannot read or follow
your work, she cannot give you credit for it.
48
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Course Planner
Spring 2007
The following outline lists each class date and gives the topic that was discussed in that class. The reading
assignment from the textbook is also given for each class date. IPS = Introduction to the Practice of
Statistics; HW = homework.
Date
M/Jan. 29
W/Jan. 31
F/Feb. 2
M/Feb. 5
W/Feb. 7
F/Feb. 9
M/Feb. 12
W/Feb. 14
F/Feb. 16
M/Feb. 19
W/Feb. 21
F/Feb. 23
M/Feb. 26
W/Feb. 28
F/Mar. 2
M/Mar. 5
W/Mar. 7
F/Mar. 9
M/Mar. 12
W/Mar. 14
F/Mar. 16
Mar. 1724
M/Mar. 26
W/Mar. 28
F/Mar. 30
M/Apr. 2
W/Apr. 4
F/Apr. 6
M/Apr. 9
W/Apr. 11
F/Apr. 13
M/Apr. 16
Topic
Introduction, Collecting Data, Types of Studies
Planning and Conducting Experiments
Planning and Conducting Surveys
Displaying Distributions: Numeric Summaries and Graphs
Normal Distributions, z-Scores
Assessing Normality, Q-Q Plots, N-scores
Scatterplots, Median Trace, Correlation
Simple Linear Regression (SLR)
Residuals, Outliers, Influence Points, and Causation
Exponential Growth, Log Transformations
RALLY DAY (NO CLASSES)
FIRST MIDTERM EXAM
Probability and Randomness
Probability Models
Random Variables
Means and Variances of Discrete Random Variables
General Probability Rules
Generalizing from Study Results
Binomial Model for Counts for Small Sample Sizes
Approximating the Sampling Distributions for Counts
Approximating the Sampling Distributions for Proportions
SPRING BREAK
Sampling Distribution of the Sample Mean and CLT
Confidence Intervals for Means
SECOND MIDTERM EXAM
Tests of Significance
Uses and Abuses of Tests
Power of a Test, Inference as a Decision
Inference for the Mean, One Sample
Inference for Means, Two Samples
Inference for a Proportion, One Sample
Inference for Proportions, Two Samples
Reading
IPS 3.1
IPS 3.2
IPS 3.3
IPS 1.1, 2
IPS 1.3
IPS 1.3
IPS 2.1, 2
IPS 2.3
IPS 2.4, 5
IPS 2.6
Assignment
Due
Quiz 1
HW 1
Quiz 2
HW 2
Quiz 3
HW 3
Exam 1
IPS 4.1
IPS 4.2
IPS 4.3
IPS 4.4
IPS 4.5
IPS 3.4
IPS 5.1
IPS 5.1
IPS 5.1
IPS 5.2
IPS 6.1
IPS 6.2
IPS 6.3
IPS 6.4
IPS 7.1
IPS 7.2
IPS 8.1
IPS 8.2
Quiz 4
HW 4
Quiz 5
HW 5
HW 6
HW 7
Exam 2
Quiz 6
HW 8
Quiz 7
HW 9
49
Chapter 3
1
Date
Topic
W/Apr. 18
F/Apr. 20
M/Apr. 23
W/Apr. 25
F/Apr. 27
M/Apr. 30
W/May 2
F/May 4
May 811
FINAL EXAMS
Reading
IPS 9.1
IPS 9.2
IPS 10.1
IPS 10.2
IPS 12.1
IPS 12.1
Assignment
Due
Quiz 8
HW 10
Quiz 9
HW 11
Project
Poster Due
Teaching Strategies
Students must keep up with the pace of the course to absorb new ideas presented both in their reading and
in class; to that end, we have weekly homework sets and weekly quizzes on the most recent reading and
homework questions. Weekly laboratory sessions provide opportunities for hands-on work with problems
related to the previous weeks reading and class discussions, as well as for practice using computer software
to carry out simulations or analyses of data. Students spend class time discussing the material in the
reading and working examples. Statistical thinking is emphasized, and we use statistical applets on the
Web and hands-on activities to develop concepts.
Learning difficult material is challenging and often frustrating to students. Immediate feedback and
easily available help are both important to help keep such frustration within reasonable bounds. I try to
return quizzes in the class period following the quiz. Tests, lab assignments, and homework are returned
within a week, usually within one or two class periods. Although I have regular office hours each week and
make myself available by appointment at other times, my main means of communication with students
outside of class is through e-mail and through our Moodle Web site. I post most of the course handouts
on the Web. Students can meet with teaching assistants between 7 p.m. and 9 p.m. on Sunday through
Thursday evenings to get help, and they can meet with the laboratory instructor during her office hours.
I strongly encourage students to form study groups that meet outside of class to discuss class work and
homework and to bring questions to class that they cannot solve in their study groups.
Lab Component
Students meet in the statistics laboratory once a week for an 80-minute class. The lab is a required part of
the course, and students must attend and do the lab homework weekly.
Each lab section contains between 15 and 20 students. Lab work may require computers or lab
equipment (e.g., balances, calipers) for weighing or measuring as students gather data from an experiment.
Students typically work in pairs or larger groups for most lab activities.
There is no lab manual; instead, we hand out plans for each lab during the section in which the plan
will be used. Below are two examples of the detailed lesson plans given to students. Each lab plan contains
some objectives and an activity for that days lab and, usually, a homework assignment.
50
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
To learn methods for constructing tests and confidence intervals for proportions
To acquire experience applying the methods for testing a hypothesis and for constructing a
confidence interval for the difference in proportions from two populations
Proportion of vehicles sitting on the white line that defines the parking place
Explain why you think your data will meet the criteria needed to ensure the validity of a confidence
interval or a test of two proportions (that is, what the assumptions are and why you think your data will
satisfy them).
51
Chapter 3
1
Methods
How are you going to decide whether a vehicle has the characteristic you are going to count? For instance,
how much of a vehicles tire must be on the line before it counts as sitting on the white line? Give an
operational definition of the variable you plan to count below. Provide as much detail in your description
as you would need to instruct someone else to collect these data for you.
Data Collection
Decide how you are going to collect and record your data (including mechanisms to ensure that your group
does not count the same car twice). Attach your data collection record to your lab report.
Inference Procedure
1. Report your summary statistics (for example, the total number of vehicles in each lot, the number
of vehicles in each lot that had your characteristic of interest, the sample proportion in each lot, and
the standard deviation of the sample proportion in each lot).
2. Describe your research question.
52
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Objectives
b)Fill in the formula by double-clicking in the blank box below the heading Formula. Enter
prev ( X ) + 1 in the formula box. Click OK. You should see the formula below the Formula
heading, and 1 (the value for the first observation) appears below the Value heading. We have
created a sequence of values from 1 to 1,000 in ascending order.
53
Chapter 3
1
d)Enter 10 + 3 X in the formula box. Click OK, and you will see 13 in the Value box for the
first observation.
e)Fill in the third variable name, YRand. That is the y value when a random error i is included.
f)Enter Y + RandomNormal (0, 10) in the YRand formula box. We are adding the random
error i, which has mean 0 and standard deviation 10 to Y. RandomNormal instructions can
also be found by choosing Functions Random numbers randomNormal.
54
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Making Graphs for Values of Slope
13. When it is done, open the Cases pane.
14. Pull a Graph off the tool shelf. Make a histogram for values of Slope by grasping the variable Slope
from the Cases pane and dropping them on the horizontal axis. Choose Histogram.
15. Right-click on the graph, and choose Plot Function. Key in the formula: normalDensity (slope,
mean( ), s( ) ), and click OK. You should be able to see a normal curve being fitted to the
histogram.8
16. Take a New Graph off the tool shelf and make a Normal Quantile Plot for the values of Slope.
Showing the Classical Summary and the Five-Number Summary
17. Pull the Summary icon from the tool shelf.
18. Grasp Slope from the Cases pane, and drop it onto the Summary table.
19. The mean will be immediately displayed as default.
20. Right-click on the Summary table box, and choose Add Formula.
21. The standard deviation of the distribution can be found by choosing Functions Statistical One
Attribute stdDev.
22. Produce the five-number summary in the summary table by using Functions Statistical One
Attribute
23. Use the information from your graphs and summary statistics to comment on how well the normal
distribution approximates the observed distribution of slope. Use a text box to insert your answer
on the screen page. To insert a text box, go to the text icon on the tool shelf A, and pull the box off
the shelf. Type your answer inside the box. You may resize the box by dragging on a corner.
Finding the 95 Percent Confidence Interval for the Mean of the Distribution of Slope
24. Theoretical estimation
8. Note that by moving the cursor over the histogram, you can see a hand, a double-headed horizontal arrow, or a single-headed arrow.
The hand symbol, held over a bar in the histogram, causes the program to report both the upper and lower values on the horizontal
scale for the bar, and the number of observations in this interval. These numbers are shown in the lower left-hand corner of the screen,
just above the Start button. For example, 2.987 <= Slope <= 2.989: 25 cases means that there are 25 values of the variable Slope
between 2.987 and 2.989. The double-headed horizontal arrow, held over a vertical line, causes the program to report the X-value of the
vertical line. The single-headed arrow causes the program to report the (x, y) coordinates of the point at the tip of the arrow.
55
Chapter 3
1
Finding the 95 Percent Prediction Interval for a New Observation by Theoretical Estimation and by
Empirical Estimation
25. Theoretical estimation
The 95 percent prediction interval for a new observation is: t* SE , where t* is the value for
the (n2) density curve with area 95 percent between t* and t*.
Click on Slope in the table, and all the values will be highlighted.
Right-click, and choose Sort Ascending. The 500 values will be arranged in ascending order.
Take the average of the twelfth and thirteenth values and also the average of the four hundred
eighty-seventh and four hundred eighty-eighth values. These two numbers estimate the range of
the middle 95 percent of the distribution.
Create a text box, and record your empirical prediction interval in the text box.
27. Compare the two prediction intervals, and give an explanation for any discrepancy you may find.
Use another text box for this discussion.
Assignment
Produce a lab report that includes the histogram, normal quantile plot, numerical summary, point
estimate, 95 percent confidence interval for the mean slope, the two prediction intervals for new
observations, and your comments.
Student Evaluation
The semester grade for this course is a weighted average of several components, as indicated below. In
borderline situations, class participation and attendance are given greater emphasis.
Participation
Quizzes
Homework
Lab work
First midterm
Second midterm
Final exam
Projects
56
5 percent
10 percent
10 percent
15 percent
15 percent
15 percent
15 percent
15 percent
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
The lab instructor grades the lab homework and provides the course instructor with an overall lab grade
for the semester. This grade is then averaged into the course grade as shown above. Homework is marked
by a grader using an answer key provided by the instructor. Each homework assignment is graded from
1 to 5 points, based on a combination of accuracy and effort. Below are rough guidelines for grading:
Teacher Resources
Textbook
Moore, David S., and George P. McCabe. Introduction to the Practice of Statistics. 5th ed. New York: W. H.
Freeman, 2005.
Other
ARTIST (Assessment Resource Tools for Improving Statistical Thinking).
https://app.gen.umn.edu/artist/index.html.
Provides a variety of assessment resources for teaching first courses in statistics.
Fathom Dynamic Data Software. Version 2. Emeryville, Calif.: Key Curriculum Press.
www.keypress.com.
57
Chapter 3
1
Student Activities
Class Projects
The following student handout explains in detail all the requirements of the semester-long research studies
that the students develop and implement, either individually or with a partner.
For your class project you will select a research question that interests you and write a proposal describing
how you plan to conduct your research. We encourage you to work with another student on your project.
You will review other students proposals, and you will receive reviews of your proposal from your peers,
from the instructors, and, for some of you, from Smith Colleges Institutional Review Board. After your
research proposal has been approved, you will carry out your data collection and analysis. Finally, you will
create a poster describing your study and your results. Posters will be displayed in the style of a professional
conference on our last day of class. Each of you will be assigned to review three of the final posters.
The following steps lead to a completed class project:
58
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
General Rules
The work (analysis and write-up) must be your own. You may consult other sources for information about
the nonstatistical, substantive issues in your project, but be sure to credit these sources in your poster.
Consult the instructors about statistical questions. Projects that involve using human subjects (interviewing,
measuring, etc.) or live animals must be reviewed by the Institutional Review Board, and you need to allow
time for this in planning your project. Institutional review ensures that the subjects will be treated properly,
their privacy protected, and their consent obtained. If you need to use human subjects, we will show you
how to prepare a proposal for institutional review.
Project Outline
The project outline consists of a one-page form on which you very briefly describe your proposed project.
One copy of the blank form is attached to these instructions, and the form is also available on Moodle at
our class site. We will use this information to work with you to develop your full project proposal.
Project Proposal
The proposal for your poster is a paper, 5001,000 words in length, that describes in detail the research you
plan to conduct and the methods you will use to both collect and analyze your data. The fundamental goal
of any proposal is to convince the reviewer that your objectives are worthy of the research effort and that
you have a plan of action that will result in successful achievement of these objectives. You must hand in
three copies of your proposal.
Please be aware that the instructors or the Institutional Review Board may require changes in your
proposal before you receive permission to conduct your study. We will work with you to ensure that your
proposal will be approved. Be sure to use the format given below for your proposal and to address each
item in the outline.
The proposal must be typed, double-spaced, on 8 by 11 inch white paper. Include a cover sheet with the
following information: the names and contact information for the authors, the course number and name,
the date, and the course instructors names. On the cover sheet state clearly: This proposal [requires/does
not require] institutional review.
Use the following section headings in the body of your proposal.
I. Introduction
What is your topic? What do you already know about your topic? Why is your topic worthy of study? What
is the objective of your project? State your research question as one that can be answered through the
collection and analysis of data.
II. Methods
A. Sampling Issues
1. What are the units in your study (observations, objects, people, studies)?
4. How will you avoid sampling bias? (You should provide enough detail about your sampling
methods so that someone else could collect the data for you.)
59
Chapter 3
1
B. Data Collection Issues
1. What variables will you measure on each unit in your sample, and how will you measure each
variable? (You should measure a minimum of two variables on each unit.) Give operational
definitions of your variables and of your methods of measurement. What is the proposed response
variable? What are your proposed explanatory or associated variables?
2.How will you collect measurements from the units (for example, will you use a questionnaire to ask
questions, or will you directly measure something like height or observe something like price)?
3. Address each of the issues of randomization, replication, and control in your study.
C. Statistical Analyses
1. Are you going to be looking for an association between your two variables or a cause-and-effect
relationship? Give your best guess about the relationships between the response and explanatory
variable.
2. Note that analysis of your data must include at least one of the following tools:
3. Describe what graphs and tables you expect to use to display your results. Describe what results
you expect to see.
60
1. Your name, the purpose of the study, and a description of the study. You may not deceive
participants or put them at risk in any way.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
2. A statement that responses are confidential or anonymous, as appropriate. If the information you
are requesting is at all sensitive, you must provide some explanation regarding the steps you are
taking to assure confidentiality or anonymity.
3. A request that the subjects voluntarily participate in the study. You should have them sign a
consent form if your study is not a survey.
F. Third-Party Information
If you require resources from a third party (for example, using data belonging to someone else), include a
copy of your written request to that party for the information. Do not send the request before you obtain
written approval from the instructors.
Peer Review of a Project Proposal
You will be asked to read and assess someone elses project proposal. Your job is to assess the feasibility and
rationale of the project you review. Are the variables the researchers plan to collect appropriate for their
research question? Are the data collection methods appropriate? Do lurking variables exist? Is the sample
size sufficient? How else could the project be done? Can the objectives be met given the available resources?
We will provide a form for your peer reviews.
Progress Report
Midway through the project you need to assess your work to date by completing a progress report. We will
give you a set of questions to answer.
Project Data and Descriptive Statistics
By Monday April 2 you should have all of your data collected so that you can begin to focus on the data
analysis and on producing a well-organized and attractive poster. At this time you must submit a copy of
your data and a report containing descriptive statistics for each variable you collected.
Preliminary Data Analysis
By Monday April 16 a preliminary draft of your complete data analysis is due. This assures that you will
have time to complete your analysis and create the poster on time for our poster session on May 4.
Poster Draft
On Monday April 23 please hand in a copy of the text and graphs you plan to put on your poster.
Abstract and Poster Presentation
Bring your poster and a separate abstract for your project to class. The content of your poster should be
roughly equivalent to that of a 10-page paper (you do not need to hand in a paper). Your poster should
include the following items:
Title: Invent a catchy or interesting title that captures the spirit of your project.
Byline: List the authors of the project and their institutional addresses.
Rationale: Provide a statement of the question or purpose of the project. What problems are
addressed, what key issues are important to the project, and what was known about the topic before
you started?
61
Chapter 3
1
Methods: Explain what you did and how you did it. How did you choose your sample? What
variables did you measure? How did you measure each variable? What statistical techniques did
you use?
Results: Present a summary of your data both in figures (graphs or tables) and in a textual
description. Emphasize trends as well as specific values. Give the results of confidence intervals or
statistical tests.
Discussion: Explain what you learned about the problem or question you set out to investigate.
Discuss your findings in terms of what else is known.
Critique: What did you learn about the process of carrying out your project? What went wrong, and
how could you avoid that pitfall in the future? What advice would you give to future students?
Poster Reviews
On the day of the poster presentation, we will provide forms on which you may write your poster review. It
will contain specific questions to address and space for you to provide more extensive comments. We will
ask you to consider the following issues:
Presentation: Is the poster attractive and well organized? Are all components present? Is it easy to
follow? Is the text well written? Are the graphs and tables easy to understand?
Statistical content: Did the investigators use appropriate statistical techniques? Are the techniques
used correctly? Are the figures appropriate to the data?
Subject matter content: Did you learn something about the subject of the poster? Is the content
interesting, fun, provocative, compelling, educational, or fascinating?
Students complete a short questionnaire at the end of term after the project is complete. Here are a couple
of responses I particularly liked:
Question: What have you learned from the process of conducting your research?
In conducting my research for the statistics project, I learned that it is very different from conducting
a science experiment. Through filling out the IRB form [Institutional Review Board forms required for
projects using human subjects], I learned about all of the ethics and meticulous details that must be
thought about even when conducting the simplest experiment. I also learned that it really pays off to be
organized and get everything done by the helpful deadlines. I also learned how to communicate efficiently
with a research partner and how to compromise.
Planning and consistent effort matters a lot. Working consistently over the entire assignment period
makes the project go a lot smoother. [There is] [m]ore time to make decisions and corrections.
62
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 2
Jackie Miller
Ohio State University, Columbus
University Profile
Location and Environment: In terms of enrollment, Ohio State is the largest university in the United States.
It is located in an urban environment about two miles from downtown Columbus, the state capital, in the
center of the state. Columbus is the fifteenth-largest U.S. city and the thirty-second-largest metropolitan
area. In addition to the university, it boasts many arts and cultural institutions and professional sports
teams in soccer, hockey, arena football, and minor league baseball. It is also a major business center.
Ohio State is ranked nineteenth in U.S. News and World Reports 2007 Americas Best Colleges
survey. Its First Year Experience (FYE) and Living-Learning Programs are listed as stellar examples of
programs that lead to student success. Kiplinger Personal Finance in 2007 ranked the school sixty-second
among its top 100 best values in public colleges. Ohio State was also selected in 2003 and 2004 as one of the
countrys 50 best colleges for African Americans by Black Enterprise magazine. More than half (53 percent)
of the entering first-year students in fall 2007 ranked in the top 10 percent of their graduating high school
class, and 89 percent ranked in the top 25 percent.
There are more than 170 majors at Ohio State. Students can also opt to custom-design their own
major through the Personalized Study Program. Undecided students can participate in the Ohio State
Exploration Program. The university sponsors nine preprofessional programs (predentistry, pre-education,
prelaw, premedicine, pre-occupational therapy, preoptometry, prepharmacy, pre-physical therapy, and
pre-veterinary medicine), as well as 28 Agricultural Technical Institute (ATI) programs leading to an
Associate of Applied Science or Associate of Science degree.
Type: Coeducational, public research university
Total Enrollment: On the Columbus campus, as of fall 2007, there were 52,568 students (39,209
undergraduates, 10,097 graduate students, and 3,262 professional students). The undergraduate student-tofaculty ratio is 13:1.
Ethnic Diversity: As of fall 2007, the minority student population was as follows: African American,
6.5 percent; Asian American, 5.2 percent; Hispanic/Latino, 2.5 percent; Native American, 0.4 percent.
International students from 113 countries accounted for 7 percent of the total enrollment.
Personal Philosophy
I love teaching statisticsdespite the fact that I often describe it as selling a product that my students
do not want to buy. (This aphorism has also become part of several of my graduate assistants teaching
philosophies.) For many students, statistics is a required course, but regardless of why they choose to take
it, most of them really do not know what the subject entails. At Ohio State, for each quarters course, I have
10 weeks to open up the world of statistics to my students; it is an opportunity to help them consciously
realize how statistics influence their daily lives. It is important to me that my students not only learn the
process of collecting and analyzing data but that they think critically about the statistics that are presented
to them from all quarters: scientific, financial, and political. It is the combination of these abilities that
leads my students to be better consumers of statistics. This is why selling a product that students do not
want to buy is challenging, rewarding, and never dullthe point being proved when some of my students
find the course interesting enough to pursue further opportunities in the discipline.
63
Chapter 3
1
Class Profile
Ohio State operates on the quarter system, and because our courses are only 10 weeks long and could
not possibly include all the material included in a yearlong AP Statistics high school class, this syllabus
presents Course Planners for two separately taught, one-quarter, introductory statistics courses that
together comprise most of the skills included in the AP Statistics curriculum: Statistics 145 (Introduction to
the Practice of Statistics) and Statistics 245 (Introduction to Statistical Analysis). The latter is a higher-level
course, although it is still introductory in nature. It is not a continuation of Stat 145. For that reason,
AP students who earn a grade of 3 on the AP Statistics Exam get credit for Stat 145 and receive five hours
of college credit, whereas those who earn a 4 or 5 get credit for Stat 245 and also receive five hours of
college credit.
Statistics 145
Students at Ohio State tend to put off this course until later in their college careers. This means that more
of my students are juniors and seniors than sophomores and first-year students. Typically, more than half
are women. The students come from preprofessional majors in the medical professions, from the social and
behavioral sciences, and from the honors program in the arts and sciences.
During the academic year, three lecture sections of Stat 145 are offered every quartertwo during the
day and one in the evening, with a different instructor for each. I am the coordinator for the course and
always teach one of the daytime lectures. Another faculty or staff member teaches the second daytime
lecture, and a senior graduate teaching associate teaches the smaller evening class. We have a total of
approximately 400 students in each of the autumn and spring quarters, and about 350 students total
in the winter quarter. (During the summer quarter, we offer one daytime lecture that typically serves
approximately 100 students.) The evening lecture usually has about 50 students, and the rest of the students
are divided equally between the two daytime lectures.
The average number of students per recitation ranges between 26 and 28, depending on enrollment for
the quarter. There are typically six recitation sections for each daytime lecture and two recitation sections
for the night lecture. This is a five-credit course. The daytime sections (and the summer course) have
three 48-minute lectures and two 48-minute recitations per week. The evening class is structured slightly
differently, with two 72-minute lectures and two 48-minute recitations per week. The recitations include
computer lab work, but there is no separately scheduled lab for the course.
Statistics 245
Statistics 245 has a prerequisite of Calculus II. Even though calculus is not really used in this course, we
prefer that the students have the mathematical sophistication that Calculus II provides. Furthermore, I am
not aware of any calculus-based introductory statistics books that fit our course.
In the autumn 2007 quarter, the vast majority of the students were juniors and seniors (nearly 80
percent), and three-quarters of them were men. Nearly a third were honors students. In general, the
students come from majors in biology, biomedical sciences, engineering, geography, and social and
behavioral sciences (economics and psychology students seeking the B.S.). During the academic year, only
one daytime lecture is offered (autumn quarter). There are approximately 150 students in the course, and
this class meets for three 48-minute lectures and two 48-minute recitations per week. Graduate teaching
assistants (GTAs) teach the six recitation sections, which have about 25 students in each. There is no lab
component to the course.
64
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Course Overviews
According to our course bulletin, Stat 145 topics include probability, descriptive statistics, correlation,
regression, design of experiments, sampling, estimation, and testing; emphasis on applications, statistical
reasoning, and data analysis using statistical software. Stat 245 is described as a calculus-based
introduction to data analysis, experimental design, sampling, probability, and inference.
For both courses, the Web-based statistical software we use is StatCrunch, because it has the benefits
of Minitab and allows us to conduct recitations in both the Mac and PC computer rooms. Ohio State has
purchased a license for StatCrunch, and our students can access it from within our course management
system. We cannot require students to purchase a particular calculator, so this is the closest we can get to
students using the same technology in recitations and on homework.
My broad goals for both courses are similar. The objectives are for students to learn the following:
Essential techniques for producing data (surveys, experiments, observational studies); analyzing data
(graphical and numerical summaries); modeling data (basic probability, sampling distributions); and
drawing conclusions from data (inference proceduresconfidence intervals and significance tests)
Textbooks
For Statistics 145, we use the second edition of Intro Stats by De Veaux, Velleman, and Bock. For Statistics
245, the text is the third edition of Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis by Peck, Olsen, and Devore.
See the Teacher Resources section of this syllabus for full citations.
Course Planners
Statistics 145: Introduction to the Practice of Statistics
In the past two years, we have lost time during the winter quarter, and I have had to drop confidence
intervals and hypothesis testing of the population mean from the course during that term. Because of this,
I will use the sequencing from autumn 2006 for the three-lecture-a-week section.
Chapter 1: Stats Starts Here
(0 days)
Students are encouraged to read this introduction on their own.
Chapter 2: Data
(1.5 days)
This chapter introduces the how and the Ws of data (who, what, when, where, why). Because students
find the Ws difficult to grasp at first, it is important to emphasize the importance of context in statistics:
knowing the answers to the Ws makes a study or analysis more meaningful. This chapter also introduces
students to the basic differences between categorical, quantitative, ordinal, and identifier variables.
65
Chapter 3
1
Chapter 3: Displaying Categorical Data
(0.51 day)
In this chapter, students learn about bar charts and pie charts. These are graphical displays that they
should be familiar with from past mathematics (or statistics) classes or from the media. It is important to
underscore the pitfalls of each type of display so that students know when they are seeing data portrayed
correctly (for example, pictograms typically violate the area principle).
Chapter 4: Displaying Quantitative Data
(1.5 days)
The chapter talks about dotplots, stemplots, and histograms (boxplots appear in chapter 5). Because
of the limited time in the quarter system, we have chosen to concentrate on histograms. The text asks
students to describe the distribution of a data set by shape, center, and spread. The authors include unusual
features (outliers, gaps, etc.) in shape. To emphasize the importance of the unusual features, I separate
this category out as a fourth aspect that should be considered when describing distributions. Recently I
heard one of my graduate teaching associates split shape up even further, telling her students to address
modality and symmetry.
Chapter 5: Describing Distributions Numerically
(2 days)
This chapter talks about the mean, median, interquartile range, and standard deviation. It also introduces
boxplots as another option for graphically displaying quantitative data. Students learn when it is most
appropriate to use the mean and standard deviation or the median and IQR to describe, respectively, the
center and spread of the distribution.
QUIZ IN RECITATION ON CHAPTERS 25
Chapter 12: Sample Surveys
(1.5 days)
The important thing for students to understand about sample surveys is when they should question
methodology and how different types of bias act on surveys. An interesting question that arises here
at Ohio State in association with that issue is why some of us trust electronic Student Evaluations of
Instruction (eSEIs), given the fact that Internet surveys are often useless and students must fill out the eSEIs
through their own OSU account. We know that no student can evaluate the same course twice, so that
problem is eliminated, but it is good to discuss what types of bias may filter into the eSEIs.
Chapter 13: Experiments
(1.5 days)
In this chapter, the authors use David Moores diagram of an experiment to show random assignment,
groups, treatments, and comparison of the response variable. The chapter addresses blocking and matched
pairs designs as well. I have used two past AP Statistics Exam questions in connection with this chapter
the yoga/tai chi (2003, no. 4) and old/new shampoo (2004, no. 2) experimental design questions.
Chapter 14: From Randomness to Probability (LLN)
(1 day)
The idea of from randomness in the chapter title is lost a bit in Stat 145 because we do not have time to
study chapter 11 (Simulation) with any justice; simulation is a key element in understanding how we get
from randomness to long-run probabilities. To show the law of large numbers during lecture, I use the
coin-toss applet linked to the fifth edition of Introduction to the Practice of Statistics that can be accessed at
http://bcs.whfreeman.com/ips5e by clicking on Student Applets and then Probability.
66
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
One thing in this chapter that I caution students about is that the addition and multiplication rules are
specific to disjoint and independent events, respectively. However, the general probability rules in chapter 15
can be used in the special situations encountered in chapter 14.
Chapter 15: Probability Rules!
(1 day)
When we get to this point in the course, I remind students that I had foreshadowed the general
probability rules of this chapter when we talked about the specific rules for disjoint and independent
events. Conditional probabilities are always difficult for students to grasp, but I remind them that we
are now formalizing the techniques that we used back in chapter 3 when we looked at marginal and
conditional distributions of categorical variables. Another stumbling block for students is the temptation
to multiply the probability of events A and B when finding the probability of the union of those two
events. In other words, students tend to make the jump from P A B P A P B P A B to
P A B P A P B P A P B without thinking about the implications. Be aware that they may
make this misstep and then, in a later exercise, show that the events are not independent. They routinely do
not see the contradiction, despite warnings in both lecture and recitation against this common mistake.
Review for midterm exam
(1 day)
COMMON EVENING MIDTERM ON CHAPTERS 25 AND 1215
Chapter 6: The Standard Deviation as a Ruler and the Normal Model
(1.5 days)
I teach chapter 6 out of order because it makes more sense to me to have students learn about z-scores and
the normal distribution right before they need it (the just in time approach). This has worked in the class
so far, but I understand why the authors have placed chapter 6 where it is in the book and why others would
teach the chapters in order.
Chapter 18: Sampling Distribution Models (CLT)
(1.5 days)
This chapter deals with sampling distribution models for both proportions and means. It spends a bit
more time on proportions than on means: I think this is because the authors move directly into inference
for proportions. The sampling distribution is motivated by simulation of data. This can be done and
understood without having studied the simulation chapter.
QUIZ IN RECITATION ON CHAPTERS 6 AND 18 (sometimes delayed to include chapter 19)
Chapter 19: Confidence Intervals for Proportions
(1.5 days)
The authors introduce confidence intervals in a way that I think makes sense for the class, although
students continue to find the process of constructing confidence intervals difficult to understand. One
thing that helps is asking them what the probability is that a 95 percent confidence interval contains
the true population proportion. Talking about this emphasizes the process of constructing confidence
intervals. I use the applet linked to the fifth edition of Introduction to the Practice of Statistics that can be
accessed at http://bcs.whfreeman.com/ips5e by clicking on Student Applets and then Confidence Intervals
to demonstrate the effect of confidence level on the width of the interval. During recitation, students do an
activity with M&Ms, one that we feel we have improved over the typical version (see Student Activities
section at the end of this syllabus). This exercise also carries over to chapter 20, on hypothesis testing.
67
Chapter 3
1
Chapter 20: Testing Hypotheses About Proportions
(2 days)
This is a chapter that students find challenging. No matter how you explain the steps to hypothesis testing,
they have a difficult time setting up the hypotheses, making a decision using the P-value, and drawing a
conclusion in context. Actually calculating the test statistic and the P-value are not the stumbling points
for these students. However, I think that AP Statistics students have had more time to be exposed to the
process of doing and thinking about statistics and may catch on to these steps more easily than other
students.
It is important to stress that we use the sample proportion when finding the standard error (and
margin of error) for the confidence interval, but we use the hypothesized population proportion when
finding the standard deviation for the hypothesis test.
Chapter 21: More About Tests
(1.5 days)
This chapter ties confidence intervals and hypothesis tests together, explaining how to use a confidence
interval to test a hypothesis. It also talks about errors and power, both of which are eliminated from our
coverage in the interest of time. We have discussed having the students read this chapter on their own and
getting them involved with an activity that would address the same issues.
Chapter 23: Inference About Means
(2 days)
This is a chapter in which I emphasize that we are studying variations on a theme, the theme being
inference. The processes of constructing confidence intervals and conducting hypothesis tests are the same
as we have already seen, with slight variations in the distribution and formulas used and the conditions
checked. Students do not seem to have a difficult time understanding the t distribution, especially when we
compare/contrast it with the standard normal distribution.
Chapter 7: Scatterplots, Association, and Correlation
(1.5 days)
Again, as can be seen by the chapter numbers, I have chosen an unconventional order for the topics in
the introductory statistics course. Because 10-week quarters are so intense, I like to end on an easier
note and let the ideas from inference settle in with the students over the remaining time in the course.
Students have no trouble understanding scatterplots and association. The biggest difficulty with correlation
actually comes in chapter 8 when they might see some partial StatCrunch output and be asked to state
the correlation. It seems that no matter how many times students tell you in class that the correlation is
negative when there is a negative association, they still do not pick this out in the final exam question that
tests this.
Chapter 8: Linear Regression
(1.5 days)
The actual process of doing linear regression and making predictions does not seem difficult for students.
They understand that extrapolation is not something they should do (I like to say Friends dont let friends
extrapolate, a slogan that can also be found on an ASA T-shirt!). One concept that is difficult for them to
explain on the final exam (which is the only time this is tested) is what a residual plot tells you about the
regression.
68
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Chapter 9: Regression Wisdom
(1 day)
This chapter is to chapters 7 and 8 what chapter 21 is to chapters 19 and 20. There are important concepts
in chapter 9, but I find it a little repetitive, so we are trying to develop a lecture activity that would get at
all of the ideas without taking class time to go through the chapter itself (students would be responsible for
reading the chapter on their own).
Review for final exam
(2 days)
COMMON FINAL EXAM DURING FINALS WEEK (COMPREHENSIVE)
69
Chapter 3
1
Chapter 7: Random Variables and Probability Distributions
(3 days)
In this chapter, we talk about random variableswhat they are, what a distribution is, and how to find the
expected value, variance, and standard deviation. The specific distributions that we study are the binomial
and the normal (including the standard normal distribution and how to read a normal table).
Chapter 8: Sampling Variability and Sampling Distributions
(2 days)
This chapter deals with the sampling distribution of the sample proportion and the sample mean. It is
important to stress the differences between and among the population distribution, the distribution of a
sample, and the sampling distribution.
Chapter 9: Estimation Using a Single Sample
(2.5 days)
This chapter introduces confidence intervals for the population proportion and the population mean. The
critical issue to emphasize with students is that conditions must be checked to make sure that they can
actually go ahead with calculating the interval. Another thing that should be pointed out is that confidence
intervals are not complete at the end of the calculationthey need to be interpreted in the context of the
problem. This chapter also addresses the calculation of sample sizes.
Chapter 10: Hypothesis Testing Using a Single Sample
(3 days)
This chapter introduces hypothesis tests for the population proportion and the population mean. Again, it
is important to stress that conditions need to be checked to ensure that students can actually go ahead with
calculating the interval and that the conclusions made need to be interpreted in the context of the problem.
The link between confidence intervals and hypothesis tests is also discussed.
EXAM 2 IN CLASS ON CHAPTERS 710
Chapter 11: Comparing Two Populations or Treatments
(3 days)
Here we look at confidence intervals and hypothesis tests for two populations, including the two-sample
difference in proportions, the two-sample difference in means, and the dependent sample mean difference.
As in chapters 9 and 10, the process of confidence intervals and hypothesis tests are highlighted (including
condition checks and interpreting results in context).
Chapter 5: Summarizing Bivariate Data
(2.5 days)
This chapter deals with scatterplots, correlation, and simple linear regression. The reason for its placement
near the end of the quarter is practicalthese are nice concepts to study when the students are tired from
a long quarter. This is an introduction to the relationship between two quantitative variables, and bivariate
data analysis for categorical variables is discussed in chapter 12.
Chapter 12: The Analysis of Categorical Data and Goodness-of-Fit Tests
(2 days)
It is important for students to see bivariate data analysis for categorical variables. Although they worked
with categorical variables in the chapters on inference for proportions, which was a special case
70
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
(the normal approximation to the binomial), they have not worked with categorical variables that have
more than two categories since the beginning of the quarter. I feel that they need to be exposed to these
procedures so that they remember that quantitative variables are not the only type of variables in the world.
FINAL EXAM DURING FINALS WEEK (COMPREHENSIVE)
Teaching Strategies
During lectures, students use course note packets that I created, based on the PowerPoint slides from the
texts but with examples added that are of interest to students. The packets use a fill-in-the-blank format,
with room for us to work the examples that I have included for that quarter. Many students like the note
packets because they can listen in class instead of furiously writing down notes. This is exactly why I
developed them, having learned in my education courses (and from personal experience) that it is very
difficult to truly listen to the teacher and copy notes from the board at the same time.
One novel thing that I do in these classes is to use a tablet PC. This allows me to write on PowerPoint
slides that duplicate the note packet, so I can actually do the work with the students and/or incorporate
their suggestions. It is very handy to be able to write down notes on a specific question that students might
ask as well. During the Stat 145 lectures, we work through at least one example of each concept; extra
examples are saved for recitation. I have been trying to find ways to get students in a large lecture to be
more talkative and to participate more. To this end, I question students as much as I can during lecture and
ask that they offer solutions to examples or hints on how to approach examples. Occasionally, I set them the
task of trying something in their notes and then walk around the lecture hall to help individual students
before bringing them back together to discuss their solutions. I also have the class do a lot of voting (for
example, which answer is correct?) and hope to include clickers (student response systems) and podcasts
within the next year or two. Basically, the teaching strategies for the two courses are very similar, but for
Stat 245 the notes are more interactive than those I use in Stat 145. It is up to the students to read the book
and to grasp the essentials of the concepts. In class, we work through examples, do simulations, use applets,
and engage in an interactive lecture.
In Stat 145, one lecture period is allotted for review for the midterm exam and two periods for the
final exam. Quiz review is handled in recitation. For the midterm and final exams, I supply review sheets
containing problems similar to those that will be on the exams but that focus on all of the concepts. I
always tell my students that if they understand the concepts, they can answer any question, but if they
concentrate only on certain types of questions, they might struggle with the concepts. Because of this, I do
not provide practice exams. Students have both the midterm review and the final exam review in their
note packets, so they can start working on those problems at any time. On the days of review, I ask them
which concepts they found most difficult, and we concentrate on those questions first before moving on
to others (time allowing). Because there is never enough time to finish all of the review questions, I release
solutions to the reviews prior to the exams so that students can compare their solutions with mine.
Lab Component
Recitation is the place where students get to ask questions about homework, work on activities, do student
presentations, and so forth. The recitations are held in computer labs, so students can actively work with
StatCrunch in the lab. Each recitation room also has an instructor podium, which allows the graduate
teaching associates (GTAs) to project what they are demonstrating for the entire class. In the PC rooms, we
have NetSupport School classroom management software, which allows the instructor to project her or his
screen onto the students computer screens and project one students screen onto the screen at the front of
the class. The instructor can also shut down the computers when they are not being used in recitation so
that students cannot surf the Web or send e-mail during class.
71
Chapter 3
1
Recitations take many different forms, depending on the GTA in charge. As part of a functional and
productive instructional team, the GTAs share ideas with each othersuch as which activities to include
(see my Student Activities section for a few examples), prep questions that students work on before
coming to recitation, knowledge checks (mini-quizzes), and how to approach difficult concepts. I like to
give the associates room to teach in a style that works best for them (and their students) but to also provide
some framework, with extra exercises from the book that they might choose to work on if they cannot
think of something else to doflexibility within a structure is how we all look at it.
All GTAs have their students work in groups for at least some of the time during recitation. Last
quarter we tried having students work in groups on smaller, more frequent homework assignments
(compared with our control group, which had fewer, longer, individual homework assignments). This
quarter we had the students do the more frequent homework individually. We have not yet done a final
analysis, but preliminary results indicate that the more frequent group work was not as effective as the
longer individual homework.
Student Evaluation
Statistics 145
Students grades for the course are based on the following components:
Homework (20 percent)
Recitation participation (10 percent)
Quizzes (20 percent)
Midterm exam (20 percent)
Final exam (30 percent)
There are 78 homework assignments every quarter, each consisting of 611 exercises from the
textbook. Each assignment is worth 20 points. Ten points are earned for completion of the homework,
andthe other 10 are awarded, as appropriate, for accuracy of the solutions. Each GTA grades from a rubric
that I provide at the beginning of the quarter. Regardless of the number of assignments, homework counts
as 20 percent of the students grade. For example, if there are 8 homework assignments during a quarter,
each is worth 2.5 percent of the students total grade.
Recitation participation is loosely based on attendance and performance on specified activities. Each
GTA has the latitude to determine how recitation participation will be graded, but the students are aware
of this structure from the GTAs syllabus. Here are examples of recitation participation guidelines from two
different associates:
Your recitation participation grade will be determined in the following manner: Each
recitation is worth 10 points. You will receive 4 points just for attending recitation (only
1 point if you are tardy or leave early) and 6 points for participating in the activity (this
includes actively listening, making comments, doing board work, and turning in any
worksheets done in class). There are 19 classes this quarter, making the total number
of points you can earn 190. I will take the total number of points you earn out of 170
to calculate your participation percentage. (You cannot get more than 100 percent for
participationeven if you attend and participate in all 19 classes.)
72
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Your recitation attendance and participation grade will be determined in the following manner:
5 percent knowledge checks
Knowledge checks are very short closed-book, closed-notes assessments and are designed
to help you stay up-to-date with your readings and studying for the course. They are given
at the beginning of designated recitations and last about five minutes. You will not be
given extra time for the knowledge check if you are late or miss recitation that day. For this
reason, I will drop your lowest knowledge-check score. Also note that I will give you about
10 to 20 questions to study for each knowledge check and then choose only a handful of
them for the in-class assessment.
Each of the two quizzes given in recitation is worth 10 percent of a students grade. Each GTA reviews for
the quiz for about 25 minutes, and then students are given 20 to 25 minutes to take the quiz. Quizzes are
typically made up of 3 or 4 multiple-choice questions and 2 free-response questions. Students are allowed
to use one 3 by 5 inch notecard (both sides) with whatever facts, formulas, and examples they want for each
quiz. Statistical tables are provided as necessary.
The midterm is given in the evening so that students from both daytime lectures and from the evening
lecture can take the exam at the same time. It usually consists of 10 multiple-choice questions and 3 or4
free-response questions. Students are allowed to use one 8 by 11 inch sheet of paper (both sides) with
whatever facts, formulas, and examples they want for the midterm. Statistical tables are provided as
necessary.
The final exam is also given at a single time on the first evening of finals week. Typically, it has
15 multiple-choice questions and 5 or 6 free-response questions. Students are allowed to use two
8 by 11 inch sheets of paper (both sides) with whatever facts, formulas, and examples they want for
the final. Statistical tables are provided as necessary.
Statistics 245
Students grades are determined based on the following components:
There are approximately 10 homework assignments, each of which consists of 611 exercises from
the textbook. Every homework assignment is worth 20 points. Ten of these points are for completion of
the homework, and 10 points are awarded for accuracy. Each GTA grades from a rubric that I provide
atthe beginning of the quarter. Regardless of the number of homework assignments, homework counts as
20percent of the students grade. For example, if there are 10 homework assignments during a quarter, each
is worth 2 percent of the students total grade.
The two in-quarter exams are given during a lecture period. A typical exam consists of 1015 true/false
questions and 3 or 4 free-response questions. Students are allowed to use one 8 by 11 inch sheet of paper
(both sides) with whatever facts, formulas, and examples they want to use. Statistical tables are provided as
necessary.
73
Chapter 3
1
The final exam is given during the time allotted for our course during finals week. It contains 2025
true/false questions and 56 free-response questions. Students are allowed to use two 8 by 11 inch sheets
of paper (both sides) with whatever facts, formulas, and examples they want to have available. Statistical
tables are provided as necessary.
A 93100 percent
A 9092 percent
B+ 8789 percent
B 8386 percent
B 8082 percent
C+ 7779 percent
C 7376 percent
C 7072 percent
D 6069 percent
F below 60 percent
Teacher Resources
Primary Textbooks and Related Resources
Statistics 145
De Veaux, Richard D., Paul F. Velleman, and David E. Bock. Intro Stats. 2nd ed. Boston: Pearson/AddisonWesley, 2006.
De Veaux, Richard D., Paul F. Velleman, and David E. Bock. TestGen. CD-ROM. 2nd ed.
Boston: Pearson/Addison-Wesley, 2006. Computerized test bank. Must be used in conjunction with
Pearsons TestGen application:
http://wpslive.pearsoncmg.com/wps/media/access/Pearson_Default/720/737317/testgen_login.html.
De Veaux, Richard D., Paul F. Velleman, David E. Bock, and William B. Craine III. Instructors Solutions
Manual for Intro Stats. 2nd ed. Boston: Pearson/Addison-Wesley, 2006.
Miller, Jackie, Richard D. De Veaux, Paul F. Velleman, and David E. Bock. Printed Test Bank and Resource
Guide. 2nd ed. Boston: Pearson/Addison-Wesley, 2006.
Statistics 245
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. 3rd ed. Belmont,
Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2008.
Internet Resources
ARTIST (Assessment Resource Tools for Improving Statistical Thinking).
https://app.gen.umn.edu/artist/index.html.
Provides a variety of assessment resources for teaching first courses in statistics.
74
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
CAUSEweb.
www.causeweb.org.
Web site for the Consortium for the Advancement of Undergraduate Statistics Education, a national
organization whose mission is to support and advance undergraduate statistics education in four
target areas: resources, professional development, outreach, and research.
Moore, David S. Statistical Applets for The Practice of Statistics, 5th ed.
http://bcs.whfreeman.com/ips5e.
Scroll down to Student Tools and click on Statistical Applets. (You can also go to www.whfreeman.com,
click on Statistics, and search for Moore to find other texts that may have linked applets.)
StatCrunch: Data Analysis on the Web.
www.statcrunch.com.
Student Activities
The following pages contain two activities that have been developed for Stat 145 and structured with
instructions for the teacher. These activities (and others) have been submitted to CAUSEweb (www.
causeweb.org) for inclusion in the peer-reviewed activities there. Although these activities and their
overviews have not been copyrighted, please give credit to Beau Corkins, Marian Frazier, and Jackie Miller,
all of Ohio State University, when using them.
75
Chapter 3
1
More formal assessment will generally occur later, in quiz or exam questions. Sample questions include
the following:
Present a graphical display (bar chart, pie chart), and ask students to report some result in context.
Ask them to calculate the conditional or marginal distribution.
Given the conditional distribution, are two variables independent?
Teaching Notes
This activity can be done in class or assigned as out-of-class work. If this is the first time that
students are using the technology, we suggest that it be done in class so they can ask questions and
collaborate. The activity works extremely well with pairs or groups of three.
This activity is not dependent on any particular choice of technology. However, students cannot
perform the necessary work on their calculators, so they must have access to some statistical
computer package.
As mentioned above, many of the students questions will focus on how to use the technology. We
recommend letting the students work together to explore the computer package: encourage them
to play around and find the answer themselves. Of course, the instructor should be available and
knowledgeable about the package and how to create every display in the activity.
76
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Time arrived = hour:minutes
Delivery time = time arrived minus time ordered (in minutes)
Pizzas = number of pizzas ordered
Other items = indicates if something besides pizza was also ordered (yes/no)
Actual - Estimate = delivery time minus estimate (that is, positive values mean the pizza was late)
(a-e) = 1 if the pizza was late, 1 if the pizza was early, 0 if the pizza was exactly on time
Questions
[The solutions appear in boldface throughout.]
1. On StatCrunch, load the file pizza.
2. Create a bar chart of store. What store has the largest proportion of orders on this list?
Papa Johns
3. Create a pie chart of the marginal distribution of late status (whether the pizza was early, on time,
or late). Are most pizzas early, late, or on time?
The majority of pizzas are early.
4. Open the bar chart (no. 2) and pie chart (no. 3) side-by-side. Notice that by clicking on a section of
the pie chart, StatCrunch highlights those stores that make up that section. Which two stores appear
to have the highest percentages of late pizzas?
Store 1: Adriaticos
Store 2: Pizza Hut
5. Create a contingency table of store versus late status (whether the pizza was early, on time, or late).
Include in this contingency table the values row percent, column percent, and percent of total.
Contingency Table Results
Rows: store
Columns: sign(ae)
Cell format
Count
(Row percent)
(Column percent)
(Percent of total)
77
Chapter 3
1
Total
7
(35%)
(6.25%)
(3.535%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
13
(65%)
(18.84%)
(6.566%)
20
(100.00%)
(10.1%)
(10.1%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
2
(100%)
(11.76%)
(1.01%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
2
(100.00%)
(1.01%)
(1.01%)
Catfish Biffs
10
(71.43%)
(8.929%)
(5.051%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
4
(28.57%)
(5.797%)
(2.02%)
14
(100.00%)
(7.071%)
(7.071%)
Domino\s
7
(58.33%)
(6.25%)
(3.535%)
2
(16.67%)
(11.76%)
(1.01%)
3
(25%)
(4.348%)
(1.515%)
12
(100.00%)
(6.061%)
(6.061%)
Donatos
15
(53.57%)
(13.39%)
(7.576%)
4
(14.29%)
(23.53%)
(2.02%)
9
(32.14%)
(13.04%)
(4.545%)
28
(100.00%)
(14.14%)
(14.14%)
East of Chicago
5
(55.56%)
(4.464%)
(2.525%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
4
(44.44%)
(5.797%)
(2.02%)
9
(100.00%)
(4.545%)
(4.545%)
Eddy\s
1
(100%)
(0.8929%)
(0.5051%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
1
(100.00%)
(0.5051%)
(0.5051%)
Grandad\s
1
(100%)
(0.8929%)
(0.5051%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
1
(100.00%)
(0.5051%)
(0.5051%)
Gumby\s
9
(69.23%)
(8.036%)
(4.545%)
2
(15.38%)
(11.76%)
(1.01%)
2
(15.38%)
(2.899%)
(1.01%)
13
(100.00%)
(6.566%)
(6.566%)
HoundDog\s
5
(83.33%)
(4.464%)
(2.525%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
1
(16.67%)
(1.449%)
(0.5051%)
6
(100.00%)
(3.03%)
(3.03%)
Adriatico\s
Ange\s
78
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Total
Kings
3
(50%)
(2.679%)
(1.515%)
1
(16.67%)
(5.882%)
(0.5051%)
2
(33.33%)
(2.899%)
(1.01%)
6
(100.00%)
(3.03%)
(3.03%)
Monkey
4
(66.67%)
(3.571%)
(2.02%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
2
(33.33%)
(2.899%)
(1.01%)
6
(100.00%)
(3.03%)
(3.03%)
Ohio State
2
(100%)
(1.786%)
(1.01%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
2
(100.00%)
(1.01%)
(1.01%)
Papa John\s
33
(60%)
(29.46%)
(16.67%)
3
(5.455%)
(17.65%)
(1.515%)
19
(34.55%)
(27.54%)
(9.596%)
55
(100.00%)
(27.78%)
(27.78%)
Peppercini\s
1
(100%)
(0.8929%)
(0.5051%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
1
(100.00%)
(0.5051%)
(0.5051%)
8
(38.1%)
(7.143%)
(4.04%)
3
(14.29%)
(17.65%)
(1.515%)
10
(47.62%)
(14.49%)
(5.051%)
21
(100.00%)
(10.61%)
(10.61%)
Rotolo\s
1
(100%)
(0.8929%)
(0.5051%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
1
(100.00%)
(0.5051%)
(0.5051%)
Total
112
(56.57%)
(100.00%)
(56.57%)
17
(8.586%)
(100.00%)
(8.586%)
69
(34.85%)
(100.00%)
(34.85%)
198
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
Pizza Hut
6. Prove your assertion in question 4 by finding the conditional distribution of late status given Store 1
and the conditional distribution of late status given Store 2.
Adriaticos %
Late
65%
On time 0%
Early
35%
Pizza Hut
%
Late
47.6%
On time
14.3%
Early
38.1%
79
Chapter 3
1
7. If an ordered pizza is randomly selected, find the probability that it was from Dominos and that it
was early.
3.535%
8. Do time of day and late status appear to be independent? Justify your answer.
For this, we made a contingency table of time of day versus late status (see below). Although
daytime and nighttime have very similar conditional distributions, and dinnertime and evening
are similar, the two groups (day/night and dinner/evening) are very different from each other.
Based on this, we conclude that time of day and late status are not independent variables.
Late
Total
Daytime
15
(45.45%)
(13.39%)
(7.576%)
1
(3.03%)
(5.882%)
(0.5051%)
17
(51.52%)
(24.64%)
(8.586%)
33
(100.00%)
(16.67%)
(16.67%)
Dinnertime
43
(59.72%)
(38.39%)
(21.72%)
6
(8.333%)
(35.29%)
(3.03%)
23
(31.94%)
(33.33%)
(11.62%)
72
(100.00%)
(36.36%)
(36.36%)
Evening
36
(63.16%)
(32.14%)
(18.18%)
9
(15.79%)
(52.94%)
(4.545%)
12
(21.05%)
(17.39%)
(6.061%)
57
(100.00%)
(28.79%)
(28.79%)
Nighttime
18
(50%)
(16.07%)
(9.091%)
1
(2.778%)
(5.882%)
(0.5051%)
17
(47.22%)
(24.64%)
(8.586%)
36
(100.00%)
(18.18%)
(18.18%)
112
(56.57%)
(100.00%)
(56.57%)
17
(8.586%)
(100.00%)
(8.586%)
69
(34.85%)
(100.00%)
(34.85%)
198
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
Total
80
On Time
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
9. Are pizzas more likely to be late during the week (MTh) or on the weekend (FSun)? Why do you
think this is?
For this, we made a contingency table of day of week versus late status (see below). Looking at
row percent, a higher percentage of pizzas are late during the week. Specifically, Tuesday has
the highest percentage of late pizzas versus early/on-time ones. Looking at column percent, the
highest percentage of late pizzas throughout the week come from weekdays. A possible reason for
this is that the pizza places are better staffed on the weekends. They know demand will be high
then, so they have a lower percentage of late deliveries.
81
Chapter 3
1
Early
On Time
Late
Total
Friday
9
(64.29%)
(8.036%)
(4.545%)
0
(0%)
(0%)
(0%)
5
(35.71%)
(7.246%)
(2.525%)
14
(100.00%)
(7.071%)
(7.071%)
Monday
20
(55.56%)
(17.86%)
(10.1%)
4
(11.11%)
(23.53%)
(2.02%)
12
(33.33%)
(17.39%)
(6.061%)
36
(100.00%)
(18.18%)
(18.18%)
Saturday
24
(66.67%)
(21.43%)
(12.12%)
2
(5.556%)
(11.76%)
(1.01%)
10
(27.78%)
(14.49%)
(5.051%)
36
(100.00%)
(18.18%)
(18.18%)
Sunday
18
(66.67%)
(16.07%)
(9.091%)
3
(11.11%)
(17.65%)
(1.515%)
6
(22.22%)
(8.696%)
(3.03%)
27
(100.00%)
(13.64%)
(13.64%)
Thursday
15
(51.72%)
(13.39%)
(7.576%)
2
(6.897%)
(11.76%)
(1.01%)
12
(41.38%)
(17.39%)
(6.061%)
29
(100.00%)
(14.65%)
(14.65%)
Tuesday
8
(30.77%)
(7.143%)
(4.04%)
5
(19.23%)
(29.41%)
(2.525%)
13
(50%)
(18.84%)
(6.566%)
26
(100.00%)
(13.13%)
(13.13%)
Wednesday
18
(60%)
(16.07%)
(9.091%)
1
(3.333%)
(5.882%)
(0.5051%)
11
(36.67%)
(15.94%)
(5.556%)
30
(100.00%)
(15.15%)
(15.15%)
112
(56.57%)
(100.00%)
(56.57%)
17
(8.586%)
(100.00%)
(8.586%)
69
(34.85%)
(100.00%)
(34.85%)
198
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
(100.00%)
Total
82
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
of the activity, students should have received an introduction to hypothesis testing. The activity discusses
the connection between confidence intervals and hypothesis testing, but it is not necessary that the
students see this beforehand.
In this activity, students try to determine whether Mars, Inc., is accurate in its claim that 20 percent of
plain M&Ms are orange. The data for this activity are collected by students in small groups. Each group
takes a sample of M&Ms (how many is determined by the class) and counts what percentage are orange.
Each group then constructs and interprets its own confidence interval based on that groups sample data.
Then they are asked to compare their results (and those of the entire class) to what we expect given
Marss claim.
The second part of the activity explores this question through hypothesis testing. Because this is
probably the first activity that students have done with testing, they are taken step-by-step through the
process. Again, they interpret their results and compare them to those of the entire class, Mars, and their
own results from part 1.
Assessment
The activity is not structured to include any formal assessment. However, assessment can certainly occur
through discussion, both classwide and one-on-one. Several parts of this activity lend themselves to
discussion. The first section (on checking conditions) is meant as a whole-class discussion and decisionmaking process. The interpretation of confidence intervals and conclusions from testing will probably lead
to spirited exchanges among group members, as will question 5b in part 1. Questions 6 and 7 (part 1) and
question 5 (part 2) require the whole class to report and discuss their results and what conclusion they can
make about those results.
More formal assessment will generally occur later, in quiz or exam questions. Questions will most
likely give students a sample statistic and require them to construct a confidence interval or perform a
hypothesis test at some confidence level. Another type of question might identify a confidence level and the
results of a hypothesis test and ask students to compare the results or explain how the two are related.
Teaching Notes
This activity is designed for in-class, group work. It would not be as helpful in an individual, out-ofclass situation. The activity works extremely well with several pairs or groups of three.
This activity is not dependent on any particular choice of technology. In fact, it requires no higher
statistical packageall work can be done on a basic calculator, with access to a standard normal table.
instructor should encourage (and be prepared for) differences in ideas and opinions. For this reason,
time constraints may be an issue; instructors should budget time wisely so that this discussion time
does not suffer.
83
Chapter 3
1
b. Randomization condition
We must sample in a way that is random: pouring the candies from a bag or using a random
dispenser are possibilities.
c. 10 percent conditionis the sample size no more than 10 percent of the population?
ecause the population of M&Ms is so vast, we can assume that our sampling is not imposing
B
any dependence. Our M&Ms are from the same bag, however, and that may be a concern with
respect to independence.
Check.
We must sample enough M&Ms to insure that np > 10. Because p = .20, this means that at
least 50 M&Ms are necessary. Thus, you might want to put the students in pairs or small
groups, in the interest of saving time and money.
Decide, based on these conditions, how we will sample, including how many M&Ms per person.
If we are interested in the proportion of all M&Ms that are orange, what are the parameter, p, and
the statistic, p ? What is your value of p ?
3. Estimate the standard error for your p . (Hint: Remember the sampling distribution of p from
chapter 18.)
p (1 p )
SE( p )
n
4. Construct an approximate 68 percent confidence interval and an approximate 95 percent confidence
interval for p, the true percentage of M&Ms that are orange. Remember to interpret these intervals
in context!
p (1 p )
68 percent confidence interval: p 0.994
n
p (1 p )
95 percent confidence interval: p 1.96
n
84
Interpretation:
We are 68 percent confident that the true proportion of orange M&Ms is between
Or:
and
If this study was repeated many times, and if each time we randomly drew x M&Ms, found
the proportion of those that were orange, and constructed a 68 percent confidence interval, we
would expect approximately 68 percent of those intervals to contain p, the true proportion of
orange M&Ms. The interpretation for the 95 percent confidence interval should be analogous to
that of the 68 percent confidence interval.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
5. Mars claims that 20 percent of plain M&Ms are orange
(http://us.mms.com/us/about/products/milkchocolate/). Did your 68 percent confidence interval
contain the p 0.2 figure advertised by the company? Did your 95 percent confidence interval
contain this figure?
If their interval contains 0.2, students will certainly say it is reasonable. If the interval does
not, they may say that it is reasonable (it almost contains 0.2; this is only one sample) or
unreasonable (0.2 is not anywhere near the interval).
b. How big would your confidence interval have to be so that p 0.2 is within the limits? That is,
what is the confidence level of the narrowest interval that still contains 0.2?
For a given p :
Recall that the general form of a confidence interval is
p (1 p )
p (1 p )
p z *
,p z *
.
n
n
We want 0.2 to be on the edge of this interval. If0.2 p , students should set
p (1 p )
p (1 p )
0.2
0.2 and solve for z*. (If 0.2 ! p , set p z *
p z *
n
n
and solve for z*.) This will give the z* for the narrowest interval that contains 0.2. Then use
the standard normal table to find the corresponding confidence level.
6. We will now look at everyones intervals:
Of the intervals that do not include 0.2, how many are too high (above 0.2)? How many are too low?
We ask this because it may be that your class has values that are systematically too high or too
low, leading to the conclusion (below) that there are more (or less) than 20 percent orange M&Ms.
7. Discuss: Do you think that there are, in fact, 20 percent orange M&Ms?
Obviously, this will depend on your classes results. Things to point out include how many high/
low intervals there are (see above), issues with sampling variability, and so forth.
Hypotheses:
H 0 : p 0. 2
H a : p 0. 2
We have no a priori reason to believe that p 0.2 or p ! 0.2 specifically, so test the general
two-sided alternative.
85
Chapter 3
1
2. Model:
Success/failure: It is hoped that all students had (at least) 10 orange M&Ms in their samples
(assuming samples of size 50).
p(1 p)
n
3. Mechanics:
You want to compare your data to what we would expect if the null model were true. Thus, your z
value is . . .
p 0.2
z
0.02(0.98)
n
. . . and your P-value is . . .
P-value = 2P (Z !| z |)
Talk about what level they compared this to. Do not institute a mindless = 0.05.rule with no
justification!
5. Discuss: Does this agree with what you decided in part 1 about Marss claim? What about everyone
else? How many of your classmates rejected the null hypothesis?
86
Here, have them look at whether they reached the same conclusion as in part 1. This should
lead to a discussion of the relationship between confidence intervals and hypothesis testing.
The number who rejected here should be (almost) the same as those who had intervals not
containing 0.2.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 3
Michael Allwood
Brunswick School
Greenwich, Connecticut
School Profile
Location and Environment: Brunswick is a pre-K12 boys private day school in Greenwich, a town at the
southwestern tip of Connecticut. Brunswicks Upper School (grades 912) has a coordinated arrangement
with Greenwich Academy, the girls private school located close by, and the boys and girls take academic
courses on both campuses. Thus, the high school boys interact with the girls in academic, artistic, and
social contexts, with the rest of their school life (student governments, athletics, publications) being a
single-sex experience. The schools mathematics departments, however, have opted to work separately,
based on research that has shown that girls learn mathematics more effectively in a single-sex environment.
Brunswick parents take a strong interest in their sons education, so we are lucky to have students who
are willing to work very hard for academic success. Consequently, the schools college record is impressive,
with all of our students attending college and nearly 90 percent of our graduates going on to schools
designated by Barrons Educational Series as highly competitive or most competitive.
Grades: Prekindergarten12
Type: College-preparatory boys day school
Total Enrollment: 884
Ethnic Diversity: African American, 4.7 percent; Hispanic/Latino, 3.4 percent; Asian American, 3.3
percent; Middle Eastern American, 0.7 percent; Native American, 0.1 percent; multiracial, 3.0 percent.
College Record: All of our graduates go on to four-year colleges.
Personal Philosophy
Most of the students who take AP Statistics at Brunswick do so because they like math, and teaching the
course gives me the opportunity to show how mathematics and mathematical thinking can be applied
to important real-life situations. The AP Statistics Exam requires of the student a true understanding of
the material included in the course, and 75 percent of its content is descriptive and/or interpretative. In
recognition of this, I encourage in-depth discussion of the concepts underlying statistical thinking and of
the process of applying these ideas to the everyday issues that are raised in class. Some of the more complex
principles are clarified by means of classroom activities, and throughout the course I emphasize the need
for written explanations that employ correct use of terminology and that are clear, precise, and concise.
Class Profile
Each year the school offers either one or two sections of AP Statistics, depending on the number of students
choosing the course. When we have had two sections, the two teachers have followed the same curriculum
and given the same tests. Currently, we have one section of 15 students. Generally, we prefer that students
take AP Statistics only as a second math course, and those who enroll in this class must have previously
taken, or concurrently be taking, Precalculus. All students in the course take the AP Exam.
87
Chapter 3
1
Brunswicks Upper School operates on a seven-day rotating schedule, in which each class meets for an
hour on five school days in every seven. The schools academic year runs from September to June and is 33
weeks long, exclusive of breaks and holidays. It is divided into four quarters, with a midyear exam at the
end of the first semester. AP math classes do not meet after the AP Exams.
Course Overview
The topics are largely organized in the order in which they are presented in the textbook, with the main
exceptions being that the data collection unit is left until after bivariate data, and errors in hypothesis
testing and regression are left until the end of the course. Each student owns a TI-83 Plus or TI-84
calculator. A TI viewscreen with overhead projector is used in class (usually operated by a student).
Students are given a copy of the formula sheet used in the AP Exam at the start of the course. Copies of this
sheet are also provided during the tests.
Course Objectives
My aim is that students finishing the course should have attained the following competencies:
Know the facts and have the skills required by the AP Statistics Course Description
Have an intuitive understanding of the background of these facts and skills
Be able to explain and interpret statistical concepts with clear and refined use of language
Have gained experience in the application of statistical ideas to real-life situations
Have developed an appreciation for the relevance and significance of statistics in the real world
Texts
Our primary text is the second edition of Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis by Peck, Olsen, and
Devore. We also use the second edition of The Practice of Statistics by Yates, Moore, and Starnes. (See the
Teacher Resources section in this syllabus for full citations.)
Course Planner
Please note the following:
The timetable below represents the plan for a typical year. In any given year, it must always be
adapted according to the needs of the students, interruptions to the schedule, and so forth.
Possible examples and exercises from the textbook that might be used in each class or homework
assignment are listed in brackets at the end of each entry. Ex. refers to a worked example from
the textbook, in which the authors have provided a solution to the problem. Made-up exs.
refers to times when data from students are used, when data from a previous example are used to
demonstrate a new concept, or when numbers are generated on the spot. Items that are not preceded
by any abbreviation indicate an exercise from one of the textbooks problem sets.
The following abbreviations are used to indicate source material: POD = Peck, Olsen, Devore,
Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis; YMS = Yates, Moore, and Starnes, The Practice
of Statistics.
88
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Semester One
UNIT I: DATA SUMMARY AND DISPLAY
Class 1
(Some of Unit I is included in the previous years math course, so these items can be covered quickly.)
Stem-and-leaf displays; shapes of distributions; relationship of shape of stem-and-leaf display to pattern in
dotplot; mention of splitting stems in stem-and-leaf display; median and quartiles, interquartile range
(percentiles); middle 50 percent [Ex. 3.10, Ex. 3.15 (draw stemplot), 3.18 (adapted), made-up exs.]
Class 2
Use of calculator to find five-number summary; boxplots; parallel boxplots; comparing distributions [3.22
(adapted), 3.62, 4.34 (adapted), made-up exs.; and the main exercise from Matching Plots to Variables, in
Scheaffer et al., Activity-Based Statistics, p. 15]
AP tip: Comparing distributions is very important for the AP Exam: see the exam scoring guidelines
for detailse.g., 2005, free-response question no. 1(a).
Class 3
Outliers; outliers on calculator (modified boxplot); mean, variance, standard deviation; mean, variance,
standard deviation of frequency distribution; mean, variance, and standard deviation (including frequency
distributions) on calculator [3.28 (adapted), 3.32 (adapted), 4.37 (adapted), made-up exs.]
Class 4
Mean versus median and implication of skewness; sensitivity of mean and standard deviation to extreme
values; criteria for appropriateness of use of mean and standard deviation; discrete versus continuous data;
histograms; z-scores [3.28, 3.26, Ex. 4.19, 4.43, made-up exs.]
UNIT II: BIVARIATE DATA
Class 5
Scatterplots and correlation in general; drawing scatterplot on calculator and commenting; calculation of
correlation using calculator; range of values of correlation; correlation formula [5.6 (adapted), 5.12, 5.16,
made-up exs.]
Class 6
Test on Unit I
Class 7
Correlation: explanation of invariance under addition of a constant to all x- (or y-) values and under
multiplication of all x- (or y-) values by a constant; correlation versus causation; interpretation of
correlation value; introduction to regression; use of the calculator to find the equation of the regression line
and draw on graph [5.9, 5.12, 5.17, made-up exs.]
AP tip: The interpretation of the value of the correlation is very important for the AP Exam: see the
exam scoring guidelines for detailse.g., 2002, free-response question no. 4.
Class 8
Definition of regression line in terms of least squares; least-squares activity (see the Student Activities
section in this syllabus for details); formulas for slope and y-intercept; how to state the equation of the
regression line [5.19, 5.21]
AP tip: When stating the equation of the regression line, AP Exam questions require definition of any
variables used, along with the word predicted applied to the y-variable.
89
Chapter 3
1
Class 9
Interpretation of slope and y-intercept of the regression line; extrapolation; outliers in bivariate context;
influential points; calculator demonstration for influential points (see Calculator Demonstrations in my
Student Activities section for details) [5.34, 5.36, Ex. 5.10 (adapted)]
AP tip: Correct interpretation of the slope and y-intercept of the regression line are important for the
AP Exam: see exam scoring guidelines for detailse.g., 1999, free-response question no. 1.
Class 10
Use of residual plot to show if a straight line is the best model; sum of squares of residuals and its relevance;
calculator demonstration for residual plots (see Calculator Demonstrations in my Student Activities
section for details); introduction to coefficient of determination [5.32, 5.33, made-up exs.]
Class 11
Coefficient of determination, r2; reading computer displays in bivariate context; calculation of b, a, and
r without statistical features of the calculator; equation on formula sheet relating b and r [5.41, 5.42,
made-up exs.]
The coefficient of determination: This is one of the trickiest concepts in the course. I have found it
best to explain the idea in the following way: When all the points lie on a straight line, there is some
variability in the y-values but it is all explained by the x variable (if I know the x value, I know the
y value exactly); one y value is higher than another because the associated x value is higher (positive
association). When the points are moved off the line, there is unexplained variability in the y-values. In
this second situation, some of the variability in the y-values can be attributed to variation of y with x
according to the line (as in the first situation), and the remainder can be attributed to the fact that the
points are not on the line. The proportion of the y-variability that is explained by the variation of y
with x according to the line is r2. When points are close to the line, the unexplained variability is low.
When points are far from the line, the line has low predictive ability.
UNIT III: COLLECTING DATA (1)
Class 12
Difference between observational study and experiment; limitation of observational study; confounding
variables [2.27, 2.28, 2.35, 2.36, 2.37]
Class 13
Test on Unit II
Class 14
Simple experimental concepts: population; use of volunteers; randomization (and why); control group and
its purpose; generalization; replication; direct control [2.28, 2.30, 2.44, 2.48ae]
Class 15
Placebo effect; use of placebo; blinding (single and double); how to randomize [2.54, 2.57 (adapted)]
AP tip: In AP Exam free-response questions on experimental design, students are required to include a
description of how the treatments are randomizede.g., 2006, question no. 5(b).
Class 16
Blocking; summary of experimental design [2.40, 2.43, 2.45]
Blocking: This should be explained in terms of reduction of variability in order to more easily discern
the effect of the explanatory variable. For further explanation, see YMS, p. 303.
90
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Class 17
PBS video: The Wonder Pill (about the placebo effect)
UNIT IV: COLLECTING DATA (2) / PROBABILITY (1)
Class 18
Census; simple random sample (SRS); stratified sample; cluster sample; systematic sample; convenience
sample [2.6, 2.8, 2.11ad]
Class 19
Test on Unit III
Class 20
Bias in general; selection bias; response bias; measurement bias; nonresponse bias (note that small sample
size is not a source of bias) [2.16, 2.17, 2.25]
Class 21
Probability using Venn diagrams; probability notation involving unions, intersections, complements;
addition rule [sheet of problems]
Probability: This topic is covered in considerable detail in the textbook, but in order to allow time for
the remainder of the course, I have found it necessary to condense my approach. The order of subtopics
given here is the one I have found to be most efficient.
Class 22
Mutually exclusive events; conditional probability [sheet continued]
Class 23
Review and extension of conditional probability; definition and explanation of independent events
[6.39c, 6.49, made-up exs.]
Class 24
Problems involving independent events; probability of at least one [6.47, 6.48 (adapted), 6.50]
UNIT V: PROBABILITY (2) / RANDOM VARIABLES
Class 25
Tree diagrams [made-up exs.]
Class 26
Test on Unit IV
[End of First Quarter]
Class 27
Tree diagrams continued; Bayes rule [6.71, 6.72, 6.73]
Bayes rule: For this I follow the method essentially as given on p. 323. I omit the formula given
on p. 324.
Class 28
Random variables; discrete versus continuous; probability distributions; graphical representation [7.11, 7.12,
7.14, 7.16, 7.18]
91
Chapter 3
1
Class 29
Continuous random variables; probability density functions [7.23, 7.24, 7.26]
Class 30
Mean, variance, and standard deviation of discrete random variable; formulas for expected value and
variance of aX + b [7.29, 7.33, 7.40]
UNIT VI: BINOMIAL AND GEOMETRIC DISTRIBUTIONS
Class 31
Binomial distribution [made-up exs.]
Class 32
Test on Unit V
Class 33
Binomial distribution continued; use of binompdf and binomcdf on calculator [7.46, 7.49, 7.55ab]
Binomial probabilities: In order to familiarize students with the basic binomial probability formula, I
assign problems in which use of binompdf or binomcdf is not allowed.
Class 34
Mean and standard deviation of binomial distribution; geometric distribution; introduction to normal
distribution (intuitive only) [7.54, 7.55cd, 7.62, made-up exs.]
Distinguishing distributions: The Unit VI test includes a question that requires students to differentiate
between random variables that are binomially distributed, geometrically distributed, normally
distributed, or none of these.
Class 35
Test on Unit VI
UNIT VII: NORMAL DISTRIBUTION / MEAN AND VARIANCE FORMULAS
Class 36
Normal distribution problems: finding probabilities and the inverse normal function [7.73ad, 7.77, 7.78]
Class 37
Normal distribution problems: finding mean and/or standard deviation [sheet of problems]
Class 38
Review of mean, variance, and standard deviation of aX + b; mean, variance, and standard deviation of
X + Y; mean, variance, and standard deviation of aX + bY [made-up exs.]
Class 39
Sums and differences of independent normally distributed random variables; conditional probability
problems involving normal distribution [sheet of problems]
UNIT VIII: SAMPLING DISTRIBUTIONS / DISTRIBUTION OF SAMPLE MEAN
Class 40
Overview of population parameters, sample statistics, and the use of a statistic to estimate a parameter
Class 41
Test on Unit VII
92
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Class 42
German tanks activity (see my Student Activities section for details)
Class 43
Sampling distributions; unbiased statistics; use of standard deviation to compare statistics [8.4, 8.6, 8.9]
Class 44
Distribution of sample mean; central limit theorem [8.20, 8.21, 8.24]
Class 45
Central limit theorem activity (see my Student Activities section for details)
Class 46
Test on Unit VIII
Classes 4752
Review for midyear exam, which is administered outside of class (see the Teaching Strategies section that
follows this Course Planner for details)
[End of Second Quarter]
Semester Two
UNIT IX: SIMULATION / INFERENCE (1)
Class 53
Simulation activity (see my Student Activities section for details)
Class 54
Simulation [sheet of problems]
Class 55
Normal approximation to binomial distribution; calculator demonstration (see Calculator
Demonstrations in my Student Activities section); distribution of a sample proportion [8.32, 8.34, 8.35]
Class 56
Confidence interval for a population proportion; margin of error; interpretation of confidence interval
and of confidence level [9.15, 9.23, 9.25]
Confidence intervals: The idea of a confidence interval is tricky for students. They need to understand
that it is the set of fixed parameter values that make feasible the sample results obtained.
AP tip: When a confidence interval is asked for in an AP Exam free-response question, students are
required to: (a) test the conditions for the process; (b) find the confidence limits using the appropriate
formula; and (c) interpret the interval in the context of the problem. While it is not always required,
students should also be able to write a coherent interpretation of the confidence level.
UNIT X: INFERENCE (2)
Class 57
Confidence interval for population mean; normal and t distributions [9.35ab, 9.38, 9.43]
Class 58
Test on Unit IX
93
Chapter 3
1
Class 59
Hypothesis test for population proportion; one-tail and two-tail [10.27, 10.28, 10.29]
AP tip: In any hypothesis test in an AP Exam free-response question, students are required to: (a) state
the hypotheses, defining any symbols used for the population parameters; (b) test the conditions for
the procedure to be used; (c) evaluate a test statistic using the correct formula and find the P-value;
and (d) reach a conclusion in the context of the problem, linking this conclusion with the P-value.
(Procedures involving critical values of the test statistic rather than P-values are also acceptable.)
Class 60
Hypothesis test for population mean: z and t tests [10.48, 10.49 (adapted), 10.57, 10.58]
AP tip: When the question does not state that the population(s) is/are normally distributed, where the
sample size(s) is/are not large, and where data values are given (as opposed to summary values such as
sample mean and standard deviation), it is necessary for students to check that the sample values make
reasonable the assumption that the population(s) is/are normally distributed. This involves drawing, for
example, a dotplot or boxplot and observing that the sample values show a distribution that is roughly
symmetric and includes no outliers.
Class 61
z and t tests for difference of population means (t test: only unpooled version) [11.24, 11.25, 11.26]
Class 62
Confidence interval for difference of two population means; review of confidence interval ideas in general
[11.12a, 11.18c]
UNIT XI: INFERENCE (3)
Class 63
Introduction to distribution of difference of two sample proportions
Class 64
Test on Unit X
Class 65
Hypothesis test for difference of two proportions; confidence interval for difference of two proportions;
relevance of confidence interval containing zero [11.54, 11.55, 11.56]
Class 66
Paired t test [11.32, 11.36, 11.39]
Class 67
Distinguishing between paired and two-sample t tests; paired and two-sample t confidence intervals
[11.38a, 11.72, 11.80]
UNIT XII: INFERENCE (4)
Class 68
Confidence intervals: required sample size for given margin of error [9.27, 9.46, 9.47]
Class 69
Test on Unit XI
94
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Class 70
Chi-square test for goodness of fit [12.7, 12.8, 12.9]
Calculator tip: The calculators lists can be used in an ingenious way to find the value of the test
statistic and the P-value: see YMS, p. 734, or POD, p. 670.
Class 71
Chi-square test for independence [12.20, 12.21]
Calculator tip: The chi-square test on the Stat, Tests menu evaluates the expected frequencies: see
POD, p. 673, or YMS, p. 754.
Class 72
Chi-square test for homogeneity; distinguishing between three types of chi-square test; inference activity
(see my Student Activities section for details) [12.16, 12.28, 12.36, 12.40, 12.42]
Classes 73 and 74
Inference activity continued
UNIT XIII: ERRORS IN HYPOTHESIS TESTING
Class 75
Introduction to Type I and II errors
Class 76
Test on Unit XII
[End of Third Quarter]
Class 77
Errors: problems involving description of Type I and II errors and their consequences [10.14, 10.17, 10.19]
Class 78
Discussion of effect on probability of Type I and II errors (and power) by changes in significance level and
sample size (and true value of parameter) [10.16, 10.20, 10.21]
Class 79
Quiz on Unit XIII
UNIT XIV: INFERENCE FOR REGRESSION / NONLINEAR REGRESSION
Class 80
t test for closeness to linear relationship (done on calculator) [13.21ab, 13.25]
Class 81
Confidence interval for slope of the regression line (and hypothesis test) by use of computer read-out and
by use of formula for sb given on the formula sheet [13.18a, 13.20 (adapted), 13.21 (adapted), 13.24b]
Class 82
Nonlinear regression: finding the best transformation by trial and error; prediction [sheet of problems]
Class 83
Nonlinear regression: use of residual plot; logarithmic transformations; implication of straight-line
logarithmic relationship in terms of original relationship [sheet continued]
95
Chapter 3
1
Class 84
Exponential and power relationships; prediction [sheet continued]
Class 85
Review and consolidation of Unit XIV
Class 86
Test on Unit XIV
Class 87
Cumulative relative frequency graphs; other minor topics missed during the year [Ex. 3.16, handout]
Classes 8894
Review for the AP Exam (see the Teaching Strategies section below for details)
[End of Fourth Quarter]
Teaching Strategies
A typical class begins with a quick verbal check to make sure that everyone has completed the previous
nights homework. I then run through the answers to that assignment, very often choosing students
randomly to read out their written explanations. (This method serves as excellent preparation for the
AP Exam, because students have an opportunity, on a daily basis, to think critically about their own
and their peers wording of statistical concepts.) Next, I introduce the main item of work to be explored
in that class, using data collected from the class or by means of an example from the textbook. I always
encourage discussion so that a real appreciation for the relevance and the essence of the topic is established.
If mathematical derivation of a formula is required, that work is also done at this stage. I then give the
students a further example to solve in class by themselves, or, if time is short, we discuss an example
as a class, talking about how each part of the problem should be tackled. Finally, I assign the next days
homework.
Most of the time, I either stand at the front of the room, using the whiteboard and/or leading class
discussion, or the students work on brief (ungraded) practice assignments, discussing their findings with
their neighbors as necessary. In the first of these two modalities, there is extensive questioningby me,
in order to encourage constructive and critical thought, and by the students, when clarification is needed.
Occasionally, in the context of project work, students use class time for data collection and later present the
results of their work to the rest of the class. The TI-83 (or -84) calculator is used extensively throughout the
course for calculation, graphical representation of data sets, and demonstration of concepts.
Throughout the course, test questions and review examples are designed to mimic the style of AP
Exam free-response questions, and the questions are graded according to criteria similar to those used
for the AP Exam. In order to encourage familiarity with the definitions and formulas involved, I often
ask students to do calculations without using the statistical features of the calculator. Prior to each test,
I hand out a set of review questions (usually the test questions from the previous year), and the students
are required to complete this for the class before the class on which the test is scheduled. When we then
go over this assignment in detail, they gain a good understanding of the test requirements and have the
opportunity to ask questions about items that may still confuse them. The remainder of that class is used to
begin the next unit of material.
96
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
For approaches to teaching specific topics, see the AP tips and other underlined suggestions and
recommendations throughout the Course Planner above. Much of the learning that goes on in my
classroom is based on the students working through designated problems and examples during the class
period, as noted in the daily schedule. Detailed descriptions of many of these exercises can be found in the
Student Activities section that begins on page 99.
AP Exam free-response questions are done in class and graded by peers according to published
scoring guidelines.
Student Evaluation
In the first three quarters, grades are based entirely on the students test scores. This is possibly unusual
and therefore deserves some explanation. First, all the students almost invariably do their nightly
homework assignments without the incentive of grades, and I further encourage full completion of this
work by the random selection of students to read out their written explanations. Second, I have found over
the years that projects and activities turn out to be more effective if they are not graded. The difference has,
in fact, been marked, with graded projects provoking a great deal of worry about the grading requirements,
whereas ungraded projects have been done thoughtfully and with enthusiasm. Third, owing to their
academic, athletic, and artistic commitments, our students tend to be under considerable time pressure.
Therefore, while retaining the aim for very high levels of achievement in the subject, I look for every
opportunity to reduce the demands put on the students by this, their second math course.
97
Chapter 3
1
Students take approximately four tests in each of the first three quarters. In the fourth quarter, I give
one test and one quiz, followed by several graded homework assignments consisting of past AP Exam
questions. In the fourth quarter, the graded homework assignments count for 60 percent of students
grades, with the remaining 40 percent coming from the test and the quiz.
Each of the first two quarters counts as 36 percent of the first semester grade. The midyear exam
accounts for the remaining 28 percent. In the second semester, the grade is formed by an average of the
third- and fourth-quarter grades. The course grade is the average of the first and second semesters.
Brunswick Schools grading scale is as follows:
A+
A
A
B+
B
B
C+
C
C
D+
D
D
98100 percent
9397 percent
9092 percent
8789 percent
8386 percent
8082 percent
7779 percent
7376 percent
7072 percent
6769 percent
6366 percent
062 percent
Teacher Resources
Primary Textbook
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. 2nd ed. Belmont,
Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2005.
98
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sternstein, Martin. Barrons AP Statistics: How to Prepare for the Advanced Placement Exam. 3rd ed.
Hauppauge, N.Y.: Barrons Educational Series, 2004.
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics: TI-83/89 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. 2nd ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Web/Video
AP Central.
apcentral.collegeboard.com.
I use this Web site for AP Exam free-response questions, scoring guidelines, and advice for students.
Scientific American Frontiers: The Wonder Pill. 2003. Hosted by Alan Alda. Distributed by PBS Home
Video. VHS. 60 minutes.
www.shoppbs.org.
Student Activities
Least Squares (Class 8)
Students are given graph paper and a set of about six points. Each student plots the points and then draws a
line in an attempt to minimize the sum of the squares of the vertical distances of the points from the line.
The sums of squares are collected and compared with the result for the true regression line produced by a
calculator. This last calculation is done by sum(lRESID2). You can also ask students to draw a good line
and ask how they will compare the lines to motivate the least-squares criteria.
99
Chapter 3
1
4. N+1N:L1(randInt(1,100))L2(N):N ENTER, ENTER, This repeatedly samples numbers
randomly from the population and enters them in L2, displaying the value of the counter, N, after
each sampling. Stop when N = 40.
5. Use 1-Var Stats L2 to find the sample mean. Type this sample mean into L3.
6. Repeat from step 3, recording as many sample means in L3 as time permits.
7. Link cords are then used to gather all the sample means as a list on the overhead calculator.
A histogram of the sample means is displayed and compared with the appropriate normal
distribution.
100
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
12. If there is time, a comparison can be made between the frequencies achieved in the runs of the
simulation and the frequencies predicted by the binomial distribution.
Calculator Demonstrations
Influential Points (Class 9)
This is to show that influential points tend to have extreme x values. Create a cluster of points with negative
correlation by seq(X,X,0,5,0.1)L1, 50.5L1+randNorm(0,0.5,51)L2. With a [0,20] by [0,20] window, make
a scatterplot with xlist=L1 and ylist=L2. Draw the regression line for this set. Show that adding the point
(2.5,15) has little effect on the regression line, whereas adding (12,5) has a large effect.
Residual Plots (Class 10)
This shows how the residual plot can reveal a curved pattern in what initially seems to be a linear
relationship. First enter seq(X,X,20,30,1)L1 and (10+L12)+randNorm(0,.002,11)L2. A scatterplot of L1
against L2 shows what appears to be a straight line, but a residual plot shows that a curve would provide a
better fit. Point out that the r value for the original set is close to 1, but this does not mean that a straight
line is the best fit.
Normal Approximation to Binomial Distribution (Class 55)
This is to demonstrate that the binomial distribution B(40, 0.6) is closely approximated by the normal
distribution N(400.6, (400.60.4)). Follow these steps:
1. seq(X,X,0,40)L1. (This stores the integers 0,1,,40 in L1.)
2. binompdf(40,.6) L2. (This stores the probabilities for B(40, 0.6) in L2.)
3. Using STAT PLOT, switch Plot 1 on as a histogram with Llist: L1 and Freq: L2.
4. Set up a window of [14.5, 34.5] by [0.5, 1.5] with Xscl = 1.
5. Using the Y= key, delete any functions that have been entered and make sure that only Plot 1 is on.
6. By pressing the GRAPH key, the histogram of B(40, 0.6) is displayed.
7. For the function Y1, enter normalpdf(X,40*.6,(40*.6*.4)).
8. Move the cursor to the left of Y1 and select the path graph style (the fifth option).
9. Again press GRAPH and watch the normal distribution curve being superimposed on the
histogram.
101
Chapter 3
1
Sample Syllabus 4
Anne M. Carroll
Kennett High School
Kennett Square, Pennsylvania
School Profile
Location and Environment: Kennett High School serves a diverse rural and suburban populace in
southern Chester County in the southeastern corner of Pennsylvania, close to the borders of Delaware
and Maryland. The cornerstone of our school was laid during the Great Depression in the 1930s. Located
in the historic borough of Kennett Square, a small town with a population of about 5,300, this recently
renovated school was the original single building of the Kennett Consolidated School District. In addition
to the high school, the district now consists of three elementary schools and one middle school spread over
several townships.
The area is a bedroom community for Wilmington, Delaware, with many parents employed by DuPont
and other chemical and pharmaceutical giants. Moreover, the greater Kennett area continues to provide a
large base of agricultural workers for the mushroom industry: Kennett Square is known as the mushroom
capital of the world. Large numbers of immigrants from Mexico provide the workforce for the agricultural
trade, and the transience of this population is a challenge to the educational system. Many households are
monolingual, and older students often come to the high school after not being in classes for many years.
Approximately 28 percent of the district population is eligible for free or reduced-fee lunches.
Grades: 912
Type: Public high school
Total Enrollment: 1,212
Ethnic Diversity: Hispanic/Latino, 32 percent; African American, 5 percent; Asian American, 1 percent.
College Record: Of our graduates, 69 percent go on to four-year colleges; 17 percent choose junior colleges,
community colleges, or technical schools; and 2 percent join the military.
Personal Philosophy
An understanding of statistics is necessary for anyone to be a savvy consumer, an informed citizen of a
democracy, and a successful student of many other disciplines. The AP Statistics course gives students an
opportunity to build a deep conceptual understanding of graphical analysis and statistical inference and
their roles in decision making. This course is the one that I wish that I had taken before the calculus-based
statistics I had at both the undergraduate and graduate mathematics levels. Students who take this course
are able to read information critically and to pursue further statistical studies, and I am gratified to be a
part of helping them to achieve these skills.
102
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Class Profile
Traditionally, Kennett High School has offered one section of AP Statistics with an enrollment of between
5 and 20 students, according to demand. We also offer a less demanding course called Applications of
Algebra/Statistics that includes one semester of statistics (the other semester is a review of Algebra 2 topics
and forms with emphasis on problem solving), as well as a stand-alone semester statistics course. The AP
course meets on a traditional schedule, five days a week for one period in an eight-period day. Classes
are 42 minutes long. The year is divided into two semesters, each having two marking periods. The first
semester concludes with a required midterm examination. All AP students are required to take the AP
Exam. Having done so, they are exempt from the second-semester examination. The course is available
to any student who has successfully completed Algebra 2 and who has either completed or is concurrently
enrolled in Analysis (Precalculus). Generally, students taking AP Statistics are juniors or seniors (although
sophomores have taken the course).
Course Overview
The basic textbook used for this class is The Practice of Statistics (second edition) by Yates, Moore, and
Starnes, hereafter referred to as YMS. (See the Teacher Resources section of this syllabus for a full citation.)
Expectations
This is a college-level class that moves at a fast pace. There is time for fun but no time for nonsense. It
is assumed that all students will show respect for themselves, for their peers, for the teacher, and for any
guests.
Attendance
Class attendance is essential to a students success in this course, where each day builds on the previous
days learning. Work missed because of class absence owing to illness or other excused reason must be
made up within the number of days missed. Any unexcused class absence results in no credit for the days
work.
Participation
Each student must participate in class. Participation includes bringing the necessary materials; preparation
(having homework, both written and study, complete); asking questions for clarification or exploration;
offering answers and insights; putting work on the board; working with partners or pair-sharing, as
appropriate to the assignment; tutoring other students; and supporting other students and a good
classroom environment. Students who participate in class are more alert and therefore get more out of
classroom instruction, experience better retention of information, and complete homework sessions in a
shorter time.
Materials
All students must have the following in class on a daily basis:
Chapter 3
1
One straightedge
Covered textbook
Graphing calculator (TI-83 Plus or TI-84 preferred if purchasing new)
Any student with financial need or for whom buying any of these supplies or paying for the AP Exam is a
hardship may make arrangements for funding through the school.
Binders
Each days notes must be kept in pen, with a topic and date. Homework that supports the notes is to be
done in pencil, with date and corresponding textbook page number. These exercises must be corrected
from the answers in the back of the book, as well as during pair-sharing sessions in class. All returned
quizzes, tests, labs, and special projects are to be corrected and integrated with the classroom notes.
Homework
It is expected that every student will spend at least one-half hour each night on written and study
homework, with perhaps more time on weekends or as labs/projects come due. Once a week, students
should review their notes for the entire course to keep all skills and concepts fresh. If this is done
consistently, an hour of study on the night before a test should be sufficient. Preparation time increases in
the weeks preceding the AP Exam.
Grading
Grades are computed on a cumulative-point basis (see the Student Evaluation section of my syllabus for
a complete explanation). Graded items include quizzes, tests, labs, projects, class participation, notebook
completeness and organization, and homework.
Tutorials
Tutoring is available to every student through a variety of means. I assist students by phone in the evening
or personally in the morning before homeroom period, during study halls when our schedules mesh, or
after school. E-mail questions are welcome from those who do not expect an immediate answer; often this
is a good way for students with a long-term absence to clarify their independent study efforts.
Course Objectives
By the end of this AP Statistics course, students should be able to do the following:
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Construct confidence intervals with z-, p-, t-, and regression statistics
Use calculator and computer technology and software to enhance understanding of statistics
Apply statistical methods to a research question
Course Planner
The following abbreviations and short titles are used to indicate source material: AP Test Prep = Preparing
for the Statistics AP Exam with Stats: Modeling the World, Second Edition (Carroll et al.); COMAP video
= For All Practical Purposes; GRB = Golden Resource Binder (instructors supplement to the textbook);
Precalculus = Demana et al., Precalculus; RVSL = Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics Web site; Sevin =
Discovering Statistics lab manual; Statistics video = The High-Stakes World of Statistics (Witzel et al.).
See the Teacher Resources section later in this syllabus for full citations.
Assessments appear in brackets in the Other column. All tests are chapter tests.
Assignments
(odd-numbered
Topic
Time Frame
Text
Other
problems
required)
***SEMESTER 1***
Introduction to statistics 1 day
pp. viixvii
Preview text;
COMAP video, prog. 6;
install Minitab GRB, special problem 0
Exploring Data (chapter 1)
Variables
1 day
pp. 17
Exer. 1.11.4
Examining distributions 35 days
Section 1.1
Exer. 1.51.30
RVSL: Histograms,
graphically
Bin Width, and Cross
Validation (Web
simulation); histogram
lab (Sevin)
[quiz 1.1]
Examining distributions 24 days
Section 1.2
Exer. 1.311.50 RVSL: Mean and Median
numerically
(Web simulation);
numerical summary
lab (Sevin)
[quiz 1.2]
Review
2 days
Chapter
Exer. 1.511.73 Statistics video, pt. 1
summary
[test]
Normal Distributions (chapter 2)
Density curves and
24 days
Section 2.1
Exer. 2.12.18
Minitab lab (GRB): special
normal distributions
problem 2A; assessing
normality lab (Sevin)
[quiz 2.1]
Standard normal
23 days
Section 2.2
Exer. 2.192.37
[quiz 2.2]
distribution
Review
2 days
Chapter
Exer. 2.382.54
[test]
summary
105
Chapter 3
1
Topic
106
Time Frame
Text
Assignments
(odd-numbered
problems
required)
Exer. 3.13.5
Exer. 3.63.23
Exer. 3.243.37
Least-squares regression
34 days
Section 3.3
Exer. 3.383.61
Review
2 days
Exer. 3.623.77
Transforming data
24 days
Chapter 3
summary
Section 4.1
Cautions:
Lurking
Confounding
Extrapolation
Causation
Categorical data
Review
23 days
Section 4.2
Exer. 4.274.49
12 days
2 days
Exer. 4.14.26
Section 4.3
Exer. 4.504.71
Chapter 4
Exer. 4.724.83
summary
End Marking Period 1
pp. 266-70
Section 5.1
Exer. 5.15.30
Experimental design
34 days
Section 5.2
Exer. 5.315.58
Simulation
34 days
Section 5.3
Exer. 5.595.72
Other
[quiz 4.24.3]
[test]
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Topic
Time Frame
Text
Assignments
(odd-numbered
problems
required)
Exer. 5.745.88
Review
2 days
Chapter
summary
Probability (chapter 6)
Randomness
12 days
pp. 326-30
12 days
23 days
Section 6.1
Exer. 6.16.10
34 days
Section 6.2
Exer. 6.116.44
Section 6.3
(pp. 359-65)
Section 6.3
(pp. 366-82)
Chapter
summary
Exer. 6.456.53
Probability concepts
Counting methods:
multiplication
principle, permutations,
combinations
Probability models
23 days
Review
2 days
Section 7.1
Section 7.2
Chapter
summary
Distributions of Discrete Random Variables (chapter 8)
Binomial
12 days
Section 8.1
Geometric
Review
12 days
1 day
2 days
Exer. 6.546.77
Exer. 6.786.87
Other
[test]
Exer. 7.17.20
Exer. 7.217.53
Exer. 7.547.68
[quiz 7.1]
[quiz 7.2]
[take-home test]
Exer. 8.18.36
Section 8.2
Exer. 8.378.54
Chapter
Exer. 8.558.64
summary
End Marking Period 2
Chapters 18
[midterm examination]
107
Chapter 3
1
Assignments
(odd-numbered
Topic
Time Frame
Text
Other
problems
required)
***SEMESTER 2***
Sampling Distributions (chapter 9)
Statistical inference
1 day
pp. 484-88
COMAP video, prog. 10
Parameters and statistics 12 days
Section 9.1
Exer. 9.19.18
[quiz 9.1]
Sample proportions
23 days
Section 9.2
Exer. 9.199.30 Sample proportions lab
(Sevin)
[quiz 9.2]
Sample means
1 day
Section 9.3
Exer. 9.319.35
(pp. 514-19)
Central limit theorem
12 days
Section 9.3
Exer. 9.369.42 RVSL: Sampling
(pp. 520-26)
Distributions (Web
simulation); Minitab lab
(GRB): special problem 9A
[quiz 9.3]
Review
2 days
Chapter
Exer. 9.439.53
[test]
summary
Inference (chapter 10)
Confidence intervals
23 days
Section 10.1
Exer. 10.110.26 Confidence interval
lab (Sevin)
[quiz 10.1]
Significance tests
34 days
Sections 10.2 Exer. 10.27
[quiz 10.210.3]
10.3
10.65
Error and power
23 days
Section 10.4
Exer. 10.66
Intuitor.com, Type I and
10.77
Type II Errors (Web
simulation); AndersonCook, Hypothesis Testing
(Web simulation)
[quiz 10.4]
Review
12 days
Chapter
Exer. 10.78
[test]
summary
10.89
Inference for Distributions (chapter 11)
One-sample t procedures 23 days
Section 11.1
Exer. 11.111.21,
[quiz 11.1]
11.23c, 11.24
11.34, 11.36
Two-sample t procedures 23 days
Section 11.2
Exer. 11.37
[quiz 11.2]
11.61
Review
1 day
Chapter
Exer. 11.62
[test]
summary
11.73
108
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Topic
Time Frame
Review
12 days
Text
Section 12.1
Section 12.2
Assignments
(odd-numbered
problems
required)
Other
Chapter
summary
Exer. 12.112.21
[take-home quiz 12.1]
Exer. 12.22
Simulations and inference
12.34
lab (GRB): special problem
12A
[take-home quiz 12.2]
Exer. 12.35
[test]
12.45
Section 13.1
Exer. 13.113.13
Section 13.2
Exer. 13.14
(pp. 750-57)
13.18
Section 13.2
Exer. 13.19
(pp. 757-69)
13.30
Chapter
Exer. 13.31
summary
13.40
End Marking Period 3
Section 14.1
Exer. 14.114.11
Predictions
12 days
Section 14.2
Review
1 day
Chapter
summary
Exer. 14.12
14.17
Exer. 14.18
14.27
Intensive cumulative
review for AP Exam
510 days
Intensive cumulative
review for AP Exam
5 days
[quiz 13.1]
[quiz 13.2]
[test]
AP EXAM
PostAP Exam project
1015 days
Independent research
End Marking Period 4
109
Chapter 3
1
Teaching Strategies
I introduce the major conceptual components of the course by using individual programs from the video
series For All Practical Purposes. These informal and conversational episodes are an effective way to
familiarize students with the basic vocabulary and common applications for the skills they are about
to learn.
I use PowerPoint for most of my classroom presentations, so I can thereby incorporate Web sites of
interest, charts, and graphs into the lecture. Students take their own notes, and sample problems and
discussion are woven into the presentation; problem sets are done outside of class. Students then discuss
these problems with their pair-share partners in order to identify and work out difficulties. Any problems
that remain unsolved are presented to the class for resolution by the rest of the group (and me).
The pair-share technique works well. A pair forms a cooperative learning unit and can join another
pair to form a lab group. My classroom presentations are often Socratic: I ask questions to stimulate
thinking. Students are frequently reluctant to take the risk of answering such questions, but they become
bolder after a discussion with a partner. The partners take academic responsibility for one another and
push each other toward better performance in homework, labs, quizzes, and tests. The partner is the first
source of information for students who miss class. In the first marking period, students are often paired
with a partner from another grade to build familiarity. In the second marking period, I pair students
based on their first-marking-period performance (strong with weak) and by observed personalities. In the
third marking period, I pair them based on their midterm examination grades. Because that examination
mimics the AP Exam and uses questions from AP Released Exams as its base, students who have
demonstrated facility with these kinds of questions can help those who are less agile in an exam situation.
In the fourth marking period, students may choose their own seats in the classroom, and that seating
determines the partners or groups.
Most chapters are explored on the front end or reinforced on the back end with a lab, often in the form
of one of the special problems in the Golden Resource Binder that accompanies our textbook. I refer to
any class-long group activity or individual investigation as a lab, and students follow the guidelines in the
Binders special problem 0 to report their results; or, in the case of the labs developed by Anne Sevin, they
complete these together with their partner(s) and report them on the form provided. Many of the special
problems require the use of Minitab or similar spreadsheet and graphing software. Students are provided
with a copy of Minitab at the beginning of the year, and one of the first labs (special problem 2A) is an
exploration of its capabilities. The directions are included with the lab. Students who have other software at
home are permitted to substitute it (after checking with me.)
There are three computer stations, plus the teachers laptop, available in my classroom. When an applet
is useful (e.g., Correlation Game Web site), students form teams and utilize these four stations to inform or
compete. Simulation labs are done with the calculator or computer. Minitab labs are done with the software
loaded on the classroom, math lab, or home computers of the students. (The classroom computer or math
lab computers may be used only by students who do not have a computer at home.) Minitab labs are most
frequently done independently (without partners).
110
Students always read the requirements for a lab or project and ask questions in the classroom before
beginning the work. I allot a one- to two-week time frame in which I expect them to complete the
assignment independently, but we determine the actual due date collaboratively. (I ask, Having read the
requirements, what do you think is a reasonable amount of time to complete this lab?) Some labs are
completed during class time with partners. These are often ones that require experimentation rather than
simulationdice rolling, penny spinning, and the like. The experimental design activity (described in the
Student Activities section at the end of my syllabus) and many of Anne Sevins labs are best done in the
classroom. They are handwritten reports.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
For assessments, I use the test and quiz resources in the textbook because I find that they closely model
the AP Exam question types. I give take-home quizzes or tests for short chapters, for chapters at the close
of the semester, or just before the AP Exam purely as a timesaver. With juniors in the course, teaching time
in the third marking period is seriously impacted by our mandatory state assessments, which eat up nearly
a week of instructional time. I sometimes ask students to do the assessment at home without the aid of text
or notes, but on other occasions I use a take-home quiz or test as a teaching aid.
To prepare students for the AP Exam, I facilitate the purchase of a review book. In the past I have
used the AMSCO book by Jim Bohan, but most recently I have been using the Pearson/Prentice Hall book
that is ancillary to David Bock et al.s Stats: Modeling the World. (Disclaimer: I am one of the authors of
this test prep book, a fact I also disclose to my students.) All students purchase their own copies; I place
a group order, accept shipment, and usually pay shipping and handling. They use the book to prepare
independently for midterms. In the two to three weeks prior to the AP Exam, I specify chapters from the
textbook and test prep book for review and then give in-class quizzes on the review topics. These quizzes
consist of short-answer questions from the Released Exams that address the particular concept or skill, and
students are placed under time restrictions similar to those of the AP Exam. I grade the quizzes based on
my experience with the AP Exam Scoring Guidelines and return the papers for discussion the next day. We
often review the scoring procedures as a group and look at sample answers. Weekend assignments are the
practice exams from the test prep book.
After the AP Exam, students are generally free of homework. All work is completed during class. We
explore opportunities for research and analysis that will assist the school community. Some project themes
are proposed by the administration, and other research ideas come from students. Prior years themes have
addressed the following questions:
Does the day or the grade level or a combination of these factors influence absence rates at Kennett
High School?
How does the evacuation alarm compare with the ambient noise levels at Kennett High School?
Are students satisfied with the cafeteria offerings in the Kennett Consolidated School District?
Does extracurricular activity impact grade point average?
Student Evaluation
Students are graded on a point system, with each quiz contributing 1025 points; each test, 5090 points;
each lab, approximately 50 points; homework for the marking period, approximately 50 points; notebook
binder, approximately 50 points; and classroom participation, approximately 50 points. Roughly, tests
account for 35 percent of the grade; quizzes, 20 percent; labs, 30 percent; homework, 5 percent; binder, 5
percent; and class participation, 5 percent. It varies according to the number of activities I can accomplish
with any given group.
Tests (taken from the Golden Resource Binder) are point balanced between the multiple-choice and
the free-response questions, to anticipate AP Exam scoring. All AP courses at Kennett High School are
weighted at 5.0 on a 4.0 scale. Each of the four marking periods is graded separately, and the cumulative
points create a percentage that corresponds to a letter grade. That letter grade contributes a certain number
of points to the students GPA. The GPA points are accumulated over the four marking periods, then
doubled in value, added to the midterm letter grade GPA value, and averaged to arrive at the final year-end
letter grade. The schools grading scale is as follows:
111
Chapter 3
1
Honor Courses
GPA
4.83
4.50
4.17
3.83
3.50
3.17
2.83
2.50
2.17
1.83
1.50
0.00
1.00
AP Courses GPA
5.33
5.00
4.67
4.33
4.00
3.67
3.33
3.00
2.67
2.33
2.00
0.00
1.00
Teacher Resources
Primary Text
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics: TI-83/89 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. 2nd ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Related Print Resources
Barat, Christopher. The Practice of Statistics Instructors Solution Manual. 2nd ed. New York:
W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Fligner, Michael A., and William I. Notz. The Practice of Statistics Printed Test Bank. 2nd ed. New York:
W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Yates, Daniel S., and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics Golden Resource Binder. 2nd ed. New York:
W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Supplementary Materials
Books
Bohan, James. AP Statistics: Preparing for the Advanced Placement Examination. New York: AMSCO, 2000.
Carroll, Anne M., Ruth E. Carver, Susan A. Peters, and Janice D. Ricks. Preparing for the Statistics AP
Exam with Stats: Modeling the World, 2nd ed. AP Test Prep series. Upper Saddle River, N.J.: Pearson/
Prentice Hall, 2007.
112
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
College Board. 1997 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 1997.
College Board. 2002 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 2002. (Note: The 2007
Released Exam has become available since this syllabus was submitted.)
Demana, Franklin, Bert K. Waits, Gregory D. Foley, and Daniel Kennedy. Precalculus: Graphical,
Numerical, Algebraic. 6th ed. Boston: Pearson/Addison-Wesley, 2004.
Lovell, Robert. Probability Activities: For Problem Solving and Skills Reinforcement. Emeryville, Calif.:
Key Curriculum Press, 1993.
Scheaffer, Richard L., Mrudulla Gnanadesikan, Ann Watkins, and Jeffrey A. Witmer. Activity-Based
Statistics: Instructor Resources. New York: Springer, 1996.
Sevin, Anne D. Discovering Statistics: An Interactive Approach. Workshop presentation, 1995. From an
unpublished laboratory manual, Laboratory Manual for Introductory Statistics, Framingham State
College, Framingham, Massachusetts, spring 1993.
Software and Other Technology
Minitab. Student Version. Release 12. 1998.
www.minitab.com.
Texas Instruments. TI-84 Plus Graphing Calculator and ViewScreen.
http://education.ti.com/educationportal/sites/US/homePage/index.html.
Video
For All Practical Purposes: An Introduction to Contemporary Mathematics, episodes 610. 1987. Produced
by the Consortium for Mathematics and Its Applications (COMAP). An Annenberg/CPB Project. VHS/
DVD. Distributed by Intellimation, Santa Barbara, Calif. 30 minutes per episode.
The High-Stakes World of Statistics (Parts 1, 2, and 3). 1998. Directed by Jonathan Reich. Performed by
the Standard Deviants. Academic consultants: Ronald Witzel and Barry Skolnik. VHS. Distributed by
Cerebellum Corporation, Falls Church, Va. Three videocassettes, 261 minutes.
Web Sites
Anderson-Cook, C. M., and S. Dorai-Raj. Hypothesis Testing.
www.amstat.org/publications/jse/v11n3/java/Hypothesis.
Web site to accompany Making the Concepts of Power and Sample Size Relevant and Accessible to
Students in Introductory Statistics Courses Using Applets. Journal of Statistics Education 11,
no. 3 (2003).
Annis, Rebekah et al. What Are the Odds? The Ins and Outs of Probability.
http://teacherlink.org/content/math/interactive/probability/home.html.
Consortium for the Advancement of Undergraduate Statistics Education (CAUSE).
www.causeweb.org/resources.
Easton, Valerie J., and John H. McColl. Statistics Glossary.
www.cas.lancs.ac.uk/glossary_v1.1/samp.html.
113
Chapter 3
1
Intuitor.com. Type I and Type II ErrorsMaking Mistakes in the Justice System.
www.intuitor.com/statistics/T1T2Errors.html.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics.
http://onlinestatbook.com/rvls.html.
University of Illinois at UrbanaChampaign. Department of Statistics. The Correlation Game.
www.stat.uiuc.edu/courses/stat100/java/GCApplet/GCAppletFrame.html.
W. H. Freeman Co. The Practice of Statistics. 2nd ed. Companion Web site.
http://bcs.whfreeman.com/yates2e.
Student Activities
The Poker Project
(Topic: Probability)
Goal
Students use a basic understanding of probability, the fundamental counting principle (multiplication
principle), and the combinations rule to count the number of possible hands and their probabilities for
winning at five-card poker.
The Problem
On an initial deal of five cards to any one player, list the 10 possible hands in poker, and count the number
of ways to acquire each of those hands. Students may use books or the Internet to assist them but are
encouraged to do their computations independently and check that they have accounted for the entire
sample space before using other resources. If sources are used (and students are encouraged to check), they
must be cited in proper form as part of the paper.
The Product
Each student must hand in a typed paper, which may be as creative in design as desired. The paper must
include not only the probability of each hand but the explanation, with proper notation, of how the
probability was derived. (This part is unique to each student: although students may get answers and
techniques from another source, the explanations must be their own.)
Evaluation
This project is graded on the correctness of each hand and the quality of the explanation (4 points for each
hand), as well as the presentation and proper citation (10 points).
114
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
The Problem
An antidepression drug on the market has an effective period of 8 to 10 hours for each dosage. A number
of patients have complained that they have experienced dryness as a side effect and are therefore increasing
their water consumption. The pharmaceutical company has decided to investigate this side effect. You
are asked to design an experiment to determine the significance of this claim. You have been given
eight days to complete this experiment, and the subjects are 20 single-housed, healthy, young adult male
Sprague Dawley rats. (Previous animal experiments have shown that dryness is an indication that can be
determined by using rats as subjects, and we have determined the proper dosing range for rats.)
Describe and diagram your design. Be prepared to discuss.
The Product
Each group submits a handwritten report at the end of the class period.
Evaluation
Students generally work on this problem in groups of two to four. One design is submitted and graded on a
20-point scale. A class discussion of the various designs follows.
115
Chapter 3
1
Sample Syllabus 5
Dora Daniluk
Mayde Creek High School
Houston, Texas
School Profile
Location and Environment: Mayde Creek High School, one of six high schools in the Katy Independent
School District, is located 25 miles west of downtown Houston. The district, encompassing 181 square
miles in eastern Texas, has seen student enrollment steadily grow to more than 50,000 in the 2006-07
school year, with just under 3,000 of these pupils at Mayde Creek High.
Our school is academically grounded, technologically advanced, student-centered, communitysupported, and respectful of individuals. The curriculum is broad-based and includes a strong AP
program, dual credit for courses with the local community college, a special program for gifted and
talented students, and international business and career/technology offerings.
Grades: 912
Type: Public, four-year secondary school
Total Enrollment: Approximately 2,600
Ethnic Diversity: Hispanics/Latinos constitute 38 percent of the population; African Americans, 14
percent; Asian Americans, 6 percent; and others, 1 percent.
College Record: Of the class of 2006, 63 percent went on to attend a four-year college, 29 percent enrolled
in a two-year college, 3 percent received further vocational training, and 4 percent entered the military.
Personal Philosophy
Students who enroll in my classes vary greatly in their mathematical backgrounds and abilities. For many,
this class provides their first or only AP experience, whereas others have a schedule filled with AP courses.
I do believe that this is one course where all students can feel a measure of accomplishment. Statistics is
the real world around us, and relating activities and learning to what students see and know can stimulate
interest and success. I believe that activity-based lessons are essential to present concepts, and as a result,
each chapter in our textbook involves at least one activity that will help students discover, learn, and/or
recall the needed material. The classroom involves cooperative learninga chance to share ideas, discuss
problems, and explore possible answers. This team atmosphere is a major reason that 90 percent of our
students consistently earn grades of 3 or better on the AP Exam.
Class Profile
Mayde Creek High School usually has two sections of AP Statistics, with approximately 25 to 30 students
in each; I teach both classes. We are on a traditional schedule, and the class meets daily for 45 minutes.
The course prerequisite is Algebra 2, and as a result the students vary in ability from those who have only
Algebra 2 in their math background to those who are currently taking AP Calculus. Our district has an
open-door policy for AP courses, and all students are encouraged to enroll in these classes. All AP courses
116
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
provide an extra bonus point toward calculating a students grade point average on our 4-point scale.
Although our school does not require AP students to take AP Exams, students in this course are strongly
encouraged to do so, and on average, more than 80 percent take the exam.
Course Overview
The aim of this AP course is to provide students with a learning experience equivalent to that obtained in
most college introductory statistics courses, which have become a requirement for many college majors.
Students are expected to complete college-level assignments and be sufficiently motivated and selfdisciplined to perform at a postsecondary level. The course involves four major topics: exploring data,
planning a study, anticipating patterns, and statistical inference. The skills and concepts listed in the
Topic Outline of the AP Statistics Course Description are all covered. In addition to mastering skills and
understanding concepts, I hope each student will develop an awareness of the importance of this subject in
the real world, improve communication skills to convey decisions and ideas, and apply this knowledge in
the future.
TI-83 or -84 calculators are essential for success, and the mathematics department permits rental of
calculators for students who are unable to make such a purchase. There is no formal lab component in this
course. The computer lab is used only for Internet activities found at the textbook publishers Web site or
at various other sites listed in the Teacher Resources section of this syllabus. In past years this has involved
one or two days in the lab, as well as having students research specific sites from home.
The primary statistics text for the district is The Practice of Statistics: TI-83 Graphing Calculator
Enhanced by Yates, Moore, and McCabe.
Course Planner
Our academic year consists of two semesters, with school beginning in late August and running through
the end of May. In the timetable below, the number of days in the Time Frame column indicate the actual
number of classroom instruction daysthat is, 15 days equals three weeks, exclusive of school breaks,
holidays, and test days. There is a test at the end of each instructional unit and a semester exam at the end
of each semester.
Textbook problem numbers are not always listed in numerical order because the problems sometimes
piggyback one another, and the sequence listed allows students to continue the same line of thought.
The following abbreviations are used to indicate book titles: ABS = Activity-Based Statistics (Scheaffer
et al.); PS (course textbook) = The Practice of Statistics (Yates et al.); SIA = Statistics in Action (Watkins et
al.); SMW = Stats: Modeling the World (Bock et al.); WS = Workshop Statistics (Rossman and von Oehsen).
See my Teacher Resources section for full citations.
117
Chapter 3
1
SEMESTER 1
Time
Frame
~15 days
~7 days
Activities
Distribution activity
Features of a Distribution, WS, pp. 2934
Matching graphs to variables and
matching statistics to graphs, ABS,
pp. 3140
Strategies
A student survey from the first day of
class that collects nonsensitive information
(favorite fast-food restaurant, number
of DVDs owned, etc.) can be used for
graphical displays and discussion of types
of data, as well as future topics.
TI graphing features are used extensively.
(Beware, however, of teaching too many
calculator functions, such as renaming
lists; weaker students may be overwhelmed
by this additional information.)
Assign several past AP Exam free-response
questions to make students more aware of
expectations and methods of scoring these
questionse.g., 2001, no. 1.
Introduce transformation of data and the
resulting effects on measures of center and
spreadlater referenced in chapter 7.
Counting Techniques and Probability
Activities
Students select lottery numbers on the day
Topics
we begin this chapter, and drawings are
Randomness
done on a daily basis. (The Texas Lottery
Probability models
consists of selecting six numbers from 1 to
54.) A calculator is used to randomly select
six numbers at the beginning of class, and
Assignments
prizes are given for matching four, five, or
Worksheets to review basic counting
six numbers. And yes, very few prizes are
techniques, including combinations and
given.
permutations
Probability review worksheets
PS, chapter 6, problems 8, 9, 12, 13, 19,
21, 22, 23, 3133, 39, 40
118
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Strategies
Provide as much practice as possible in
this section.
A review of basic probability at this
point has proved to be beneficial before
addressing probabilities found using
different density curves.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Time
Frame
~9 days
~10 days
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
Group problems from SMW, pp. 9395
Strategies
A calculator is used to find the probability
on the standard normal curve. I do not
teach too many shortcuts at this time.
Draw connections with chapter 1, such as
Assignments
graphing data and finding the quartiles for
PS, chapter 2, problems 2, 3, 4, 7, 9, 13,
the normal curve.
17, 26, 27, 30, 31, 33, 39, 40, 43
Past AP Exam free-response question
practice: 2003, no. 3.
Examining Relationships
Activities
Activities to demonstrate the meaning of
Topics
LSRL and the coefficient of determination:
Scatterplots
Using the data from example 3.12, we
Correlation
calculate the sum of the squares of the
Least-squares regression
residuals for the line y = 4 + .5x. Students
then try to find a better line with a
smaller sum of squares. A calculator is
Assignments
then used to show the LSRL, and the
PS, chapter 3, problems 1, 2, 5, 7, 11, 42,
minimal sum is calculated.
43, 10, 26, 30, 36, 38, 50
PS computer lab activity from the textbook
Web site
Web sites related to these concepts (GC
Applet and Regression Applet in the
Teacher Resources section of this syllabus)
Matching descriptions to scatterplots
activity, ABS, pp. 8385
Strategies
Go slowly and show as many examples as
possible.
Emphasize all steps needed to analyze the
data.
Recipes for slope and coefficient of
determination are helpful for students
to learn, but be sure these concepts are
understood.
119
Chapter 3
1
Time
Frame
~10 days
~15 days
Assignments
Review worksheet on logs and
exponentials
PS, chapter 4, problems 51, 52, 54, 7,
9, 10, 12, 61, 1924, 38, 39, 65, 40, 41,
43, 64
Samples and Experiments
Topic
Designing samples
Designing experiments
Simulating experiments
~9 days
120
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
Have students collect data in a variety of
ways and find the best model to fit their
datae.g., the Cheerios exploration
available on Jared Derksens Web site
(www.mrderksen.com/Downloads
/cheerios.pdf).
Strategies
Most of my students need a one-day review
of logs and exponentials.
Group activities work well in this unit.
Now is a good time to practice past AP
Exam free-response questions (such as
no. 1 from 2005).
Activities
Random Rectangles, ABS, pp. 154-55.
Systematic, cluster, and stratified sampling
is also demonstrated.
Strategies
Students find examples of recent
Assignments
experiments or studies and then analyze
PS, chapter 5, problems 1, 4, 5, 7, 912,
according to principles learned in this
1425, 27, 31, 33, 29, 40, 45, 47
chapter.
Group experiment based on the
Vocabulary for this chapter needs to be
Helicopter Project (see the Student
stressed.
Activities section of this syllabus)
Past AP Exam free-response question
practice: 2002, no. 2; 2004 (Form B), no. 2.
Probability Revisited
Activities
Play the Game of Greed (URL is in my
Topic
Teacher Resources section) to introduce
Probability tables and trees (section 6.3)
simulations. Rules of the game: Students
Law of large numbers
stand. Single die is rolled twice and total
Simulating probability (section 5.3)
is counted. Students may sit and retain
this total or stand for additional rolls. Any
roll of 6 erases the accumulated total, and
Assignments
winner(s) are those students who most
PS, chapter 6, problems 50, 53, 54, 45,
recently sat down. On average, how many
47, 49, 51, 60
points would you expect to earn?
Worksheets using problems from a
Textbook
Web site simulation of the law of
variety of texts to supplement table and
large numbers.
tree problems
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Time
Frame
~6 days
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
Random Behavior, ABS, pp. 9395
Spinner activity to demonstrate
transformations and combinations of
random variables
Dice activity to demonstrate that 2x is
different from x + x
Strategies
Keep in mind that rules about means
and variances for linear combinations of
random variables are not on the formula
chart for the AP Exam. These topics need
to be included with problems in future
chapters.
SEMESTER 2
Time
Frame
~6 days
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
Binomial Rabbits demo from NetLogo (see
my Teacher Resources section)
Normal approximation to the binomial
demo (see the Teacher Resources section)
M&Ms to demonstrate binomial and
geometric distributions
Student pairs graph binomial distributions
on classroom boardfrom p = .1 to p = .9.
Compare the graphs; calculate the mean
and standard deviation for each using
formulas from chapter 7; then compare
these results to formulas for binomial
distributions.
Strategies
Students need to see a variety of examples
to emphasize the difference between
binomial and geometric distributions.
121
Chapter 3
1
Time
Frame
~10 days
~9 days
122
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
PS activity 9A (alternate) to demonstrate
the central limit theorem (CLT). I have
a dozen sets of these numbers, as well as
four sets of a uniform distribution. Use
one-inch graph paper to record data. I
select sample sizes of 3, 5, and 10 from the
normal distribution and sample size of 10
from the uniform. Displaying these graphs
for the remainder of the year proves
beneficial to remind students that sample
size (not population size) is important in
determining the variation of the sampling
distribution.
Strategies
Using the sets of numbers for the normal
distribution (described above), students
graph a confidence interval and note if it
captures the true mean of the population.
There are some really nice software models
demonstrating the central limit theorem
(see Sampling Distribution and CLT Model
in my Teacher Resources section).
Understanding of the CLT is very
important; time here is well spent.
Strategies
Students need to memorize much of the
vocabulary in this chapter.
Students begin a portfolio of all types of
inference tests and intervals.
Although calculating power and
probability of Type II errors is not
required material, both are valuable in
demonstrating the relationships between
Type I, Type II, power, sample size, and
effect size.
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Time
Frame
~9 days
~7 days
~8 days
Chi-Square Procedures
Topics
Goodness of fit
Homogeneity of proportions
Independence
Assignments
PS, chapter 13, problems 1, 3, 4, 12,
21, 30
Worksheets with mixed types of
inference studied to this point
Strategies
Past AP Exam free-response questions
covering inferences
Activities
Test of homogeneity: For a quiz grade,
each student receives a cup of multi-fruitcolored cereal and determines if the colors
are equally distributed. After the quiz,
they check the bottom of their cups to
determine which kind of Froot Loops
they have (three different brands of cereal
are used in the class).
Strategies
Test after this unit on chapters 913
combined: This exam (the only one in
the course that covers multiple units)
combines all of the different types of
intervals and tests. I feel that tying all
of these topics together is important to
success in this area.
123
Chapter 3
1
Time
Frame
~7 days
~ 10 days
Assignments
Review worksheets on linear regression
and transformations to achieve linearity
Computer data printouts
AP Exam questions
Review for AP Exam
~ 10 days
Assignments
Multiple-choice and free-response
questions from AP Central and
Released Exams
PostAP Exam Period
Topics
Games of chance
Apply principles of probability in
developing a game of chance
Resources, Activities,
and Strategies
Activities
Cooperative assignments and review
worksheets
Strategies
Review chapters 3 and 4 for AP Exam.
Students need to be able to analyze data
from different types of computer software.
Activities
Game of Chance project (see my Student
Activities section)
Teaching Strategies
I have integrated my specific teaching strategies for each segment of the syllabus into the Course Planner
above. Here I describe some of the broader instructional methods that I employ.
I start most class periods with a short warm-up question that reviews recently presented material. These
problems are graded as correct or incorrect, and the points earned are recorded for each student. Individual
accumulated points become a quiz grade at the end of the grading periodbased on five-eighths of the total
points possible. As the year progresses, I begin class once a week with 12-minute timed warm-ups, using
free-response questions similar to those that appear on the AP Exam.
Group points are earned in cooperative activities. For example, I often distribute challenging multiplechoice questions (at a higher level of difficulty than most of my test questions) to groups of students in
order to review for a test. These encourage discussion in the group and give the students good practice.
At the end of each six weeks, group points are converted into a quiz grade, based on the average number
of points earned by the class groups. Such a quiz is usually a benefit to student averages. New groups are
determined randomly (of course) every six weeks.
I am a strong believer in learning by doing, so a great deal of my instruction is based on classroom
activities that reinforce the material being taught. Students learn abstract concepts best from practical
applications, and they also enjoy engaging in hands-on projects. For instance, because it has a second-story
balcony, my school offers the perfect place to stage the Helicopter Project described on the North Carolina
124
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
School of Science and Mathematics (NCSSM) Web site. (For a complete description of this and several
other such undertakings, see the Student Activities section at the end of this syllabus.) I have found the
amount and quality of learning that students derive from group activities to be well worth the additional
time required.
Once we begin to study inference, I have the students develop a portfolio that contains examples of
each type of hypothesis test and confidence interval (see the Student Activities section). The total points
earned are counted as a test grade, but most important, students claim that this collection of their work
provides the best study material for the AP Exam. I use released AP Exam questions for many of these
problems, but I vary them from year to year, because the portfolios tend to be saved by former students.
Student Evaluation
Students transcripts show two semester grades, both of equal value. Each semester has three six-week
grading periods and a semester exam, each worth 25 percent of the semester grade. District guidelines
require that each six-weeks grade be determined as follows:
Tests: 70 percent
Quizzes: 20 percent
Daily class work and homework: 10 percent
There is a test at the end of each instructional unit. All unit tests are half multiple-choice and half
free-response questions. Semester exams are 70 percent multiple-choice and 30 percent free-response.
The second-semester exam is a comprehensive final. Quizzes are given periodicallyeither announced or
unannouncedin order to assess students knowledge of the material on a day-to-day basis.
The schools grading scale is as follows:
90100
8089
7579
7074
A
B
C
D
Teacher Resources
Primary Textbook
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and George P. McCabe. The Practice of Statistics: TI-83 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. New York: W. H. Freeman, 1999.
Supplementary Books
Bock, David E., Paul F. Velleman, and Richard D. De Veaux. Stats: Modeling the World. Boston: Pearson/
Addison-Wesley, 2004.
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. 2nd ed. Pacific Grove,
Calif.: Brooks/Cole, 2005.
Rossman, Allan J., and J. Barr von Oehsen. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data and the Graphing
Calculator. New York: Springer, 1997.
125
Chapter 3
1
Scheaffer, Richard L., Mrudulla Gnanadesikan, Ann Watkins, and Jeffrey A. Witmer. Activity-Based
Statistics: Instructor Resources. New York: Springer, 1996.
Utts, Jessica M., and Robert F. Heckard. Mind on Statistics. 2nd ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole,
2004.
Watkins, Ann E., Richard L. Scheaffer, and George W. Cobb. Statistics in Action: Understanding a World of
Data. Emeryville, Calif.: Key Curriculum Press, 2004.
Yates, Daniel S., and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics Golden Resource Binder. 2nd ed. New York:
W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Web Sites
Boggs, Rex. The Game of Greed.
www.lhs.logan.k12.ut.us/~jsmart/greed.htm.
NCSSM Statistics Leadership Institute Notes. The Helicopter Experiment: A Factorial Design.
http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Stat_Inst/PDFS/FacDesgn.pdf.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics. Normal Approximation to the Binomial Distribution.
http://onlinestatbook.com/stat_sim/normal_approx/index.html.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics. Sampling Distribution.
http://onlinestatbook.com/stat_sim/sampling_dist/index.html.
University of Illinois at UrbanaChampaign, Department of Statistics. GC Applet.
www.Stat.uiuc.edu/~stat100/java/GCApplet/GCAppletFrame.html.
West, R. Webster, University of South Carolina. Regression Applet.
www.stat.sc.edu/~west/javahtml/Regression.html.
W. H. Freeman Co. The Practice of Statistics. 2nd ed. Companion Web site.
http://bcs.whfreeman.com/yates2e.
For my purposes, the Web site for the second edition works fine with the first edition of the textbook.
Wilensky, Uri, Center for Connected Learning and Computer-Based Modeling, Northwestern University.
NetLogo Binomial Rabbits Model.
http://ccl.northwestern.edu/netlogo/models/BinomialRabbits.
Wilensky, Uri, Center for Connected Learning and Computer-Based Modeling, Northwestern University.
Central Limit Theorem Model.
http://ccl.northwestern.edu/netlogo/models/CentralLimitTheorem.
126
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Student Activities
Graphical Methods for Describing Univariate Data
(Adapted from a project attributed to Susan Mead, in Christopher R. Olsen, AP Statistics Teachers Guide
[New York: College Board, 2002], 154.)
You are a dietician who has been asked to make a presentation to a high school class. You would like to
discuss the nutritional value of fast food, using the concepts learned in The Practice of Statistics, chapter 1.
Please do the following:
1. Pick one of the restaurants from the following list and look at one nutritional value (e.g., calories,
sodium content, fat content, cholesterol) across all food products (entrees, salads, and sides). If there
is more than one size for that product, use the middle size. Using the data shown in the tables,
prepare a graphical representation of the nutritional value of the data set with at least 15 values.
Then analyze the distribution, including measures of center and spread, the shape, clusters, gaps,
and outliers. Write a brief summary of the nutritional value of the fast food from your restaurant.
2. Pick two restaurants. Choose a nutritional value different from the one you chose in problem
no. 1. Do a comparison of this value for both restaurants, including graphical and numerical
analysis. Are there any differences or similarities between the two types of establishments with
regard to the chosen nutritional value?
Please include separate lists of data for each part of this project.
Web sites for the restaurants are given below. If you would like to analyze a fast-food restaurant that is
missing from this list, just ask if you may include it.
Burger King
Chick-fil-A
Churchs Chicken
Jack in the Box
Kentucky Fried Chicken
McDonalds
Wendys
Whataburger
www.bk.com
www.chickfila.com
www.churchs.com
www.jackinthebox.com
www.kfc.com
www.mcdonalds.com
www.wendys.com
www.whataburger.com
Grading
This is a 50-point project, equivalent to half a test.
All work is due at the beginning of the period on
15 percent per day deduction for late work.
Each project should begin with a cover sheet that includes the title of your project, your name, and the date.
Do not put it in a binder. Just staple or paper clip the pages together.
Chapter 3
1
Projects should be grammatically correct and without spelling errors. I will deduct points for
offensive errors.
for me to evaluate.
2 points
9 points
9 points
4 points
13 points
13 points
128
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
6. What type of design will be used?
7. Draw the design:
8. What controls do you need? Be specific:
9. State the procedure your group will use to do the experiment. BE PRECISE!! Assign group
members to do the different jobs.
10. Assign the helicopters to treatments. Explain how your group did this.
11. Perform trial runs. Make corrections or improvements to your answers for the questions above.
Second-Day Worksheet
As a group, answer these questions when you finish your experiment. You will finalize your comments/
thoughts in your group report.
1. What are the results for each helicopter?
2. What are the mean and standard deviation for each treatment?
3. What conclusions can be drawn from your data?
4. Did anything go wrong? If so, what?
5. What would you and your group do differently?
6. Draw a double line graph (one line for the longer rotor, one for the shorter) of the means of each
treatment, putting the measurement of flights on the vertical axis.
Grading
The report that each group submits should consist of the following parts and must include this sheet for
each group member. Your grade is based on the following (maximum possible points are in parentheses):
Points
Controls (10)
Procedures (10)
Raw data and exploratory analysis (10) (does not need to be typed)
129
Chapter 3
1
First-day worksheet from each group member (10)
Cooperative work (group/teacher evaluation) (20)
Project grade (100)
1. One-sample z (completed)
(5)
2. One-sample t (completed)
(5)
(5)
(5)
5. Two-sample t (completed)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(5)
(5)
---------------------------------------------
130
(10)
(10)
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
13. Random problem (corrected)
(10)
(20)
(100)
Total:
Game of Chance
After the AP Exam, we usually have two weeks of class before final exams start, and because some of my
students are taking other AP Exams, I do not want to burden them with additional homework or makeup
work. The Casino Lab activity from the Golden Resource Binder (2nd ed.) for chapter 7 of our text is used
to introduce games of chance. Additional history for each game is also discussed. After completing the
lab, students must create their own game of chance. Partners may be used if desired. Students must create
a sheet for documentation of game results when played by their classmates. Often additional texts must be
referenced to determine the theoretical probability of the new game. This has proved to be an entertaining
way to finish the year!
Instructions
After having looking at several popular games of chance, it is now your turn to develop your own game
using probability. You may work alone or with one partner. The following requirements must be met:
Step One:
1. Decide on a game that you would like to develop.
2. Test your ideas through simulations of your game.
3. Are you able to answer all of the questions in step two for your game?
4. Adjust/change the rules and guidelines for your game.
5. Share your thoughts with Mrs. Daniluk before proceeding.
Proposal acceptance date:
Step Two (prepare your written project, including each of the following):
1. Name your game. (5 points)
2. Describe the rules of your game. (10 points)
3. Play your game, recording the results, and determine the experimental probability of winning.
Playing of your game may be done with the actual materials or simulated with the calculator. Play
a realistic number of times in order to feel somewhat confident about your experimental probability.
(5 points)
4. Determine the theoretical probability of winning your game. This may be much more difficult than
it sounds, so think about this aspect of your game as ideas grow. Of course, your work must be
shown! (10 points)
5. If it costs $2 to play your game, what must the payoff be in order to make this a fair game? (5 points)
131
Chapter 3
1
6. Find two other individuals from our class to play your game. Provide them with the proper forms or
worksheets to record their results. (5 points)
7. How do these results (in item 6) compare with the experimental and theoretical probabilities that
you found in items 3 and 4 above? (5 points) Is there a substantial difference? (5 points)
8. Are there any improvements or alterations that you think should be made to your game?
Grading
This assignment counts as a 50-point quiz, or you may double the points to make it equivalent to a 100point testwhichever you prefer.
Note: This will not be decided randomly J. Have fun!
132
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 6
Jared Derksen
Rancho Cucamonga High School
Rancho Cucamonga, California
School Profile
Location and Environment: Rancho Cucamonga High School (RCHS) is located in a suburban area 40
miles east of Los Angeles. The school has experienced six years of improvement on state tests. There are
two student leadership groupsone follows a traditional model by organizing rallies, dances, lunchtime
activities, and community projects, whereas the other group, our Renaissance Program, is solely dedicated
to promoting and recognizing student achievement. Renaissance works with local businesses and school
funds to provide special T-shirts to students on the Honor Roll and recognizes students who show marked
scholastic improvement, as well as our academic Top 10. The Renaissance Rally held every spring is
viewed by many students as one of the highlights of the school year. RCHS also sponsors more than thirty
student clubs, ranging from guitar and chess to various ethnic dancing groups and anime. Our awardwinning music program has many different ensembles and performing groups, and the athletic program
is competitive in the Southern California League. In short, RCHS has a strong sense of school pride and
accomplishment and fosters an environment where being involved while learning is highly valued.
Grades: 912
Type: Public high school
Total Enrollment: 2,800
Ethnic Diversity: The student body is 34 percent Hispanic/Latino, 16 percent African American, and
7 percent Asian American.
College Record: Although 70 percent of the graduating students go to college, only 30 percent attend a
four-year university.
Personal Philosophy
I am enthusiastic about teaching AP Statisticsthis is a dynamic class that significantly influences my
students thinking and the way they view the world. I jokingly tell them, Be forewarned! If you do not
want to think about statistics at the most inopportune moments for at least the next five years, dont take
this class! The applications and implications of statistics can be found everywhere in our culture: election
polls, medical studies, financial analysisand even bags of M&Ms. For that reason, I always make sure
that assignments are tied to real-world data, and class time often includes interactive experiments and
activities. My goal is to show students how to think carefully about the collection and analysis of data,
thereby helping them to make discerning and rational decisions about many important issues that rely on
statistical claims and improving their critical thinking skills in general.
Class Profile
RCHS offers three sections of AP Statistics annually, all taught by me. It is a one-year, two-semester
course that meets five days a week. The class is 55 minutes long, except on Fridays, when it meets for
45 minutes. Class size ranges from 25 to 35 pupils per section. Students enter the class with a wide range of
133
Chapter 3
1
backgrounds. Some have the minimum prerequisite (passing Algebra 2 with a C), whereas others come
from the honors program. It is not uncommon for honors students to take AP Statistics concurrently with
Precalculus or Calculus.
Course Overview
The course includes the topics listed in the AP Statistics Course Description, primarily through the use of
three resources: Bock et al., Stats: Modeling the World, second edition (the main textbook); Levine-Wissing
and Thiel, AP Statistics, third edition; and the past AP Exam questions available on AP Central, as well as
in the AP Statistics Released Exams (1997 and 2002 [Note: The 2007 Released Exam has become available
since this syllabus was submitted.]). (For complete citations, see the Teacher Resources section of this
syllabus.)
Expectations
I look forward to teaching every day. I hope that you will come to class ready to learn and with a positive
attitude. Statistics is an inherently interesting subject: it surrounds us everywhere we go. Investigating such
a fascinating topic will involve lots of participation on your part. So turn off your cell phone, and come to
class ready to think and be stretched!
Participation
You are expected to participate in class regularly. Finishing the Do-Now problems and completing
problems that we work on during class time is essential for your learning. You will turn in participation
cards during class to demonstrate how involved you are.
Materials
All students must have the following in class on a daily basis:
134
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
After-School Tutoring and Study Groups
I will be available after school for tutoring one or two days a week. On Mondays, the schedule for the week
will be announced. I strongly recommend that you form a study group. Working with your classmates to
learn the material is an excellent way to improve your understanding of statistics.
Course Planner
The numbered weeks below indicate actual instruction time, exclusive of school breaks and holidays. Full
citations for all sources mentioned here can be found in the Teacher Resources section of this syllabus.
SEMESTER 1
Unit I: Exploring and Understanding Data
Stats, chapters 16
Time frame: five weeks
Week 1
Introduction to stats (chapter 1)
Quiz on chapter 4
Week 3
Summary statistics for quantitative data (chapter 5)
Outliers (chapter 5)
1997, no. 1
2000, no. 3
2001, no. 1
2002 Form B, no. 5
135
Chapter 3
1
Week 4
The normal distribution (chapter 6)
Week 5
Review and assessment of Unit I
Unit I vocabulary crossword
Project 1: Exploring datacollect data, graph it, and describe it (see the Student Activities
section of this syllabus)
Unit I Exam
A major test is given at the end of this unit. It includes at least one AP Exam free-response question (see list
in week 3) and is given on one-and-a-half school days. The test has multiple-choice problems as well.
Unit II: Regression
Stats, chapters 710
Time frame: four weeks
Week 6
Displaying and describing scatterplots (chapter 6)
Week 7
Analyzing two-variable quantitative data
Week 8
Analyzing two-variable quantitative data
136
1999, no. 1
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Week 9
Transformations to achieve linearity (chapter 10)
1997, no. 6
2004 Form B, no. 1
Unit II Exam
This major exam includes regression (again) and the topics in chapters 9 and 10.
Unit III: Collecting Data
Stats, chapters 1213
Time frame: three weeks
Week 10
Designing surveys via various methods (chapter 12)
Weeks 11 and 12
Observational studies (chapter 13)
Control
Random assignment of treatment
Replication
Placebo and blinding
Blocking and matched pairs
Confounding and lurking variables
Statistically significant difference (introduction)
1997, no. 2
1999, no. 3
2001, no. 4
2002, no. 2
2002 Form B, no. 3
2003, no. 4
137
Chapter 3
1
Unit III Exam
In addition to 10 multiple-choice questions, the test contains 3 free-response questions that are similar to
those found on the AP Exam.
Unit IV: Probability
Stats, chapters 11, 1418
Time frame: eight weeks (the last six weeks of the first semester and the first two weeks of the second
semester)
Week 13
Basic probability principles, including complementary, independent, and mutually exclusive events
(chapter 14)
Week 14
Addition, multiplication, and conditional probability rules (chapter 15)
Scramble worksheets assigned (worksheets that consist of a mixture of different probability chapters)
Probability quiz
Favorite released AP Exam free-response question to use:
Week 15
Random variables (chapter 16)
2001, no. 2
2002 Form B, no. 2
2004, no. 4
Week 16
Simulating probability scenarios (chapter 11)
2001, no. 3 (or a variation that examines whether iPods really shuffle randomly!)
Week 17
Review for final exam
Week 18
Finals week: cumulative semester exam
138
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
SEMESTER 2
Unit IV: Probability (continued)
Week 1
Binomial and geometric distributions for means and proportions (chapter 17)
Week 2
Sampling distributions (chapter 18)
Week 4
Hypothesis testing for one proportion (chapter 20)
Week 5
Type I and II errors and power (chapter 21)
Colored bead activity from mystery bags (analysis of errors and power)
Unit V vocabulary crossword
Unit V exam (chapters 1921, including review of sampling distributions for proportions)
Week 6
Intervals and tests for two proportions (chapter 22)
Cumulative Unit V Exam
(Chapters 1922)
Unit VI: Inference for Means
Stats, chapters 2325
Time frame: three weeks
Week 7
Confidence intervals and hypothesis tests for one mean (chapter 23)
Examination of homemade dice (mean = 3.5?) Students will not know whether their die, because it is
homemade, will have a mean of 3.5 or not. A fair die should.
Quiz on t procedures
139
Chapter 3
1
Week 8
Confidence intervals and hypothesis testing for two means (chapter 24)
Week 9
Confidence intervals and hypothesis testing for matched pairs means (chapter 25)
Cumulative Unit VI Exam
Unit VII: Inference for Counts and Slope
Stats, chapters 2627
Time frame: two weeks
Week 10
Chi-square goodness of fit (chapter 26)
Week 11
Confidence interval for slope (chapter 27)
Cumulative year-end project (see the Student Activities section at the end of this syllabus)
Assessment
The final project receives a grade.
140
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Teaching Strategies
I firmly believe that it is important for students to take an active role in their own learning process, not just
to be passive sponges soaking up isolated pieces of information. Their immersion in the subject by working
both independently and together in class on a variety of problems and projects helps them to consolidate
what they have gleaned from the textbook and from listening to me. Moreover, it spurs them to think for
themselves, to make critical judgments about statistical claims they encounter every day, and to consider
novel applications for the methods they have learned. In order to engage them in this sort of challenge, I
use a number of different approachesamong them, the following:
Data is frequently collected from the class. On the first day, students fill out a short questionnaire,
and these data are used throughout the first unit. Many topics are introduced by asking students
to provide simple information about themselves, and the resulting data are used to open the days
lesson.
I use participation cards in class to encourage active learning. Whenever a student participates in
any class activity (answering questions, offering solutions, doing work on the board, and so forth)
that person (along with any other student who helped with the answer) hands me a card with his or
her name on it. These cards are then tabulated as a part of each students grade.
Every other week students read current news articles that contain statistics and/or statistical
issues and summarize them. These articles are then discussed in class. Sources are available
everywhere on the Internetthe AP newswire, online newspapers, and popular Web sites. Two good
examples are stories about a survey of the survivors of the 2004 tsunami in the Washington Post
(www.washingtonpost.com/wp-dyn/articles/A10689-2005Jan14.html) and about smart baby DVDs
at WebMD (http://children.webmd.com/news/20070807/smart-baby-dvds-no-help-may-harm).
A classroom set of Workshop Statistics is used for occasional cooperative group work.
When studying inference, students do confidence intervals and hypothesis tests on a template sheet
that walks them through the necessary steps: name, hypotheses (tests only), check of conditions,
formulas and math work, and conclusion. They use this template throughout the inference units and
even on many of the assessments. During review time for the AP Exam, they are weaned from the
template, but by then the steps for inference have become automatic.
When we finish the course with a final project after the AP Exam, students learn the use of Data
Desk computer software. I have designed a series of four lessons that guide them through the basics
of using the program:
Students are then encouraged (as technology at school and home permits) to use Data Desk to
analyze their final project.
141
Chapter 3
1
Student Evaluation
Students receive two separate grades for each semester of the course. In order to help students and the
instructor remain focused on the thorough learning of each component of the course, all assessments are
sorted by unit. A typical grade breakdown is as follows:
First Semester
Homework
Participation
Unit I
Unit II
Unit III
Unit IV (beginning)
10 percent
10 percent
25 percent
20 percent
15 percent
20 percent
Second Semester
Homework
Participation
Unit IV (end)
Unit V
Unit VI
Unit VII
Review for AP Exam
Final project
10 percent
10 percent
10 percent
20 percent
15 percent
10 percent
15 percent
10 percent
I do not put tests and quizzes in a separate category. Any assessment the student takes goes into the
unit to which the material pertains. The first-semester final exam grade is broken into four partsone part
for the questions on each unit. This grading system has the advantage of making it easier to recognize and
reward progress over time. For example, if a student earns high marks on the regression questions on the
first-semester final exam, these scores can be compared with the grade in the Unit II category and a more
appropriate grade for the students level of comprehension can be assigned.
Students are highly encouraged to take the AP Exam. They are reminded that high-stakes exams are
common in college, so taking an AP Exam is a good way to practice for these upcoming assessments.
Teacher Resources
Basic and Supplementary Textbooks
Bock, David E., Paul F. Velleman, and Richard D. De Veaux. Stats: Modeling the World. Boston: Pearson/
Addison-Wesley, 2004. (This is the primary text used for the course.)
Levine-Wissing, Robin, and David Thiel. AP Statistics. 3rd ed. Piscataway, N.J.: Research and Education
Association, 2006.
Resource Books
Bock, David E., and William B. Craine III. Printed Test Bank and Resource Guide for Stats: Modeling the
World. 2nd ed. Boston: Pearson/Prentice Hall, 2007.
College Board. 1997 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 1997.
College Board. 2002 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 2002. (Note: The 2007
Released Exam has become available since this syllabus was submitted.)
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. 2nd ed. Belmont,
Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2005.
Rossman, Allan J., Beth L. Chance, and J. Barr von Oehsen. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data and
the Graphing Calculator. 2nd ed. Emeryville, Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2002.
142
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Scheaffer, Richard L., Mrudulla Gnanadesikan, Ann Watkins, and Jeffrey A. Witmer. Activity-Based
Statistics. New York: Springer, 1996.
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics: TI-83/89 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. 2nd. ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Software/Multimedia
ActivStats. CD-ROM ed. 20002001 release. By Paul Velleman. N.p.: Addison-Wesley, 2000. Data Desk is
the analysis software that is built into ActivStats.
Web Sites
AP Central.
apcentral.collegeboard.com.
I use this site regularly as a source of free-response questions other than those published in the
Released Exams.
Claremont Graduate University, WISE Projects Statistical Power Applet. Type I and II and power applet.
http://wise.cgu.edu/power/power_applet.html.
Eclipse Crossword.
www.eclipsecrossword.com.
Generates crossword puzzles from a list of words and clues.
Geometers Sketchpad Resource Center.
www.dynamicgeometry.com/javasketchpad/gallery/pages/least_squares.php.
Least-squares regression demonstration.
NCSSM Statistics Leadership Institute. An Exercise in Sampling: Rolling Down the River.
http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Stat_inst01/PDFS/river.pdf.
Stratification activity
Stanton, Charles. California State University, San Bernadino.
www.math.csusb.edu/faculty/stanton/m262/regress/regress.html.
Linear regression influential point applet.
University of Illinois at UrbanaChampaign, Department of Statistics. Guess my correlation applet.
www.stat.uiuc.edu/courses/stat100//java/GCApplet/GCAppletFrame.html.
Student Activities
Project 1: Exploring Data
Purpose
To practice describing data and graphs and to begin to think about data collection and sources of bias.
143
Chapter 3
1
Page 1 (must be typed)
First paragraph: Describe how and where you collected your data (collect at least 25 data points;
data must be quantitative).
Second paragraph: Do you think your data represent the population you were studying? Why or
why not? What sources of bias do you think may have been present in your data
collection?
Third paragraph: By studying graphs of the data, what relationships can be observed? What do the
graphs show? What conclusions can be drawn?
Page 2 and following
Graph your data.
Note: Excel makes great pie graphs and lousy histogramsproceed at your own peril.
A brief oral presentation is also required for each group. No written report is necessary.
Topic
You will design a survey on an interesting topic of your choice, but you must design it so you can address
one of the following questions:
Is it possible to word a question in two different ways that are logically equivalent but that produce
much different responses?
144
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Proposal
Each groups project proposal should include the following:
Note: Your sampling procedure should not be biased. Survey 50 people per question (50 for the unbiased
question, 50 for each biased question).
Poster
The poster should completely summarize your project yet be simple enough to be understood by someone
unfamiliar with statistics. Remember the purpose of the project! It should be pleasing to the eye. It should
include a one-page typed summary describing what you did. The colors on your graphs are crucial to
communicating the bias being examined: use a consistent color key so the change can be easily spotted.
Points: 30 points (10 for appearance, 10 for clear communication on graphs, 10 for the summary)
Oral Presentation
All group members must participate equally in this five-minute talk, and your poster should be used
only as a visual aid. To receive full credit for the presentation, your group must speak clearly and with
confidence, and you must do something to engage the audience. I leave it open-ended as to exactly what you
tell us about what you did, but I absolutely insist that your presentation be clear, interesting, and articulate.
Your task is to be verbally engagingwe do not have time for elaborate props/media setup.
Points: 20 points (10 for being stimulating, 10 points for clear communication)
Due Dates
not have 100 percent attendance on that day, you will be moved to a different date and receive a 20
percent penalty on your presentation grade.
Difficulty/Interest Rating:
145
Chapter 3
1
I. Data Report (20 points)
Due: Wednesday, May 25
This section should be a thorough explanation of how you collected your data and be a beautiful example
of how much you have learned this year about the difficulties of getting a representative sample. Examples
of what you should include follow:
146
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
IV. Presentation (20 points)
Due: Friday, June 9
The requirements for the groups oral reports are given below:
Clearly communicate your question and how you collected your data (5 points).
Visually display graphs of your dataPowerPoint (if you must), overhead, poster, or video (5 points).
I do not want a pretty poster that summarizes the whole project. I want you to make a visual aid that
shows the class how your data came out. There should be only minimal text on your visual aid
titles and big numbersnot any explanations.
numbers to the classtoo many numbers at once are confusing, as is giving too many decimal places.
Make your own copies of the data, graphs, and so forth. Once you turn in each part of your report, I
need to keep it.
Do not get lazythis is to be the summation of what you have learned all year.
Please type your paper. Handwritten work is acceptable for some graphs and the like, if it is done
very neatly.
Your work should be thorough and competently written. Bullet points may be used to delineate a list
of observations. Clear communication and thorough analysis is necessary for full credit.
Vocabulary Crosswords
On the following pages is a crossword puzzle that I created with Eclipse Crossword
(www.eclipsecrossword.com).
147
Chapter 3
1
3
4
5
6
7
10
11
12
13
16
14
15
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
EclipseCrossword.com
148
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Across
1. REPRESENTATIVEIf the sample looks like the population, then it is
3. RANDOMLYWe assign the treatments to the subjects
5. STRATIFIEDWhen I divide the population into homogenous groups and choose randomly from
each, this is a
random sample.
8. BLOCKSWe divide subjects into groups that will respond similiarly to the treatments called
10. COMPAREAt the end of the experiment, we
12. NONRESPONSEBias created because some people refuse to participate in the survey
14. SAMPLEThe small group from which we get data
19. PLACEBOA sugar pill
20. VOLUNTARY RESPONSEWhen those surveyed get to choose if they want to respond
21. BIASTo systematically favor certain outcomes
22. CONTROLThe group that does the status quo for purposes of comparison is the
group.
bias. (Interviewers
29. STATISTICALLY SIGNIFICANTIf the difference between two statistics is more than chance
variation would explain, the difference is . . .
Down
2. PARAMETERThe value of the population I am trying to estimate
4. CENSUSI try to survey the entire population.
6. FACTORThe variable the experimenter controls is the
sample.
11. MATCHED PAIRSAn experimental design where every subject does both treatments.
13. RANDOMWe know all the values, but cannot predict what will happen next. This is
15. MULTISTAGEA combination of various sampling methods is a
sample.
21. BLINDINGKeeping someone unaware of what treatment they are using and/or administering
23. CLUSTERWhen I sample by surveying entire, convenient, heterogeneous groups, it is a
sample.
149
Chapter 3
1
R E P R E S E N T A T I
V E
A
3
4
5
S T R A T I
F I
E D
B L O C K S
12
16
O
P
7
10
E
S
C O M P A R E
M
N O N R E S P O N S E
T
R
R A N D O M L Y
17
13
11
14
15
S A M P L E
18
19
V O L U N T A R Y R E S P O N S E
A S
20
22
N
25
21
C O N T R O L
C O N F O U N D I
P L A C E B O
23
24
S T A T I
B I
S T I
N G
26
S U B J
T
E
27
E C T S
Y
28
R E S P O N S E
R
29
S T A T I
EclipseCrossword.com
150
S T I
C A L L Y S I
G N I
F I
C A N T
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 7
Jeane Swaynos
Seminole High School
Sanford, Florida
School Profile
Location and Environment: Seminole High School, a suburban school rich in tradition, is located in
central Florida, about 60 miles north of Walt Disney World. Sanford is a long-established community that
prides itself on its history and family values. This 100-year-old school is the oldest of the eight county high
schools, and a large percentage of the faculty are also Seminole High alumni. Seminole High is the only
magnet high school in the county with an International Baccalaureate Program as well as an Academy
of Health Careers. As a result, more than 700 students come from other areas of the county to be a part
of these programs. We also have approximately 1,100 students who are below grade level and therefore in
remedial reading and/or math courses. English is the second language in about 13 percent of the homes;
approximately 38 percent of the student body qualifies for free or reduced-fee lunches; and our students
have close to a 30 percent mobility rate.
Grades: 912
Type: Public high school
Total Enrollment: 3,100
Ethnic Diversity: Our student body is 23 percent African American, 17 percent Hispanic/Latino, 7 percent
Asian American, and 5 percent multiracial
College Record: About 30 percent of the graduates go on to college.
Personal Philosophy
I believe that every student can learn and apply some parts of the AP Statistics objectives. It is important
that students see the relevance of this course in their daily lives. My primary goal is to give them the
tools necessary to read critically when making decisions and to make those decisions based on sound
statistics. Another significant aim of this class is to show students the wide variety of practical applications
of noncalculus-based mathematics. Often students see themselves as poor mathematicians because they
struggle with precalculus and calculus. Statistics shows them another branch of mathematics and opens
them up to the possibility that there are many other avenues to take when furthering their mathematical
knowledge.
Class Profile
AP Statistics has been taught at Seminole High since 1999, with two or three sections offered each year, all
taught by me. Each class typically has between 20 and 25 students. We operate on a seven-period day, with
all classes meeting five days a week for 49 minutes, except for Wednesday, which is a shorter day with only
40 minutes per class.
151
Chapter 3
1
AP Statistics classes are composed of a mixture of students, equally divided between two types. In the
first group are highly motivated students who are enrolled in Pre-IB courses and take AP Statistics as an
elective. Others are sophomores who are enrolled in Precalculus as well. We also have a number of seniors
who have completed AP Calculus BC and are taking this subject as another elective.
The second group is made up mainly of seniors, some of whom have never taken an AP course before
and who have completed no math course beyond Algebra 2. Some have a weak reading level or poor
study skills, and enrolling in an AP class exposes them to the work necessary to be successful in college.
The Health Academy students often sign up for AP Statistics because they see a need for this subject in
their field.
A majority of students have part-time jobs, working on average 20 hours a week. Keeping everyone
engaged in the learning process has been a challenge.
Course Overview
The AP Statistics course at Seminole High incorporates the curriculum set forth in the Topic Outline of the
AP Statistics Course Description in the order presented by the textbook that I use: The Practice of Statistics
(second edition) by Yates, Moore, and Starnes. There are four quarterly grading periods, each nine weeks
long. The first semester runs from August through January, and the second, from February through June.
All AP Statistics students are required to take the AP Exam. This exam is funded by the state of Florida,
and students taking an AP course get a weighted grade of 1.0 for the class. Students must maintain a C
for the weighted grade and are required to take the end-of-year state assessment.
There are computer labs on campus, but reading students and low-level classes are given first priority
for these facilities. The statistics class has access to the lab about once every nine-week period. All students
have a TI-83 or equivalent calculator that they use at home and in school. Students are loaned calculators
for the year if they are not able to afford one. This service is free of charge and available to all students in
Algebra 2 or above.
One of our schools goals is to increase enrollment in AP courses. The administration is more
concerned with enrollment in the classes than with the students grades on the AP Exam. The faculty and
administration want to expose students to higher-level courses and therefore will accept a wide range of
student abilities in AP courses. Studies show that students who take AP courses are more successful in
college than those who have not had this opportunity. There are no prerequisites listed for the courses
only suggested recommendations. For AP Statistics, that is completion of Algebra 2. There are, however,
some advanced IB students who take Algebra 2 concurrently with AP Statistics, and if they work hard, they
are successful.
My specific objectives for this course are that the students acquire the following skills:
They are able to apply statistical concepts when collecting information and make informed decisions
using statistics accurately.
They develop an appreciation for the depth of understanding that statistics add to real-life situations
and understand how statistics could be used to help visualize and add mathematical facts to
subjective situations.
152
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Course Planner
The following abbreviations and short titles are used to indicate source material: ABS = Activity-Based
Statistics (Scheaffer et al.); APS = AP Statistics (Bohan); DTD = Statistics: Decisions Through Data video
(COMAP); FF = Fifty Fathoms (Erickson); FRQ = AP Exam free-response question from past exams (AP
Central and the printed Released Exams); ISDA = Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis (Peck et al.);
PS (the main textbook) = The Practice of Statistics, 2nd ed. (Yates et al.); SFE = Statistics for Experimenters
(Box et al.); SMW = Stats: Modeling the World (Bock et al.); and VS = Visual Statistics (Doane et al.). See the
Teacher Resources section in this syllabus for full citations.
Practice free-response questions are usually graded very generously, and students are allowed to work
on them in groups. The questions that are not designated practice are done individually and graded more
stringently.
Resources
DTD, unit 1: What Is
Statistics?
ISDA, Published Data, pp. 86
and 136
SMW, read pp. 24
Graphical displays of various Sec. 1.1: Displaying
distributions
Distributions with Graphs
Define the various shapes of
Stem-and-leaf plots
graphs.
Define categorical and
quantitative variables.
Describe the center, shape, and
spread of a distribution.
Stem-and-leaf plots.
Homework
PS, read sec. 1.1 and complete
the first part of the guided
notes.
Project: Find an article
involving statistics, and
write a short summary. Due
the day before test 1.
Complete the data sheet. (This
asks students to provide
general information about
their schedules, themselves,
and their families for survey
purposes.)
PS, chap. 1, problem nos. 48
Resources
DTD, unit 2: Stem-and-Leaf
Plots
FF, demo 2: Mean and
Median, p. 24
SMW, p. 52, nos. 15, 16; p. 54,
no. 30
SMW, read pp. 3639
ISDA, p. 64, no. 3.20
153
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
3
Distribution of univariate
data (center, shape, spread)
Skewed distributions
Time plots
Boxplots
Five-number summary and
data sets
Side-by-side boxplots
Resources
ABS, Matching Graphs to
Variables, p. 12
DTD, unit 5: Boxplots
SMW, read pp. 6162 and 6869
Define IQR median and mean
PS, chap. 1, nos. 2932, 3436
of a distribution using
student-generated data. Find SMW, p. 107, no. 11
the IQR and determine if
there are outliers.
Activity
On the board have student
groups display and describe
the data collected from day 2
homework.
Resources
VS, chap. 1, p. 19
154
Homework
PS, chap. 1, nos. 9, 10, 1214,
16, 18, 19
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
7
Split stemplot
Effects of changing units on
summary measures
Homework
PS, chap. 1, nos. 4143
Practice FRQs, 2001 nos. 1
and 6A
Resources
FRQ, 2001 no. 1
VS, chap. 3, p. 55; chap. 4, p. 74
Various ways of describing
Review guided notes for chap. 1. PS, chap. 1, nos. 4951
data: advantages and
Using five simple data entries,
disadvantages
find the standard deviation,
Practice FRQs, 2004 no. 1,
working through each part of
2002 no. 1
Finding the standard
deviation without technology
the formula
Resources
SMW, read pp. 8384
ABS, Capture/Recapture,
pp. 126-29
Technology to find the mean Students work with partners to
and standard deviation
find the mean and standard
deviation of class-generated
data.
Resources
FF, demo 4: Transforming
the Mean and Standard
Deviation, p. 28
WS, activities 4.12 and 4.13,
p. 66; 6.8, p. 98
TEST 1 (chap. 1)
10
11
12
13
Review of test 1
Sec. 2.1: Density Curves and the
Normal Distribution
Practice FRQs, 2005B no. 1,
2006B no. 1
PS, outside activity 2A: Finegrained Distribution
Board problems to determine if PS, read sec. 2.2; chap. 2,
data are normal
nos. 1214, 18
Sec. 2.2: Standard Normal
Calculations
Resources
DTD, unit 7: Normal Curve
ISDA, p. 134, no. 4.40
155
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
14
Finding the area given the
z-score
Finding the z-score given
the area
15
Normality plots
16
Technology to create a
normality plot
Technology to find the
z-score and/or area
Methods for assessing
normality
17
Resources
DTD, unit 8: Normal
Calculations
Board problems: finding z-score PS, chap. 2, nos. 3133, 35,
and area
38, 39
Assessing normality
FRQ, 2003 nos. 3A and 3B
Resources
FF, demo 3: What Do Normal
Data Look Like?
SMW, read p. 97
Review guided notes for chap. 2. PS, chap. 2, nos. 40, 41, 4648
Use calculator to find the
z-score and area and to create FRQ, 1999 no. 4
a normality plot.
Review chap. 1 with ABS
Read Is It Normal?
activity.
Resources
Flanagan-Hyde, Is It Normal?
(AP Central)
TEST 2 (chaps. 1 and 2)
18
19
Scatterplots: definition,
interpretation, and analysis
of patterns
Review of test 2
Sec. 3.1: Scatterplots
Response and explanatory
variables
Activity
Plant project (see the Student
Activities section of this
syllabus )
Resources
DTD, unit 11: Scatterplots
SMW, read pp. 116-17
156
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
20
Linear regression (plant
project)
Bivariate data: finding the
correlation and linearity of
the relation
21
22
23
24
25
Homework
PS, chap. 3, nos. 1518
Resources
SMW, read pp. 127-29
Resources
PS, chap. 3, nos. 2123, 25, 28,
29, 32
FF, demo 6: Least Squares
Linear Regression, p. 34
FF, demo 8: Devising the
Correlation Coefficient, p. 38
VS, chap. 18: Visualizing
Regression Models, p. 353
Define r2 and read a computer
PS, chap. 3, nos. 3437; read
printout.
sec. 3.3
Resources
DTD, unit 13: Correlation
ISDA, read p. 157
Activity
As a group, work through
finding the SSM and SSE of
four data points. Calculate r2.
Review guided notes.
Board problems
Resources
SMW, read Butterfly Ballot,
pp. 167-68
Board problems
Resources
ISDA, Correlation, p. 175,
nos. 5.30, 5.31; p. 189,
nos. 5.42, 5.43
SMW, read pp. 147-52
157
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
Activities and Resources
26
Linear regression concepts
Board problems
applied to problems for
Answer questions about the
which students have
plant project.
generated their own data
Reading a computer printout Resources
SMW, read pp. 152-53
VS, chap. 15, p. 287
27
Review for test 3
Problem no. 65 in class
Work in groups at the board to
complete review problems.
28
TEST 3 (chaps. 1, 2, and 3)
29
Exponential and power
Sec. 4.1: Transforming
functions in relation to
Relationships
statistics
Review log properties.
Importance of linear
relationship in statistics
30
Transformations of
Sec. 4.2: Cautions About
exponential functions
Correlations and Regressions
Transformations in relation Making transformations of
to the residual plot
exponential functions
31
158
Transformations of power
functions and their relation
to residual plots
32
33
Resources
DTD, unit 16: Questions of
Causation
ISDA, p. 206, no. 5.52; p. 210,
no. 5.61
ABS, Matching Graph to
Scatterplot, pp. 5055
Making transformations of
power functions
Homework
PS, chap. 3, nos. 57, 60, 61
Practice FRQs 1999 no. 1, 2000
no. 1
Residual plots
Making residual plots using the
calculator
Sec. 4.3: Relations to Categorical PS, chap. 4, nos. 5054
Data
Confounding variables
Lurking variables
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
34
Using distribution tables
to determine conditional
probabilities
Simpsons Paradox
35
36
Review: describing data with
graphs and numerical values
37
38
39
Homework
PS, chap. 4, nos. 5962
Homework
PS, read sec. 5.1; chap. 5,
problem nos. 16, 10, 11, 13,
15, 16
Sampling techniques
Activity
Explain the survey project. With
a partner, students design two Complete the survey project.
ways to ask the same question
to gather information about a SMW, p. 13, nos. 114
particular topic.
Resources
DTD, unit 18: Survey
DTD, unit 15: Designing
Experiments
SMW, read pp. 68, 246-55, and
263, nos. 15
ABS, Random Rectangles,
pp. 99102
Describe the various types of
sampling techniques.
Resources
SFE, Random Sampling,
pp. 28, 64; Experimental
Error, p. 24
SMW, read pp. 229-34
ISDA, p. 27, no. 2.17; p. 55,
no. 2.23
159
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
3
Random digit table for
choosing subjects in an
experimental design
Three principles of
experimental design
Resources
ISDA, read pp. 29; 37, no. 32
Randomization in relation to Randomization and why it is
PS, chap. 5, nos. 3436
statistical inference
important
Biased samples
Resources
SMW, p. 243, nos. 46, 12, 13
Diagrams to explain
Principles of experimental
PS, chap. 5, nos. 3739, 41, 42
experimental design
design
Randomization of treatment Drawing an experimental design
RAT (random allocation of
Confounding variables
treatment)
Blocking
Confounded variables
Resources
SFE, Blocking, pp. 102-5
SMW, p. 244, nos. 15, 16
ISDA, p. 36, no. 28
Activity
Writing the alphabet backward
with/without practice
Resources
SMW, p. 263, nos. 3, 5
Sec. 5.3: Simulating Experiments PS, chap. 5, nos. 56, 58
Chance behavior
FRQs, 1997 no. 2, 1998 no. 3
Assigning digits
Activity
Problem no. 70 (birthday)
160
Homework
PS, read sec. 5.2
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
9
Experimental design and the
plant project
10
11
12
13
Activity
ABS, Streaky Behavior: Runs in
Binomial Trials, p. 65
14
15
Independent events in
relation to disjointed events
Resources
Problem 6.3, p. 334: class
activity
Computer lab activity with Venn PS, chap. 6, nos. 1921, 23,
diagrams
2426
Basic probability simulations
Independence and the
PS, chap. 6, nos. 2729, 31,
multiplication rule
3235
FRQ, 1997 no. 3
161
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
16
Applying probability
concepts to application
problems
Rule for justifying
independence of events
17
18
19
Conditional probability
How to prove events are
independent
20
21
22
23
Random variables
Applying probability to
random events
162
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
24
Normal distribution in
relation to a histogram
Applying a probability
distribution to a histogram
25
26
Resources
ISDA, p. 315, nos. 1214, 19
Types of density curves
Sec. 7.2: Mean and Variance of
Random Variables
Density curve for continuous
random variables in relation Law of large and small numbers
to a probability distribution
Activity
The king of large numbers
The imaginary queen of small
numbers
Resources
SMW, read pp. 276-77
Rules for combining two sets Sec. 7.2: Combining Normal
of data
Random Variables
Rules for means and standard
Applying the rule for mean
and variance when adding
deviation when combining
or subtracting means or
random variables
standard deviations
P
P P
x y
Px y
Px P y
V 2x y
V 2x V 2 y
V 2x y
V 2x V 2 y
V 2a bx
27
b2V 2 x
Resources
FF, demo 22: How Errors Add,
p. 83
SMW, read pp. 313-15; p. 322,
nos. 2428
Activity
PS, chap. 7, nos. 3439, 41
Dice activity (review for chap. 7):
students create their own set of
dice and generate a probability
distribution along with a
histogram.
163
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
Activities and Resources
28
Applying the rules for adding Homework test
and subtracting means and
Problem no. 47 in class
variance to two independent
distributions
Assumptions for combining
two normal variables
29
Review for test 3
Test review questions on the
board
30
31
32
33
34
35
Geometric distribution
Conditions for a geometric
Resources
FF, demo 13: Building the
Binomial Distribution, p. 56
FF, demo 14: More Binomial,
p. 59
Use working:
PS, read sec. 8.2
at least, at most, the
majority of
binomialpdf (n, p, k)
binomials (n, p, k)
1-binomialcdf (n, p, k)
Sec. 8.2: Geometric Distribution PS, chap. 8, nos. 3739
P(x = k) = (1-p) (k-1)p
Resources
ABS, Waiting for Reggie, p. 79
FF, demo 47: Wait Time and
the Geometric Distribution
164
Homework
PS, chap. 7, nos. 42, 4446, 48
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
Activities and Resources
Homework
36
Mean for a geometric
Complete guided notes for
PS, chap. 8, nos. 4447, 50, 54
probability
chap. 8.
Find mean of geometric 1/p.
FRQ, 2001 no. 3
Using the calculator to find
the probability of a geometric
probability
37
Review chaps. 18
Semester exam review: work on PS, chap. 8, nos. 5557, 59, 60
questions from chaps. 7 and 8.
FRQ, 1998 nos. 6B, C, D, E
38
TEST 4 (chaps. 7 and 8)
Semester review
39
Exam review: chaps. 5 and 6 NINE-WEEK EXAM
Semester review
40
Exam review: chaps. 7 and 8
41
SEMESTER EXAM
Homework
FRQ, 1998 no. 1
Resources
DTD, unit 19: Sampling
Distributions
Complete problem no. 7 in class. PS, read sec. 9.2; also chap. 9,
nos. 1217
Display the sampling
distribution.
Sec. 9.2: Sampling Proportions
PS, chap. 9, nos. 2530
Resources
FF, demo 23: Sampling
Distributions and Sample
Size, p. 85
FF, demo 30: Where Does That
Root p(1-p) Come From?
Review sec. 9.2.
PS, chap. 9, nos. 3234, 3941
Sec. 9.3: Sample Mean, Sampling
Error
ISDA, p. 410, no. 8.9
165
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
5
Central limit theorem
Compare the CLT to the law
of large numbers
7
8
10
166
Applying sampling
distributions to proportion
and mean problems
Homework
PS, chap. 9, nos. 43, 4549;
complete guided notes
for chap. 9
Activity
Computer lab
TEST 1 (chaps. 8 and 9)
PS, read sec. 10.1
Sec. 10.1: Introduction to
PS, chap. 10, nos. 1, 24
Inference and Estimating with
Confidence
V
CI = X z *
n
Resources
DTD, unit 20: Confidence
Intervals
ABS, Confidence Intervals,
p. 120
Activity
Given a situation, have each
student find his or her own
confidence interval and
display this on the overhead
(PS, p. 541).
Resources
ABS, How Many Tanks?,
pp. 148-50
FF, demo 32: How the Width
of a Confidence Interval
Depends on N, p. 110
Sample size conditions and
assumptions
V
MOE z*
n
Finding the z*
Calculator steps
Resources
FF, demo 29: Capturing with
Confidence Intervals
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
11
Tests of significance
Null and alternative
hypothesis
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Homework
PS, chap. 10, nos. 2124; read
sec. 10.2
Resources
FF, demo 44: Power, p. 144
TEST 2 (chaps. 9 and 10)
PS, read sec. 11.1
Sec. 11.1: Inference for the Mean PS, chap. 11, nos. 24, 79
of a Population
t distributions
Degrees of freedom
Problem no. 5 in class
Resources
VS, chap. 9, p. 165
167
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
21
Applying the one-sample t
test to a matched pair design
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
168
Homework
PS, chap. 11, nos. 10, 13, 15
Resources
FF, demo 38: Using a t Test to
Compare Means, p. 129
Power of a t test
Resources
FF, demo 44: Power, p. 144
Applying a test of
Sec. 11.2: Comparing Two
significance when comparing
Means
two means
Conditions and assumptions
Assumptions and conditions Conclusions
necessary for comparing two Calculator steps
means
Using the graphing
Resources
calculator to find the P-value
VS, chap. 10, p. 187
for a test of significance
when comparing two means ISDA, p. 575, no. 11.55
Reading a computer printout Reading computer printouts
for a two-sample t test
Pooled and unpooled procedures
Pooled and unpooled data
Resources
ISDA, p. 584, nos. 64, 65
Applying the principles
One- and two-sample
of a two-sample t test and
procedures for test or
matched pair t test using
confidence intervals
self-generated data
Activity
Hula-Hoop activity for
comparing two means
Applying a t test with selfComplete Hula-Hoop activity
generated data
and review rubric.
TEST 3 (chaps. 10 and 11)
Using statistical inference
Chap. 12: Inference for
with categorical data
Proportions
Sec. 12.1: Inference for a
Standard error of a
proportion
Population Proportion
Assumptions and conditions Conditions and assumptions
for a test of proportion
p(1 p)
n
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
Activities and Resources
29
Sample size and margin of
Sample size and margin of error
error for a proportion test
Calculator steps
Using the graphing calculator
for a proportion test
30
Comparing two proportions Sec. 12.2: Comparing Two
when doing a confidence
Proportions
interval
Parts of the test and confidence
interval
Standard error for a twosample proportion
1
1
pc (1 pc )
n1 n2
Pooled and unpooled
Standard error
31
Using the calculator for one- Calculator steps
and two-proportion tests and
for confidence intervals
32
Review chaps. 11 and 12
Review for test 4
33
TEST 4 (chaps. 11 and 12)
34
Review chaps. 912
FRQs, 1999 no. 2, 2002 no. 6
35
Review chaps. 912
FRQ, 2004 no. 5A
36
NINE-WEEK EXAM
Homework
PS, chap. 12, nos. 10, 12, 15,
16; read sec. 12.2
FRQ, 2006B no. 4
PS, chap. 12, nos. 29, 30, 33, 34
FRQs, 2004B nos. 3 and 6A
Resources
VS, chap. 13: Goodness of Fit,
p. 249
Sec. 13.2: Inference for Two-Way PS, chap. 13, nos. 15, 18, 21, 29
Tables
Chi-square test for independence
and homogeneity
Conclusions for chi-square tests
Resources
SMW, read pp. 518-31 and p. 537,
nos. 14
169
Chapter 3
1
Day
Topic
Activities and Resources
4
Reading a computer printout Assumptions and conditions for
for chi-square and linear
chi-square independence test
regression
Calculator steps
Assumptions and conditions Computer printout, pp. 787, 793
for chi-square
5
6
13
14
15
16
17
10
11
12
170
Resources
ABS, Is Your Class Differently
Aged? (chi-square test), p. 163
TEST 1 (chaps. 12 and 13)
PS, read sec. 14.1; chap. 14,
nos. 2, 3
Null and alternative
Sec. 14.1: Inference About the
PS, chap. 14, nos. 6, 11, 12
hypothesis for inference for
Model, Null, and Alternative
regression
Standard error for the slope
Standard error for the slope Residuals and standard error
Reading a computer printout Degrees of freedom
for a linear regression test
Resources
SFE, Residual Checking,
pp. 183-84
TEST 2 (chaps. 13 and 14)
Review: multiple-choice
Practice AP multiple-choice
questions
problems (APS)
Review: multiple-choice
Practice AP multiple-choice
questions
problems (APS)
Review: multiple-choice
Practice AP multiple-choice
questions
problems (APS)
Necessary steps for inference Sec. 15.1: Inference for
for the spread of a population
Population Spread
F test comparing two standard
Applying the F test to
inference
deviations
Reading a computer printout
comparing two standard
deviations
Review: describing data
Review for AP Exam, chaps. 14
8
9
Homework
FRQ, 2003 no. 5
Multiple-choice questions
from the AP Statistics
Course Description
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Topic
18
19
Binary predictors in
regression
20
Trimmed mean
21
Spearman rank
22
Hypogeometric distribution
Homework
Teaching Strategies
I have often found that those students who receive a grade of 2 on the AP Exam have worked the hardest
and have shown the most growth. It is important to keep these students motivated to continue their
education. Sometimes they will not apply to college because they do not see themselves as successful, and
academic achievement is not promoted at home. This course is their first attempt and can set the stage
for college and further education. Keeping these students successful and motivated is one of the most
difficult tasks in teaching AP Statistics. Setting up an environment where they can ask questions and
not be intimidated by the more advanced students has been a challenge. I often seat these students in the
front, where I can see if their facial expressions indicate that they do not understand. The more advanced
students are on the sides of the room, where I can make sure they are on task, or in the back, where
sometimes I give them more challenging problems to work through individually.
A motivating factor for every student is the brag wall above the blackboard in my classroom, where
I post the names of all the students who have achieved a grade of 3 or higher on the AP Exam since 1999.
The names of the students who have received a 5 are larger and in bold letters. This is a strong incentive for
those high-level students who define success as earning a 5. The lower-level students are ecstatic to see their
names posted at all.
I weave a variety of activities into the class, each of which can be adjusted according to the needs of
my students. They range from short activities that engage students as they enter the classroom to larger
projects that are assessed at the end of the semester. For more examples, see the Student Activities section
at the end of this syllabus.
Data-Gathering Activities
Most students understand abstract concepts better when they see the connection with something they have
experienced. I often have students collect data about themselves or the schoolfor example, how many
numbers do you and/or your parents have stored in your cell phone? What is the average tip you leave
in restaurants? How many hours do you spend reading e-mail? How many students do not have parking
stickers? How long do you spend waiting in line in the cafeteria? Students enjoy collecting information that
relates directly to themselves, and we discuss how data are often used to make decisions or persuade people
to think in a certain manner. The data are displayed in hand-drawn graphs, and students are required to
explain and interpret the distributions in written assignments. This is followed by a short demonstration
to the class. After drawing graphs by hand, students use the calculator to produce the same type of display.
171
Chapter 3
1
Through exploration they find the window adjustments and scales necessary to create a useful graphical
representation. I find the kinesthetic learner benefits the most from these strategies, and all students start
to see the usefulness of statistics from the very beginning of the year.
Exploration Activities
Students often use the calculator to explore concepts by using simulation and trial-and-error methods.
For example, they are given five data points and are directed to come up with various means and standard
deviations by manipulating them. An example of the trial-and-error method is shown below.
Students are given a number line from 0 to 20 and are presented with the following task:
Place the dots 2, 7, 10, 13, and 18, and estimate the mean and standard deviation. Check your
estimate using your calculator.
Change the data in the previous item so that the mean is the same but the standard deviation is
about 3.
Place the five numbers so that the mean is 15 and the standard deviation is about 3.
Place four numbers so that the mean is 5, and add 3 to each number. What is the effect on the mean
and standard deviation?
Arrange five numbers so that the standard deviation is larger than the mean.
Jeopardy!
The objective is to review previously learned material and integrate it into the new concepts. We have a
variety of Jeopardy!-type games, presented in PowerPoint, that we often play for a few minutes at the end
of class. The questions are fairly simplegenerally fill-in-the-blank or multiple-choice problems. The
problems for the game were developed by students from earlier years, and the game parallels Jeopardy! in
that the questions are categorized by the chapters in the textbook or by topic. Example: What is the rule for
justifying an outlier?
Physical Movement
I have created a series of physical movements that are linked to various concepts in order to help the
kinesthetic learner. For example, the four conditions of a binomial distribution are each represented by
a unique physical movement. When students enter the classroom, they may be asked to indicate the four
conditions for a binomial distribution by using these physical movements. (Fixed number of outcomes:
stand up straight; two outcomes: hold out the left and right hands; probability remains the same: turn
right and left to show that both sides of ones face are the same; independence: kick with one foot to show
that it is independent of the other foot.) When students come back the next year, they still remember the
movements and the four conditions for binomial distributions.
Guided Notes
Guided notes are used with each chapter to help the low-level reader better understand the material
presented. These notes help students to clarify the important parts of the chapter and to see what concepts
they should have gathered from the reading. Examples can be found at the Mrs. Krummel Web site listed
in my Teacher Resources section.
172
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Acronyms and Audiovisual Aids
Students in the past have developed their own acronyms and musical tunes to aid in the memorization
of concepts, and this helps them recall some of the basic principles involved in the course. I continually
emphasize the need to be able to communicate these concepts and use the memorization device to begin
that process. A visual display of two rats in a box helps students recall the three principles of experimental
design: random allocation of treatment (RAT); replication (indicated by two rats); and control of the
process (represented by the box). I place two plastic rats in a box as the students enter the classroom. When
the bell rings, they have four minutes to explain the three principles of experimental design. For homework
they begin the design of a simple experiment incorporating these principles.
173
Chapter 3
1
which is then averaged in with their other test grades. The replacement option for the fourth-quarter exam
motivates the stronger students, and the extra-credit points encourage the weaker ones to take the mock
exam. If they are not able to attend on Saturday, they must stay after school two days before the scheduled
event to take the exam and receive the same incentives.
In addition to the mock exam, we have two major review sessions with the other schools in the county.
These are held on Saturday mornings. Each teacher presents one of the four major topics of the course,
with students rotating around the classrooms and hearing the topics presented. For each hour that students
attend, they receive three points extra credit that may be used on any test during the fourth quarter.
There are also individual review sessions at each school. At Seminole High School, these take place
after school from 46 p.m. or 57 p.m. Each session is worth extra-credit points if attended. We review the
material using a short PowerPoint presentation, followed by a group activity that applies these concepts.
Because our class periods are only 49 minutes, these two-hour blocks present a unique opportunity to
further review what students should have learned in class. Refreshments are provided. Former students
have said that these review sessions, presented during the two weeks before the exam, were most beneficial
to them.
I have a mathematical library in my classroom. These titles are not textbooks but popular nonfiction
that explores mathematics at the secondary level. The books have been collected over the years,
with some purchased from retired math teachers. Students pick a book to read, write a report about
it, and then design an activity from the book and present it to the class. The report must include
a summary of the book and suggest how other mathematics classes could incorporate it in their
curricula. This was one of the most well-received activitiesstudents enjoyed seeing mathematics
presented in a new light. Here are some of the titles in this library:
Title
Alice in Quantumland
Another Fine Math Youve Got Me Into . . .
Archimedes Revenge
The Art of Mathematics
Beyond Numeracy: Ruminations of a Numbers Man
Bridges to Infinity
A Brief History of Time
Connections: The Geometric Bridge Between Art and Science
Dead Reckoning: Calculating Without Instruments
Descartes Dream
Does God Play Dice?
The Emperors New Mind
174
Author
Robert Gilmore
Ian Stewart
Paul Hoffman
Jerry P. King
John Allen Paulos
Michael Guillen
Stephen Hawking
Jay Kappraff
Ronald W. Doerfler
Philip J. Davis and Reuben Hersh
Ian Stewart
Roger Penrose
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Title
The Enjoyment of Mathematics
Experiments in Topology
Fearful Symmetry: Is God a Geometer?
The Fourth Dimension
From Zero to Infinity
Fuzzy Logic
Game, Set, and Math
Gdel, Escher, Bach: An Eternal Golden Braid
How to Solve Problems
Innumeracy: Mathematical Illiteracy and Its Consequences
Islands of Truth
Mathemagics: How to Look Like a Genius Without Really Trying
The Mathematical Experience
Mathematical Thought from Ancient to Modern Times
(three volumes)
The Mathematical Tourist
The Mathematical Universe
A Mathematician Reads the Newspaper
A Mathematicians Apology
Mathematics and the Search for Knowledge
Mathematics for Everyman
Mathematics for the Million
Mathematics in Art
Mathematics in Western Culture
Mathematics: People, Problems, Results (two volumes)
Mathematics: The Loss of Certainty
Mathsemantics: Making Numbers Talk Sense
Mazes for the Mind
Metamagical Themas
Mind Tools: The Five Levels of Mathematical Reality
The Most Beautiful Mathematical Formulas
The Nature and Growth of Modern Mathematics
Natures Numbers: The Unreal Reality of Mathematical Imagination
Number
100 Great Problems of Elementary Mathematics
On the Shoulders of Giants
Author
Hans Rademacher and
Otto Toeplitz
Stephen Barr
Ian Stewart and Martin Golubitsky
Rudy Rucker
Constance Reid
Daniel McNeill and Paul Freiberger
Ian Stewart
Douglas R. Hofstadter
Wayne A. Wickelgren
John Allen Paulos
Ivars Peterson
Arthur Benjamin and Michael
Brant Shermer
Philip J. Davis and Reuben Hersh
Morris Kline
Ivars Peterson
William Dunham
John Allen Paulos
G. H. Hardy
Morris Kline
Laurie Buxton
Lancelot Hogben
Michael Holt
Morris Kline
Douglas M. Campbell and
John C. Higgins, eds.
Morris Kline
Edward MacNeal
Clifford A. Pickover
Douglas R. Hofstadter
Rudy Rucker
Lionel Salem, Frdric Testard,
and Coralie Salem
Edna E. Kramer
Ian Stewart
John McLeish
Heinrich Drrie
Lynn Arthur Steen, ed.
175
Chapter 3
1
Title
Paradigms Lost
The Paradoxicon
The Penguin Dictionary of Curious and Interesting Geometry
Pi in the Sky: Counting, Thinking, and Being
Practical Reasoning
Prisoners Dilemma
The Problems of Mathematics
Readings in Mathematics, book 2
Thinking Machines
The Tinkertoy Computer
Author
John L. Casti
Nicholas Falletta
David Wells
John D. Barrow
Larry Wright
William Poundstone
Ian Stewart
Irving Adler, ed.
Irving Adler
A. K. Dewdney
Students have designed Jeopardy!-type games (described earlier in this section) and multiple-choice
questions to be used in the following year. They have also done PowerPoint presentations showing
how statistics is involved in the recycling process throughout the country. This project includes
making blankets for the homeless out of recycled plastic grocery bags. Although the Web site
is under construction, a picture of the weaving process for these blankets can be found at
http://home.cfl.rr.com/swaynos.
I have explained how probability is involved in gambling, such as card games that are played on the
Internet.
I have discussed different types of mortgages and how interest is determined using credit cards. The
class has done exploratory activities using the financial applications on the TI-83.
Students receive one grade for each semester. Each nine-week quarterly grade is worth 40 percent, and the
semester exam counts for 20 percent.
176
Tests
45 percent
Homework
20 percent
Participation and quizzes 20 percent
Nine-week exam
15 percent
A = 90100 percent
B = 8089 percent
C = 7079 percent
D = 6069 percent
F = Below 60 percent
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Tests
Approximately five tests are given during each nine-week period. They generally are spiral tests, which
means that they include previously learned concepts. One of them is a take-home test, on which students
may work together. Another is taken directly from the homework problems, which encourages students to
complete the homework and learn the concepts. These two assessments help weaker students to succeed in
the class.
For the other three tests, I put a review sheet online a few days before the test, and students can see me
before or after school to ask questions about it. I collect these sheets at the start of the test, and if the work
has been done satisfactorily, the student may earn up to an additional 10 points on the test. Students who
understand the review sheet are likely to do well on the free-response questions on the test itself.
All the exams are half multiple-choice and half free-response questions and are designed to occupy a
45-minute class period. Students may use calculators and formula sheets at all times.
Homework
Homework takes approximately 3045 minutes a night. It is collected daily and graded on completeness.
The classroom is open every morning at 6:15 so that students can work together to finish their homework.
I am available to tutor and administer makeup tests and quizzes at that time. Students may also make
appointments after school if they are behind in class or need more individual instruction.
At the start of class I put a problem on the overhead and walk around to assess the students
homework. If they made an attempt at every problem, then they generally get full credit for the homework.
No late work is accepted, and if students are sick, they have one day to make up the work for each day of
absence.
Participation
Students go to the board and complete problems at least twice a week, receiving a participation grade for
this work. They have indicated that this is the most successful way of learning to solve problems, and
they enjoy this part of the class. I pair weak and strong students. The less-able students then see that the
stronger ones often do not fully understand the concept either, and this can make them less inhibited
about asking questions. If you do not have enough board space, try small 2 by 3 foot whiteboards that
the students can use at their seats. I can quickly grade the board work, especially the communication
part of the problem. Students listen as I grade their classmates problems and make changes before I get
to their work. Sometimes the more advanced students have poor communication skills but understand
the mathematics. The weaker students may know all the details but often miss important mathematical
procedures. Together they often make a good team and learn from each other.
Students who are absent must take a makeup quiz the next morning to replace this participation
grade. Attendance has occasionally been a problem in the past, and this practice has effectively reduced
unexcused absences.
Students are sometimes given three or four multiple-choice questions at the start of class and may work
together on the answers as a participation grade. The questions come from the previous nights reading
homework. They are posted at the start of class, and students have only a few minutes to work on the
problems. This encourages them to get to class on time and begin working immediately. It also gives them
more practice with multiple-choice questions.
177
Chapter 3
1
Nine-Week Exam
This is given during one 49-minute class period at the end of each nine weeks. It is 75 percent multiplechoice and 25 percent free-response questions.
Teacher Resources
Primary Text
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and George S. McCabe. The Practice of Statistics: TI-83 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. 2nd ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2003.
Supplementary Books
Bock, David E., Paul F. Velleman, and Richard D. De Veaux. Stats: Modeling the World. Boston: Pearson/
Addison-Wesley, 2004.
Bohan, James. AP Statistics: Preparing for the Advanced Placement Examination. New York: AMSCO, 2000.
Box, George E., William G. Hunter, and J. Stuart Hunter. Statistics for Experimenters: An Introduction to
Design, Data Analysis, and Model Building. New York: Wiley, 1978.
College Board. 1997 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 1997.
College Board. 2002 AP Statistics Released Exam. New York: College Board, 2002. (Note: The 2007
Released Exam has become available since this syllabus was submitted.)
Doane, David P., Kieran Mathieson, and Ronald L. Tracy. Visual Statistics 2.0. Boston: McGraw-Hill/Irwin,
2001.
Erickson, Tim. Fifty Fathoms: Statistics Demonstrations for Deeper Understanding. Oakland, Calif.: EEPS
Media, 2002.
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. Pacific Grove, Calif.:
Brooks/Cole, 2001.
Scheaffer, Richard L., Mrudulla Gnanadesikan, Ann Watkins, and Jeffrey A. Witmer. Activity-Based
Statistics: Instructor Resources. New York: Springer, 1996.
Technology
Fathom Dynamic Data Software. Version 2. Emeryville, Calif.: Key Curriculum Press. This is used as a
teaching demonstration, and once every nine weeks the students have computer access.
Texas Instruments. TI-83 Plus/TI-84 graphing calculators.
http://education.ti.com/educationportal/sites/US/homePage/index.html.
Video
Statistics: Decisions Through Data. Written by David S. Moore. Lexington, Mass.: Consortium for
Mathematics and Its Applications (COMAP), 1992. Five videocassettes with users guide (total of 21
video segments).
178
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Web Sites (General)
The following represent the main Web resources used in the course. Some offer online demonstrations
using Java applets that help to illustrate many of the key statistical concepts taught.
AP Central. AP Statistics Course Home Page.
apcentral.collegeboard.com/stats.
An essential resource for all AP teachers. From here you can navigate to the free-response questions
from previous AP exams.
Coons, Al. BB&N AP Statistics.
www.bbn-school.org/us/math/ap_stats.
Teachers site with tests, notes, and links to other sites.
Derksen, Jared. The AP Stats Top 10 FAQs.
www.mrderksen.com/top10.htm.
Fr. Chris AP Statistics.
www.fortunecity.com/campus/anlaby/36.
Teacher site with many resources.
Intuitor.com. Amazing Applications of Probability and Statistics.
http://intuitor.com/statistics/index.html.
Lock, Robin H., Mathematics Department, St. Lawrence University. A Sampler of WWW Resources for
Teaching Statistics.
http://it.stlawu.edu/~rlock/maa51/www.html.
Math Forum@Drexel. AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group Archives.
http://mathforum.org/kb/forum.jspa?forumID=67
Minitab for AP Students.
www.Minitab.com/education/apstatisticshighschool.aspx.
Mrs. Krummel Web site. Teacher site.
http://mrskrummel.com/statteacher.htm.
Guided notes for each chapter of The Practice of Statistics can be found at this site, under YMM
Chapter Outlines, as well as many other resources. There is a semester exam review with 200
problems and answers. Guided notes and the answer key are available for purchase, but the exam
review can be downloaded for free.
Mrs. Smarts AP Statistics Page. Teacher site.
www.lhs.logan.k12.ut.us/~jsmart/stats.html.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics.
http://onlinestatbook.com/rvls.html.
Rice Virtual Lab Simulations/Demonstrations.
http://www.ruf.rice.edu/~lane/stat_sim/.
This portion of the RVLS site has applets that allow students to interact. You can assign activities at
home, if students have computer access.
179
Chapter 3
1
Schott, Brian, Georgia State University. Practice Multiple-Choice Questions for Business Statistics.
www2.gsu.edu/~dscbms/ibs/qcontent.html.
Shodor Education Foundation. Interactivate Activities.
www.shodor.org/interactivate/activities.
W. H. Freeman Co. The Practice of Statistics. 2nd ed. Companion site to the textbook.
http://bcs.whfreeman.com/yates2e.
180
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Dallal, Gerard E., Tufts University. Probability Theory.
www.tufts.edu/~gdallal/prob.htm.
Article about a probability density curve and cumulative density curve.
Chapter 8 (The Binomial and Geometric Distributions)
Exner, Nicholas, University of Illinois at UrbanaChampaign, Department of Statistics. Animal Cards.
www.mste.uiuc.edu/reese/cereal/maincereal.html.
This site shows a geometric distribution.
Chapter 9 (Sampling Distributions)
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics. Simulations/Demonstrations.
www.ruf.rice.edu/~lane/stat_sim/.
This applet displays the central limit theorem. Choose the sampling distribution activity.
Chapter 10 (Introduction to Inference)
Bock, David. Is That an Assumption or a Condition?
See link under Teaching Resource Materials, Statistical Interference on the Statistics Course Home Page
on AP Central.
Dallal, Gerard E., Tufts University. Confidence Intervals.
www.tufts.edu/~gdallal/ci.htm.
Hayden, Robert W. 10% Assumption for Inference.
See link under Teaching Resource Materials, Statistical Interference on the Statistics Course Home Page
on AP Central.
Chapter 11 (Inference for Distributions)
Bullard, Floyd. On Power.
See link under Teaching Resource Materials, Statistical Interference on the Statistics Course Home Page
on AP Central.
Chapter 12 (Inference for Proportions)
Peltier, Charles. Why Do We Pool for the Two-Proportion z-Test?
See link under Teaching Resource Materials, Statistical Interference on the Statistics Course Home Page
on AP Central.
Student Activities
Foldables
Foldables are three-dimensional, interactive, graphic organizers that students make themselves and use to
learn and review critical concepts and vocabulary terms. They are fashioned by folding and cutting paper,
and they often have flaps that can be lifted to reveal information. Patterns for creating them are available
in various styles and designs that students can adapt to any subject. Below are several URLs for Web sites
with examples of foldables used in history or science classes. This same concept can easily be adapted for
statistics. Making foldables gives students a visual tool to store, organize, and recall a large quantity of
information.
www.eemes.ccs.k12.nc.us/candler/PDF/foldables.pdf
www.dinah.com/egroup/Archives.htm
181
Chapter 3
1
http://ushistory.pwnet.org/resources/pdf/Geography_Foldables_Photo.pdf
www.ehhs.cmich.edu/~dnewby/DinahZikefoldables.doc
My students create graphic organizers at the end of each chapter of the textbook, defining each concept
and presenting a problem that incorporates that concept. The vocabulary words that were introduced in
the chapter are also included. If the foldable is graded as part of a test, it is usually worth about 10 percent.
If I know the test is difficult, I use the foldable as 10 points extra credit. At the end of the quarter, I may
assign a take-home test, asking students to design a foldable that could be used on their nine-week exam.
Creative students often excel in this activity, whereas the stronger mathematical students sometimes have
difficulty with neatness and the imaginative aspects of the task. We begin this project during a short class
period, and I make sure that paper, glue, scissors, and decorative markers are available. At the beginning
of the year, I display several examples from past classes, talk about the benefits of completing an organizer,
and demonstrate how to use it to study. The scoring guidelines are also explained. Below is a modified
rubric that I have used in the past.
Mathematical thoroughness
45 points
Creativity
25 points
On time
10 points
Neatness
10 points
Durability
10 points
(Have you included all the necessary concepts with examples for each?
Are the vocabulary words clearly defined?)
(Have you used your personality and creative imagination in the design?)
(Due [date here], before you take your exam)
(Is it clearly written and nicely displayed?)
(Can you continue to use it for the remainder of the year?)
How are the hours you spend doing homework related to the number of hours you spend
reading e-mail?
How is the percentage of the tip you leave at a restaurant related to the price of your meal?
How is the simulated probability from playing poker related to the theoretical probability?
How is the amount of coffee you drink related to the amount of water you drink?
How is your arm span related to your height?
Students usually become genuinely excited about this kind of assignment if they are addressing a question
that interests them rather than being delegated a predetermined task. They collect bivariate data, indicating
both the independent and dependent variable and what units were used. They create boxplots and
histograms for the univariate data and scatterplots, with a residual plot, for the bivariate data.
182
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
The assignment also requires defining the slope, correlation, and coefficient of determination in the context
of their data. Students experience the problems that come with actually collecting their own data. They see
that zeros often are problems or that a large number of outliers may require adjustments to the data.
Students are then expected to connect the information in their display to their question of interest in
a short presentation to the class (four minutes). They should be able to explain and interpret all numerical
output and to make a reasonable prediction for some input value that will be asked for during the
presentation. The small display boards that I use for this exercise are easy to store and can be brought out
in future years as examples. In many ways, this activity mimics a miniature science-fair project.
This small project is counted as a test grade, and the evaluation of each board follows this general
format: on time (5); neatness (10); creativity (15); mathematical concepts (20); graphs (20); organization,
grammar, and spelling (10); use of technology (5); and presentation to the class (15).
Plant Project
When linear regression is first introduced, each student is given two paper cups filled with potting soil
and four bean seeds. (Purchase seeds that germinate quickly so data can be collected within two weeks
time. Usually only one or two actually germinate and grow. If more than one seed per cup germinates,
the student keeps only the one that looks the strongest.) They are instructed to fertilize one cup daily
with Miracle-Gro and the other daily with worm tea, a natural fertilizer that comes from the castings
of worms. They measure the height of their plants for 10 days, and then we do a linear regression with
x equaling the total amount of fertilizer and y the height of the plant. The students do not follow any
structured rules of experimental design. They complete a worksheet after the chapter 3 review of the
concepts of linear regression.
When we study experimental design in chapter 5, the same experiment is done again, this time
following the correct procedures for randomization of treatment and placement of the plants. We use
the first experiment as the foundation to talk about lurking and confounded variables and also how we
could incorporate blocking into our design. One student is assigned to do all the watering of both groups
of plants.
Hula-Hoop Activity
When testing the difference between two means, students form groups, and we gather data on how many
rotations males and females can complete when spinning a plastic Hula-Hoop around their waists. We also
do a matched pair design for revolving the hoop clockwise versus counterclockwise. We use one period to
183
Chapter 3
1
collect the data, and the next day the data are analyzed. This activity gives the more coordinated students
an opportunity to excel.
UNO Cards
Often in high school a substantial number of students are pulled out of class for assemblies, senior lunch,
pep rallies, field trips, band trips, photos, PSAT/NMSQT or state testing, and so on. This makes teaching
new materialor even reviewing old materialdifficult. When more than one-third of my class is removed
for some such event, I use this activity with the students who are left: I write an easy review question on
each card in an UNO deck. As they play the game, students must answer the question before using the
card. After the AP Exam, students can create their own decks of cards for next years students.
184
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sample Syllabus 8
Josh Tabor
Glen A. Wilson High School
Hacienda Heights, California
School Profile
Location and Environment: Hacienda Heights is an unincorporated, largely residential area, about 20
miles east of downtown Los Angeles. Its best-known landmark is the Hsi Lai Temple, one of the largest
Buddhist temples in the Western Hemisphere, whose architecture mimics that of ancient Chinese
monasteries. A significant proportion of students at Glen A. Wilson High come from homes where English
is not the primary language. The school offers AP courses in 17 subjects; 754 AP Exams were taken in 2007,
with 68 percent of the students receiving grades of 3 or better.
Grades: 912
Type: Public high school
Total Enrollment: Approximately 1,800
Ethnic Diversity: In 2006-07, the student population was approximately 44 percent Hispanic/Latino and
43 percent Asian American.
College Record: Approximately 54 percent of graduating seniors go to four-year colleges, and an additional
39 percent go to two-year colleges.
Personal Philosophy
Teaching AP Statistics has been the most rewarding and enjoyable experience I have had as an educator. It
has been a great opportunity to work with college-bound students, giving them a challenging college-level
course that will prepare them for study in almost any field. Numerous alumni have returned to tell me how
valuable AP Statistics was and how well-prepared they felt for college.
Class Profile
At Glen A. Wilson High School we offer between two and four sections of AP Statistics each year, with
an average class size of about 32. I am the only statistics teacher. The prerequisite for the course is a
passing grade in Algebra 2, although many students complete Precalculus first. Concurrent enrollment
in Precalculus or AP Calculus is allowed. We are on a traditional daily schedule with 55-minute periods.
The school year usually begins after Labor Day and ends in mid-June. It consists of two semesters, with
progress reports mailed to the students homes every six weeks. The relatively late start proves to be a
challenge each year, but I manage to finish the curriculum by the early May AP Exam date and use the
time after the exam to explore additional topics, such as multiple regression and ANOVA.
Students are encouraged to take the AP Exam, but it is not a class requirement. Typically, at least
80 percent of my students choose to take the exam.
There is no regularly scheduled laboratory for the course; students go to the computer lab only once
during the year, although they are given several assignments to do at home on a computer (or in the
computer lab on their own time).
185
Chapter 3
1
Course Overview
The primary text used in this class is the first edition of Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis by
Roxy Peck, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. (See full citation in the Teacher Resources section later in this
syllabus.) I begin the course with the second section of the Topic Outline in the AP Statistics Course
Description, Sampling and Experimentation: Planning and conducting a study. This is the first major
topic in our textbook and seems a natural place to start, as planning a study is the first step in the statistical
process. We then move to the outlines first topic, Exploring Data: Describing patterns and departures
from patterns; the third, Anticipating Patterns: Exploring random phenomena using probability and
simulation; and finish with the fourth section, Statistical Inference: Estimating population parameters
and testing hypotheses.
learn a variety of statistical tests and estimation procedures and understand which is appropriate for
a particular study;
use statistical data and reasoning skills to make inferences and communicate them in a clear written
format;
read and analyze articles and studies from current news sources and apply statistical methods to
assess validity; and
organize, summarize, and effectively present collected data using technology, including graphing
calculators and computers.
Course Planner
Vacation days and student-released days are not included in the days of instruction. Thanksgiving usually
occurs around day 60, winter break near day 73, and spring break just after day 134. In the chart below,
FRQ refers to an AP Exam free-response question (available on AP Central). The 1997 questions are from
the printed Released Exam. The newspaper articles cited are ones that I have accumulated over the years.
Most of the time I just read the article to the class, although in some cases I make photocopies. HW means
homework; throughout, the decimal numbers following HW refer to problem numbers.
SEMESTER 1
Day
Section and Title
1
The Role of Statistics
(chapter 1)
2
3
186
Activities/Assignments
Class: Sexual discrimination activity
HW: Read pp. 110; problems 1.17
HW: 2.12.4
Class: Gettysburg Address activityuse Rossmanchance.coms Sampling
Words (see the Teacher Resources section of this syllabus)
HW: Read pp. 2022; article and questions: Pollings Dirty Little
Secret, Week in Review, New York Times, Nov. 21, 1999
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Section and Title
4
Bias in Sampling (2.4)
Stratified Random
Samples (2.4)
Other Sampling
Methods (2.4)
Experiments and
Observational Studies
(2.22.3)
Designing Experiments
(2.5)
10
11
Designing Experiments,
continued (2.5)
More Designing
Experiments (2.5)
Activities/Assignments
Class: Putting a Reality Check on Holocaust Denial, USA Today,
Jan. 12, 1994
HW: 2.16, 2.1922
HW: 2.11, 2.12; article and questions: How to Tell if Political Polls Are
About Truth, or Consequences, Los Angeles Times, Jan. 30, 2000
Class: Use NCSSMs Rolling Down the River (see Teacher Resources
section)
HW: 2.10, 2.13, 2.17, 2.18
Class: FRQ, 2004B no. 2
HW: Sampling worksheet
HW: Read pp. 1519, problems 2.5, 2.79
HW: Read pp. 2735; worksheet: Wildcat Arena. (I give students a
drawing of a basketball arenadifferent levels, different sections
and then ask them to use each of the sampling methods we have
learned to get a sample of people from the arena.)
HW: 2.23, 2.25, 2.26
Class: FRQ, 1999 no. 3
HW: 2.2830, 2.32
HW: Articles and questions: Study: Clot-busters Work in Lungs, Too,
Herald-Sun (Durham, N.C.), Aug. 5, 1997; Study: Schizophrenia
Drug May Help Alzheimers Patients, Herald-Sun (Durham, N.C.),
Dec. 11, 1997
Class: FRQ, 2000 no. 5
HW: 2.33, 2.36, 2.3840
Class: FRQ, 2006B no. 5
HW: Articles and questions: Duke Study Measures Prayers Healing
Effects, Herald-Sun (Durham, N.C.) Nov. 10, 1998; Brisk Walks
Can Lengthen Your Life, Study Finds, Herald-Sun (Durham, N.C.),
Feb. 11, 1998
12
13
Caffeine Experiment
(2.5)
14
Review: chapter 2
15
16
Test: chapter 2
Displaying Categorical
HW: 3.2, 3.3, 3.7, 3.10, 3.11
Data: Bar and Pie Charts
(3.1)
Displaying Numerical
HW: 3.12, 3.1520
Data: Dotplots and
Stem-and-Leaf Displays
(3.2)
Displaying Numerical
HW: 3.3234, 3.36
Data: Frequency
Distributions and
Histograms (3.3)
17
18
187
Chapter 3
1
Day
Section and Title
19
Cumulative Relative
Frequency Distributions
(3.3)
20 Describing the Center of
a Data Set (4.1)
21
Measures of Spread (4.2)
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
188
More Measures of
Spread/Boxplots
(4.24.3)
More on Standard
Deviation/Using the
TI-83 (4.4)
More on Standard
Deviation (4.4)
Shifting and Rescaling
Data (not in book)
Review: chapters 3 and 4
37
Review: chapter 5
38
Review: chapter 5
Activities/Assignments
Class: FRQ, 2006 no. 1
HW: chapter 3 worksheet
HW: 4.2, 4.3, 4.57, 4.9, 4.16, 4.17
Class: FRQ, 2006B no. 1
HW: 4.19, 4.21, 4.25
HW: 4.2933
Class: FRQ, 2005 no. 1
HW: 4.2224, 4.34
HW: 4.3541, 4.44
HW: Read pp. 135-37; problems 3.46, 3.49, 4.51, 4.52, 4.58, 4.59, 4.61,
4.64
Class: FRQ, 2004 no. 1; matching distributions (from Activity-Based
Statistics)
HW: JMP Student Edition worksheet (see the Teacher Resources section)
HW: 5.19, odd
Class: Use Geometers Sketchpads Least Squares applet (see the
Teacher Resources section)
HW: 5.26, 5.27, 5.29, 5.30
HW: 5.47, 5.48
Class: FRQ, 1998 no. 2
HW: 5.38ad + residual plot; 5.39a, b; 5.43a, d
HW: 5.4042, 5.4446, 5.49
HW: Regression output worksheet
HW: 5.1012, 5.14, 5.1618
HW: 5.3135
Class: Use Linear Regression applet (see the Teacher Resources section)
HW: Review worksheet
Class: Introduce first-semester project
Class: FRQ, 1999 no. 1
HW: Work on project proposals
Class: FRQ, 2005 no. 3
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Section and Title
39 Test: chapter 5
40 Review for midterm
41
Review for midterm
42
43
44
45
Midterm
Chance Experiments
and Events (6.1)
Definition of Probability
(6.2)
Basic Properties of
Probability (6.3)
Conditional
Probability (6.4)
Independence (6.5)
6.5 continued
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
Some General
Probability Rules (6.6)
Review: 6.16.6
Estimating Probabilities
Using Simulation (6.7)
More Simulations (6.7)
More Simulations (6.7)
Review: chapter 6
Review: chapter 6
Test: chapter 6
Project presentations
Project presentations
Discrete Random
Variables (7.17.2)
Continuous Random
Variables (7.3)
Mean of a Random
Variable (7.4)
Standard Deviation of a
Random Variable (7.4)
Activities/Assignments
Class: FRQ, 2006 no. 5
Class: Use NCSSMs The Midge Problem (see the Teacher Resources
section)
Class: Midge problem
Class: Collect project proposals
Class: FRQ, 2005 no. 1
HW: 6.13, 6.5, 6.12
HW: 6.8, 6.9, 6.11, 6.13
HW: 6.1518, 6.20, 6.21, 6.24, 6.26, 6.27
HW: 6.2935
HW: 6.3644
Class: FRQ, 2003B no. 2
HW: 6.4552
HW: 6.5361
HW: 6.6269
HW: Read pp. 285-91; problem 6.71; simulation worksheet, problems 12
HW: Simulation worksheet, problems 34
HW: 6.75 (do five runs); simulation worksheet, problem 5
HW: Review worksheet, problems 15
Class: FRQ, 2001 no. 3
189
Chapter 3
1
Day
Section and Title
65 Linear Functions and
Linear Combinations
(7.4)
66 7.4 continued
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
190
Binomial Distribution
(7.5)
More on the Binomial
Distribution (7.5)
Geometric Distribution
(7.5)
Review: 7.17.5
The Normal
Distribution (7.6)
Other Normal
Distributions (7.6)
Using TI-83 Distribution
Menu (7.6)
Combining Normal
Random Variables (7.6)
Normal Approximation
to the Binomial
Distribution (7.8)
Review: chapter 7
Review: chapter 7
Test: chapter 7
Sampling Distributions
(8.1)
How Many Textbooks?
(8.1)
Activities/Assignments
HW: 7.29, 7.30, 7.34, 7.40
Class: FRQ, 2001 no. 2
HW: 7.38, 7.39, 7.41; worksheet, problem 4
HW: 7.43, 7.44, 7.46
HW: 7.47, 7.4952, 7.54
HW: 7.5558
Class: FRQ, 2005B no. 2
HW: Worksheet, 57
HW: 7.61, 7.62, 7.64, 7.65 (include illustrations)
HW: 7.6670
HW: 7.7175
HW: Worksheet, problems 89
HW: 7.94 (use normal approximation), 7.115-19; worksheet, problem 10
Class: FRQ, 2006B no. 3
HW: 7.98100, 7.102, 7.104, 7.114
Class: FRQ, 2004 no. 4
HW: 8.14, 8.8
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Section and Title
85 Test: chapter 8
86 Review for final
87 FINAL EXAM
Activities/Assignments
HW: FRQs, 1998 nos. 4, 6; 2002B nos. 3, 5; 2006 no. 3
SEMESTER 2
88
89
90
91
92
Estimation Using a
Single Sample (9.1)
Large-Sample
Confidence Interval for
a Population Proportion
(9.2)
9.2 continued
Interpreting the
Confidence Level (9.2)
94
95
Review: chapter 9
96
97
Test: chapter 9
Hypothesis Testing
(10.1)
Errors in Hypothesis
Testing (10.2)
Hypothesis Tests for a
Population Proportion
(10.3)
10.3 continued
93
98
99
100
101
102
103
10.3 continued
10.4 Hypothesis Tests
for a Population Mean
10.4 continued
104
105
Power (10.5)
Review / JMP activity
191
Chapter 3
1
Day
Section and Title
106 Review / JMP activity
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
192
Test: chapter 10
Inferences Concerning
the Difference Between
Two Population or
Treatment Means Using
Independent Samples
(11.1)
11.1 continued
11.1 continued
Activities/Assignments
Class: FRQ, 2005B no. 6
HW: JMP activity
Class: Fish oil activity (see the Student Activities section)
HW: Read pp. 535-47
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Day
Section and Title
125 More HOP Tests (12.2)
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
138
Modeling Nonlinear
Data (5.5)
More Nonlinear Data
(5.5)
More Nonlinear Data
(5.5)
Conclusion (5.5)
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
136
137
Activities/Assignments
Class: FRQ, 2003B no. 5
HW: 12.23, 12.30; article: The Role of Suggestion in the Perception of
Satanic Messages in Rock-and-Roll Recordings, Journal of Psychology
116 (1984): 245-48.
HW: 12.16, 12.21, 12.24, 12.27
HW: 12.32, 12.33; article: Sex and Time of Day as Determinants of
Whether People Enter the Cafeteria Together or Alone, Psychological
Reports 51 (1982): 837-38.
Class: FRQ, 1999 no. 2
HW: 13.1, 13.3, 13.6, 13.8
HW: 13.21, 13.25
HW: 13.19, 13.22, 13.26
HW: JMP Student Edition worksheet (13.24) (See Teacher Resources
section)
Class: FRQ, 2005B no. 5
HW: FRQs, 2001 no. 6; 2006 no. 2
HW: Worksheet, problems 12
HW: Worksheet, problems 34
HW: Worksheet, problems 57
Class: FRQ, 2004B no. 1
HW: FRQ, 1997 no. 6
Use remaining FRQs (from AP Central and the Released Exams)
Evening: complete practice AP Exam (2002)
Use remaining FRQs
Use remaining FRQs
193
Chapter 3
1
Day
Section and Title
149 Assign second-semester
project
150 Multiple Regression
(14.1)
151 Fitting a Model and
Assessing Its Utility
(14.2)
152 Inferences Based on an
Estimated Model (14.3)
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
194
Activities/Assignments
HW: 14.47
HW: 14.16, 14.25
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Teaching Strategies
On a normal day, class starts with a review of the homework from the previous evening. This is usually
followed by a presentation of new material. To help students assimilate the large amounts of information
imparted, I provide them with partially complete notes (see the example below). Students download these
from my school Web site for each chapter, print them out, and bring them to class daily. Depending on the
topic, the notes may include exposition with key words left out, examples, and/or problems for practice.
The practice problems are to be done in class so I can check for understanding. This routine has freed up
an average of 15 minutes in every class period. I use the additional time in a variety of ways: to read articles
from newspapers and magazines (see the Course Planner above), to have extended discussions about the
lesson, and to work on practice AP Exam free-response questions.
Experimental Design
Suppose we wanted to design an experiment to see if caffeine affects pulse rate.
What is the explanatory variable?
Caffeine
Pulse rate
If there is a change in pulse rates, we do not know if caffeine was the cause. For example, suppose I
told a joke while we were waiting, and everyone laughed so hard that his or her pulse rate went up. Or,
suppose we took notes and everybodys pulse rate slowed down to sleeplike levels. Finally, there are any
number of other things that could occur that we may not be aware of.
195
Chapter 3
1
Some problems can be easily solved by including a control group, which does not receive caffeine. In our
experiment, we can accomplish this by using two levels of caffeine: no caffeine and some caffeine. For
example, we could assign each class member to one of two treatments: regular cola or caffeine-free cola.
Caffeine-free cola is considered a placebo, which is a treatment that is lacking the explanatory variable but
is similar to the other treatments in every other way.
Why do we not give cola to one group and nothing to the other group?
Oftentimes applying any treatment can create a change in the response variable. For example, when
children get hurt, they feel better if their wound is kissed or covered with a bandage, even though
neither of those treatments actually eliminate any pain.
In our study, if only one group got a treatment, the fact that its members were chosen to receive free soda
might make their pulses increase before the caffeine even hits their bloodstream! Having every subject
receive a treatment ensures that both groups think they are being treated the same. Then, any difference
between their pulse rates can be attributed to the explanatory variable and not the excitement of getting
free soda.
Of course, it is essential that the subjects do not know which treatment they are receiving. If a person does
not know who is receiving which treatment, that person is blind.
There are two classes of individuals who can influence the results of an experiment:
Those who could influence the results directly (subjects, treatment administrators, and the like)
Those who evaluate the results
When every individual in one of these classes is blinded, the experiment is called single blind. If every
individual in both classes is blinded, then the experiment is double blind.
Can our experiment be run in a double blind manner?
Yes, if the subjects, the people handing out the treatments, and the people measuring the pulse rates all
do not know which treatment is which.
But doesnt someone need to know which is which? Yes, but that person should not have any
interaction with the subjects at any point of the experiment.
196
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Principle 1: Direct control means holding extraneous variables constant for all treatment groups so that
their effects are not confounded with the explanatory variable.
Temperature of drink
Size of drink
Drinking rate
Amount of sugar (no diet soda)
Waiting time between treatment and pulse reading
Pulse rate before experiment (need to be resting)
Room temperature
Amount of carbonation
How we measure pulse
If we do not control these extraneous variables by making them the same for all treatment groups, they
could have differential effects on the response variable and thus confound the effects of the caffeine on
pulse rates. For example, we may not be able to tell if it was the caffeine or the temperature that causes the
higher pulse rate.
Principle 2: Blocking occurs when subjects are divided into blocks (groups) of similar units based on some
extraneous variable and then separated into different treatment groups.
What if men react to caffeine differently than women?
This additional variability may make it more difficult to see the difference between the treatments.
We could run the study with only one gender to exert direct control, but then we could only draw
conclusions about one gender.
But, to reduce this variability we could make sure there is a representative number of men and women
in each treatment. For example, if there are 20 women and 30 men in the experiment, then the
experimental group should have 10 women and 15 men, and the control group should have the same.
In this example, we have formed two blocks: men and women. Then we assigned both treatments to
the subjects within each block.
What are some other extraneous factors that we can block for?
197
Chapter 3
1
You should try to make the blocks as small as possible. Ideally, the size of the block should be the same as
the number of treatments. For example, if there are three treatments, then there should be three subjects in
each block. If each block has only two subjects, then the subjects are called a matched pair.
Principle 3: Randomization is the random assignment of subjects to treatments to ensure that the
experiment does not systematically favor one treatment over the other.
What about all of the other extraneous variables we do not think of? What about the variables we cannot
directly control or block for?
If we randomly assign subjects to treatments, this should, on average, even out (but not necessarily
eliminate) the differential effects of these variables, because their effects should be spread equally between
the treatment groups.
Note: We must always randomize, as there will always be extraneous variables we do not consider.
How do we randomize?
Draw names from a hat. The first half chosen are in one group, the remaining names in the other.
Number the class members from 1 to 36. Then, generate random numbers without replacement until
half are chosen for one group. The remaining subjects go in the other group.
For matched pairs, flip a coin to determine which subjects go into which group. If the coin comes up
heads, the first person in the pair goes to group A and the other person to group B; if it comes up tails,
the first person goes to group B and the other person to group A.
Principle 4: Replication means ensuring that there are an adequate number of observations in each
treatment group. If each treatment group only had one experimental subject, then we would not be able
to conclude that any changes in the response are the result of the treatments. It is possible that some
characteristic of the individual was the cause of the change.
Increasing the sample size makes randomization more effective. The more subjects we have, the more
balanced our treatment groups will be. For example, if we have only 10 subjects and 2 of them have a
certain unknown characteristic, it is quite likely that both of those subjects could end up in the same
treatment group, simply by chance. However, if we have 100 subjects and 20 have the characteristic, it is
very unlikely for all 20 to end up in the same group. There is a much better chance that the groups will
be close to balanced (10/10, 9/11, 11/9, etc.) when the sample size is larger. (If you were flipping a coin and
wanted to get as close as possible to 50 percent, you would flip the coin more than a few times!)
Note: Replication can also refer to repeating the experiment with different subjects. This can help us feel
more confident about applying the results of our experiment to a wider population.
Summary: With control, blocking, randomization, and replication, each treatment group should be nearly
identical, and the effects of extraneous variables should be the same in each group. Now, if changes in
the explanatory variable are associated with changes in the response variable, we can conclude that it is a
cause-and-effect relationship.
198
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
After completing this lesson, we conduct the experiment in class. I bring in cola with caffeine and without
caffeine (whatever brand is on sale) in the same cooler so the temperatures will be the same. Volunteers
from the class help me pour equal amounts of soda into identical cups. There are usually a few students
who do not drink soda, so make sure to let everyone know that participation is voluntary. The rest of the
students measure their initial pulse rates and form two lines: males (ordered by pulse rates) and females
(ordered by pulse rates). The first two males are paired, the next two males are paired, and so on. I flip a
coin to assign each pair to treatments. If the coin comes up heads, the first person goes to the left side of
the room and the other person goes to the right; if it is tails, vice-versa. The same is done for the female line.
Then each group is given a different treatment. The students slowly drink the soda while we go over
a homework assignment. After about 15 minutes, each student measures his or her final pulse rate. We
compare the change in pulse rates for each pair, but because this is only the first semester, we do not do
any formal inference procedures. One additional twist (that I discovered by accident one year) is to leave
the door to the classroom open so that the two groups will be in slightly different environments. This is
a perfect example of a confounding variable: if there is a difference in pulse rates, we will not know if it is
due to the difference in caffeine content or the difference in environment.
One final note: in 11 years of doing this experiment, the results have never appeared significant. This is
probably because the amount of caffeine in a cup of soda is too small to make a measurable difference.
I give a cumulative midterm and final each semester, with the second-semester final usually given a
week before the AP Exam.
Students come in during the evening or on Saturday approximately two weeks before the final exam
to take the entire 2002 AP Exam. We score the exam together immediately afterward.
During the year, students work in groups of four to complete previous AP Exam free-response
questions, usually on a topic we are currently studying. Each member of the group is responsible for
discussing the answers to the question and making sure the other group members understand. They
are allowed to use their notes and textbook. Each student writes up his or her answer, and the group
turns in all four papers together. I randomly select one paper to grade and give the entire group
the same score, based on the scoring guidelines found on AP Central. These questions are worth
5 percent of a students semester grade, and I usually value them at 3 points instead of 4, as AP
questions can be quite challenging.
Some students choose to purchase an AP Statistics review book (see the Teacher Resources section
below), but this is not required, and we do not use them in class.
Use of Technology
All students have a TI-83/TI-83 Plus/TI-84 graphing calculator for use in class, at home, and on the
AP Exam. They use it extensively throughout the course.
All students have a copy of JMP Student Edition statistical software for use at home and for
demonstrations in class. I give them occasional assignments that must be completed using this
program. After the AP Exam, they use this software daily when we learn multiple regression and
ANOVA. Other statistical software such as Fathom and Minitab is used for demonstration purposes.
Although JMP is packaged with some textbooks, our school obtained it independently.
In class, I make use of a variety of applets available on the Internet (see my Teacher Resources
section).
199
Chapter 3
1
Student Evaluation
Each student receives two semester grades, not one overall grade. Progress reports are sent out at 6 and 12
weeks, but each semesters grades accumulate and are not an average of each 6-week period. The semester
grades are determined as follows:
Tests: 65 percent
Each semester there are approximately eight tests, one for each chapter, as well as cumulative midterms and
finals. A significant portion of each test assesses communication skills and connections between topics.
Homework: 15 percent
Students are assigned daily homework from the primary textbook.
Projects: 10 percent
Each semester students complete a major project (see my Student Activities section).
Participation: 5 percent
Participation in class discussions and activities is required.
Class work: 5 percent
This consists of AP Exam free-response questions done in groups and other in-class activities.
The midterm is weighted the same as the other tests. The final is longer (two hours versus one hour),
so it is worth more points but proportionally so. In other words, a multiple-choice question is still worth
the same on the final; however, there are more of them. The format of all the tests is similarroughly onethird to one-half multiple-choice questions and the rest free-response questions. I try to make them similar
in format to the AP Exam.
The grading scale at Wilson High is as follows: A = 90100, B = 8089, C = 7079, D = 6069.
Teacher Resources
Basic Textbook
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. Pacific Grove, Calif.:
Brooks/Cole, 2001.
200
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Sternstein, Martin. Barrons AP Statistics: How to Prepare for the Advanced Placement Exam. 3rd ed.
Hauppauge, N.Y.: Barrons Educational Series, 2004.
Periodicals
Chance. Magazine published quarterly by the American Statistical Association and Springer. Subscription
information at www.amstat.org.
STATS: The Magazine for Students of Statistics. Published three times a year by the American Statistical
Association and Springer. Subscription information at www.amstat.org.
Neither magazine is written specifically for the AP Statistics teacher, but they are both very interesting.
Subscription prices are discounted for ASA members.
201
Chapter 3
1
Software
ActivStats. CD-ROM ed. 2005-06 release by Paul Velleman. N.p.: Addison-Wesley, 2006.
www.datadesk.com/products/mediadx/activstats.
Data Desk analysis software is built into this product.
Fathom Dynamic Data Software. Version 2. Emeryville, Calif.: Key Curriculum Press.
www.keypress.com.
JMP 6. Student Edition.
www.JMP.com/se.
Minitab.
www.minitab.com.
StatCrunch: Data Analysis on the Web.
www.statcrunch.com.
Web-based statistical software.
WinStat.
http://math.exeter.edu/rparris.
Free download.
Videos
Against All Odds: Inside Statistics. Lexington, Mass.: Consortium for Mathematics and Its Applications
(COMAP), 1989. This video series of 26 half-hour segments was written by David Moore. It can be
viewed online for streaming media for free at www.learner.org. Downloading is prohibited.
Statistics: Decisions Through Data. By David S. Moore. Five videocassettes with users guide. Lexington,
Mass.: Consortium for Mathematics and Its Applications (COMAP), 1992. This series of five one-hour
videos (total of 21 video segments) teaches various topics in 1015 minute segments, using some of the
footage from Against All Odds. The videos are useful for introducing or reviewing a topic, or for a day
when a substitute covers your class. They come with worksheets and other materials.
Web Resources
AP Statistics Course Home Page.
apcentral.collegeboard.com/stats.
This is a wonderful resource that includes the Course Description, previous AP Exam free-response
questions, sample syllabi, tips for the AP Exam, important announcements, reviews of textbooks and
other resources, and many excellent articles about the teaching of statistics.
AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group (EDG). The College Boards electronic discussion group for this
subject, commonly referred to as the listserv, is an open forum for discussing anything related to AP
Statistics, including questions on textbook problems, how to prepare for the AP Exam, issues of pacing
for different textbooks, technology questions, and questions that go beyond what we would teach our
students. Register through the course home page at AP Central.
AP Statistics FAQ.
www.mrderksen.com/faq.htm.
Includes resources for new teachers and sections about the AP Exam and course content.
202
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Geometers Sketchpad Resource Center. Least Squares.
www.dynamicgeometry.com/javasketchpad/gallery/pages/least_squares.php.
Linear Regression.
http://statweb.calpoly.edu/bchance/applets/LRApplet.html.
Math Forum@Drexel.
http://mathforum.org/kb/forum.jspa?forumID=67.
This is a read-only searchable archive of all AP Statistics EDG messages over the past several years.
NCSSM (North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics). An Exercise in Sampling: Rolling Down the
River.
http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Stat_inst01/PDFS/river.pdf.
NCSSM. The Midge Problem: A Mathematical Modeling Example.
www.dlt.ncssm.edu/afm/lessons/midge_problem.doc.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics. Sampling Distribution.
http://onlinestatbook.com/stat_sim/sampling_dist/index.html.
Rossmanchance.com. Sampling Words.
www.rossmanchance.com/jsm03/activities/SamplingWords.doc.
Student Activities
How Many Textbooks?
(Adapted from the How Many Taxis? problem from the North Carolina School of Science and
Mathematics [http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Talks/PDFS/Taxis%20for%20MAA.pdf] and from the How
Many Tanks? activity in Activity-Based Statistics [see citation in the Teacher Resources section above].
Sample Syllabus 3 in this publication describes how the German tank activity is used in Michael Allwoods
classroom.)
During World War II, Allied forces noticed that all German tanks were labeled with a serial number.
After observing numerous tanks, it became obvious that the tanks were numbered systematically. Thus,
the Allies were able to predict the total number of German tanks and their locations using the observed
serial numbers. This became known as the German Tank Problem (for more information, see
www.guardian.co.uk/g2/story/0%2C%2C182425%2C00.html).
Fortunately for our troops in the Middle East, enemy forces do not have any tanks to speak of.
However, the methods used to solve the German Tank Problem can be applied to many other situations. In
this assignment, your job is to develop a method to estimate the total number of AP Statistics books (or any
other textbook) at our school, based on a random sample of books and the assumption that the books are
numbered sequentially starting from 1.
For example, suppose a random sample of n = 7 books contains the following numbers: 10, 38, 59,
61, 74, 90, 94. How can you use this information to estimate the total number of books (N)? One possible
method would be to take the median value (61) and double it. In this example, 61 2 = 122. Thus, our
estimate for the total number of books is N = 122.
203
Chapter 3
1
For this activity you will create three other statistics to estimate the total number of books. Remember,
a statistic is any quantity computed from the values in a sample. You may use any combination of the
summary statistics we already know (mean, median, min, max, quartiles, IQR, standard deviation) or
invent your own. The goal is to find a relatively simple statistic that reliably predicts the total number of
books.
To determine which of your three statistics gives the best prediction, you will perform a simulation to
generate sampling distributions for each of your three statistics. For the purposes of the simulation, assume
that there are 100 books total (N = 100) and that you will be taking samples of size 7 (n = 7). For each run
(do 25 runs), generate seven random numbers from 1 to 100, and compute the values of each of your three
statistics.
NOTE: On
we will have a competition in class to see which group has the best
statistic. The nominating order will be randomly selected, and no statistic will be allowed more than once.
During each round of the competition, I will secretly choose N and then give you a sample of n numbers
from 1-N. Each group will compute the value of its statistic based on the sample of n numbers. The closest
estimate will be awarded 3 points, the second closest will receive 2 points, and the third closest will get
1 point. After several rounds, the team with the most points will get 2 extra-credit points per member.
8
-6
12
0
10
1
14
2
2
-3
0
-4
0
2
x f = 6.57
xr = -1.14
At first glance, it appears that the average reduction when using fish oil is higher than the average
reduction when using regular oil ( P f Pr ! 0 ), because x f xr 7.71 ! 0 . However, it is possible that
the oils have the same effect and that the observed difference is the result of randomization variability.
204
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
To decide, we start by assuming that the null hypothesis is true H 0 : PF PR . That is, there is no
difference between regular oil and fish oil. So, the first person in the list would have had a reduction of 8
no matter which treatment he was taking. He just happened to be assigned to the fish oil group by chance.
To see how likely it is to get a difference of 7.71 because of randomization variability, we can perform
a simulation. Write each reduction on a piece of paper, and re-randomize the subjects into two groups.
This simulates assigning the subjects to groups when the null hypothesis is true. Once you make two new
groups, find the mean of each group and then their difference x F x R . Finally, collect differences from
the class to form a sampling distribution of x F x R , and estimate the probability of getting a difference as
high as 7.71 by random chance.
Teachers note:
Once each student has a difference of means, plot all the results on a dotplot. It is very unlikely that any of
the differences will be more than 7.71. A typical conclusion to this activity might be worded in this way:
Thus, assuming that there is no difference in the two oils, it is very unlikely to get a difference of sample
means as high as 7.71 by random chance (p 0). Therefore, we reject the null hypothesis and conclude that
fish oil helps reduce diastolic blood pressure.
Proposal (5 points)
The proposal is due Monday, October 30. Late work will be penalized 20 percent per day, even if you
are absent.
Describe your topic and state which type of bias you are investigating.
Describe how you will obtain your subjects (minimum sample size is 50). This must be practical!!
Your population does not need to be from this school, nor should you interrupt any classes.
Describe what your questions will be and how they will be asked, including how you will
incorporate the principles of a good experiment and avoid confounding variables. Convince me that
you have a good design!
205
Chapter 3
1
Poster (17 points)
The poster is due Monday, November 27. Late work will be penalized 20 percent per day, even if you
are absent.
The key to a good statistical poster is communication and organization. Make sure all components
of the poster are focused on answering the question of interest.
The poster should be standard size (about 23 by 28 inches) and not on foam board. Make sure it is
light enough to be hung on the wall.
Data collection: In this section, describe how you obtained your data. Be specific.
Graphs and summary statistics: Make sure the graphs are completely labeled, easy to compare, and
help to answer the question of interest.
Discussion and conclusions: In this section, state your conclusions. You should also discuss any
errors you made, what you could do to improve the study next time, and so forth.
Presentation (3 points)
Each pair is required to give a five-minute oral presentation to the class. Both members must participate
equally and should be prepared to answer questions.
Second-Semester Project
Purpose: The purpose of this project is for you to actually do statistics. You are to: (1) form a hypothesis;
(2) design a study; (3) conduct the study; (4) collect the data; (5) describe the data; and (6) make conclusions
using the data.
Topics: You may do your study on any topic, but you must be able to perform all six steps listed above.
Make it interesting, and note that degree of difficulty is part of the grade. For example, experiments are
preferred over observational studies or surveys. Projects about response bias are not allowed. There will be
a limited amount of class time for performing experiments.
Group size: You may work alone or with a partner.
Proposal (5 points)
You must have an approved project by Wednesday, May 10. To get approval, you should be able to
demonstrate how your study will meet the requirements of the project. In other words, you need to clearly
and completely describe your hypotheses, what test/interval you will use to analyze the results, how you
will collect the data so the conditions will be satisfied, and so forth. You must also make sure that your
study will be safe and ethical, if you are using human subjects. The proposal should be typed. If it is not
approved, you will have to resubmit it for partial credit until it is approved.
206
Course
About Organization
AP Statistics
Poster (17 points)
The poster is due Wednesday, May 31. Late work will be penalized 20 percent per day, even if you
are absent.
The key to a good statistical poster is communication and organization. Make sure all components
of the poster are focused on answering the question of interest.
The poster should be standard size (about 23 by 28 inches) and not on foam board. Make sure it is
light enough to be hung on the wall.
Data collection: In this section, describe how you obtained your data. Be specific.
Graphs and summary statistics: Make sure the graphs are well labeled, easy to compare, and help
answer the question of interest.
Discussion and conclusions: In this section, state your conclusion (with test statistic and P-value),
and discuss why your inference procedure is valid (that is, discuss the conditions and so forth). You
should also discuss any errors you made and what you could do to improve the study next time.
Presentation (3 points)
Each individual or pair is required to give a five-minute oral presentation to the class.
Examples of successful projects:
207
Chapter 4
The AP Exam in Statistics
Like all AP courses, AP Statistics prepares students for a worldwide examination administered each year
in early May. Students can earn college credit and/or placement into an advanced class at many colleges
and universities by achieving a sufficiently high score on this exam. This assessment is not some formulaic
vehicle that requires you to teach to the test. Because the AP course and the AP Exam are designed by the
same peoplethe AP Statistics Development Committeethe exam is a natural outgrowth of the course.
The course goals emphasize the ability to creatively apply and implement statistical principles rather than
rote memorization. Students will not be faced with trick questions; instead the AP Statistics Exam gives
them the opportunity to showcase the college-level skills that they have learned throughout the year.
209
Chapter 4
1
responses along a particular scoring scale? To ensure alignment between the free-response questions and
how those questions will be scored, draft scoring guidelines are developed by the Chief Reader, a college
professor who oversees the scoring of the questions, with input from the Development Committee.
The AP Reading
The multiple-choice section of the AP Exam is scanned and scored by computer. The free-response
questions are evaluated at the AP Reading in June.
The people who score the free-response questions on the exam are known as Readers. These are
experienced statistics instructors who teach the AP course in a high school or the equivalent course at
a college or university. To ensure a broad and balanced group of Readers, factors such as school locale
and setting (urban, rural, etc.), gender, ethnicity, and years of teaching experience are considered. Reader
applications can be completed online at apcentral.collegeboard.com/readers. It is generally expected that
applicants will have at least three years of experience teaching AP Statistics.
Some of the more experienced Readers are invited to serve as Exam Leaders (for some subjects that have
two exams), Question Leaders (who supervise the scoring of a specific free-response question), and Table
Leaders. The remaining Readers are divided into groups of six or eight, with each group supervised by
one Table Leader. Under the guidance of the Chief Reader, the Exam Leaders, Question Leaders, and Table
Leaders assist in establishing scoring standards, selecting sample student responses that exemplify those
standards, and preparing for the training of the Readers.
The primary goal of the scoring process is to have each Reader score the student responses consistently,
fairly, and to the same standard as the other Readers. In other words, a student response should receive the
same score without regard to which Reader scored the response or the day on which it was scored. This
goal is achieved through the creation of detailed scoring guidelines, thorough training of all Readers, and
the various checks and balances that are applied throughout the Reading. For example, many but not
necessarily all student responses will be back-read a second time by a Table Leader to ensure that the
guidelines are being applied consistently. In addition, no Reader will score more than one question from a
particular students exam.
210
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
You are encouraged to read chapter 1, The AP Process, in any of the Released Exam publications for
additional detailed information about the development and scoring of the exams, the creation of the scoring
guidelines, and the training of Readers.
Holistic Scoring
The six free-response questions on the AP Statistics Exam are scored holistically; that is, each response
is evaluated as a complete package. With holistic scoring, a judgment is made about the overall quality of
the students response, as opposed to analytic scoring, wherein the necessary components of a students
response are specified in advance, and each component is given a value counting toward the overall score.
For example, suppose a student is to solve a quadratic equation, x2 2x = 7. An analytic scoring rubric
might allocate a total of 4 points in the following manner:
Analytic scoring is appropriate for evaluating responses to focused questions that have few response
alternatives.9 Holistic scoring, in contrast, is well suited for questions where the student is required
to synthesize information and respond at least partly in written paragraphs. For example, an openended question may present a real-life experiment with resulting data and ask the student not only to
analyze the data but also to comment on how the experimental protocol might be enhanced. Opinions
on improvement might focus on refining the sampling method, controlling confounding variables, or
seeking more power through increasing the sample size. Indeed, the students justification of his or her
experimental improvement could even depend on relevant contextual knowledge brought to the exam from
the real world! In this context, holistic scoring represents a recognition not only of multiple reasonable
approaches to a statistical analysis but an insistence about statistical synergya quality student response is
more than just the sum of its parts.
One method of implementing holistic scoring is to decide in advance the number of categories into
which student answers will be sorted. These may be labeled A, B, C, D, and F; distinguished, proficient,
and novice; or simple numbers, 5, 4, 3, 2, and 1. The AP Statistics Scoring Guidelines for each free-response
question on the exam have five categories, numerically defined on a 0 to 4 scale. Each category represents
a level of quality in the student response. These levels of quality are defined in two dimensions: statistical
knowledge and communication. The specific standards for each question are tied to a general template,
which represents the descriptions of the quality levels as envisioned by the Development Committee. This
general template is reproduced in the following table. Note that communication and statistical knowledge
are given equal value.
9. Anthony J. Nitko, Educational Assessment of Students, 3rd ed. (Upper Saddle River, N.J.: Merrill, 2001), 194-95.
211
Chapter 4
1
A Guide to Scoring Free-Response Statistics Questions:
The Category Descriptors
Score
Descriptors
4
Complete
3
Substantial
2
Developing
1
Minimal
212
Statistical Knowledge
(Identification of the important
components of the problem and
demonstration of the statistical concepts
and techniques that result in a correct
solution of the problem)
Shows complete understanding of the
problems statistical components
Synthesizes a correct relationship
among these components, perhaps with
novelty and creativity
Uses appropriate and correctly executed
statistical techniques
May have minor arithmetic errors, but
answers are still reasonable
Shows substantial understanding of the
problems statistical components
Synthesizes a relationship among these
components, perhaps with minor gaps
Uses appropriate statistical techniques
May have arithmetic errors, but answers
are still reasonable
Communication
(Explanation of what was done and why,
along with a statement of conclusions drawn
in context)
Uses
diagrams in an incomplete or
Uses some appropriate statistical
ineffective way, or diagrams may be
techniques but misses or misuses others
missing
May have arithmetic errors that result
States a conclusion that is incomplete
in unreasonable answers
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
AP Grades
The Chief Reader sets the four cut points that divide the composite scores into groups corresponding to the
final AP grades of 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5. A variety of information is available to help the Chief Reader determine
the score ranges into which exam grades should fall:
Distributions of scores on each portion of the multiple-choice and free-response sections of the exam
are provided, along with the totals for each section and the composite score total.
With these tables and special statistical tables presenting grade distributions from previous years, the
Chief Reader can compare the exam at hand to longitudinal results from other years.
For each composite score, a table summarizes student performance on all sections of the exam.
A subset of the multiple-choice questions is used for equating purposes. That is, a certain number of
questions from an earlier exam are included in the current one, thereby allowing comparisons to be
made between the scores of the earlier group of students and those of the current group.
This information, along with other data, is used by the Chief Reader to establish AP grades that
reflect the level of competence demanded by the AP Program and legitimately compare this years
AP grades with earlier years.
Finally, on the basis of professional judgment regarding the quality of the performance represented
by the achieved scores, the Chief Reader determines the students final AP grades.
213
Chapter 4
1
Many colleges consult their incoming students AP grade reports when making placement and
credit decisions. In general, an AP grade of 3 or higher indicates sufficient mastery of course content to
allow placement in the succeeding college course and/or credit for and exemption from a college course
comparable to the AP course.
Each college develops its own criteria for making AP credit decisions. Because the grade necessary for
credit and the exams that will be accepted can vary from college to college and even from department to
department within a particular institution, it is important for a student to clearly understand the policies
for that educational institution. Sometimes the decision is based on whether the students grade is 3, 4, or
5. Some colleges do not give AP credit at all, or only for selected courses. It is incumbent on students to ask
questions about a universitys AP policy when they apply to a school or visit a particular institution. One
helpful source is on collegeboard.com. Students can click on AP Credit Policy Info on the AP student page,
which will take them to a search tool where they can type in the name of an institution and be linked to
information on its AP credit policy.
214
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
AP Central contains scoring guidelines and commentaries on sample student responses for freeresponse questions from past AP Statistics Exams. This is an excellent place to become more familiar with
the actual implementations of the guidelines for individual questions. However, there is a danger that the
specificity of the guidelines for past questions can be misinterpreted. For example, one might be tempted
to create overly narrow rules for students statistical writing. Many of the free-response questions can be
integrative in nature, as illustrated by the one featured in chapter 1 that includes data analysis as well as
sampling elements. A particular hypothesis-testing question might ask students to comment on how the
data were collected, and this would of course be reflected in the scoring guidelines. A cursory reading of
one of the question-specific rubrics could lead one to conclude that for all hypothesis-testing questions a
discussion of the sampling is required. This temptation must be resisted! Each rubric is written to reflect
a particular question. For example, a specific element in the response to an inference question could be
crucial, less than crucial, or even irrelevant in a different question.
Although it is not possible to completely codify guidelines or rules of thumb for approaching the freeresponse questions, it is possible to offer some general observations about common limitations and errors
of omission and commission in student responses on past exams. Some benefits of experience from past AP
Readings are provided below.
215
Chapter 4
1
that writing down a confidence interval or stating the null hypothesis is rejected is sufficient and that the
Reader will know what was meant. Irrespective of what the student meant to write, the response will be
evaluated on what was written. It is expected that beyond the mechanics, conclusions should be given in
terms of the context of the question, whether it is an interpretation of the resulting confidence interval or
an appropriate conclusion about the null hypothesis and how that conclusion was reached. If a question is
presented in a context, the student must explicitly interpret the statistical results in that context.
Exploring Data
The graphical presentation of data is, of course, an excellent method of communicating about distributions
of data and relations between variables. However, the effectiveness of graphs is compromised if the axes are
not correctly labeled and scaled. In comparative displays, students frequently fail to label which group is
associated with which display. Another common error is the use of different scales in a comparative setting.
For example, the graphical clarity of comparative boxplots of the heights of males and females is destroyed
if each boxplot has its own scale. Descriptions of distributions should as a matter of course address (in
context) the center, spread, and shape, as well as unusual features such as outliers, gaps, and clusters. When
comparing distributions, characteristics of each distribution should be mentioned explicitly. To say that
distribution A is skewed to the right, for example, does not carry any implicit information that distribution
B is not so skewed or that it may even be symmetric. In addition, comparative language must be used;
for example, the median male adult height is greater than the median female adult height. This is quite
different from simply listing the attributes of each distribution.
Planning Studies
Writing responses to questions about planning studies has historically been difficult for students. This is
not surprising, as these questions tend to elicit the least formulaic responses and require a more exact use
of statistical vocabulary. A student who, for example, struggles with hypothesis testing can demonstrate
some knowledge by adhering to the stylistic form of the hypothesis-testing procedure. The writing style
for discussion of methods of data collection and experimental design is almost blank verse by comparison.
Some students are ambushed by this opportunity, writing long responses that may entirely fill the allotted
space but that are, in effect, noncreditable answers. Possibly the best advice for responding to these
questions is to know the vocabulary of sampling and experimental design and to write with precision using
that vocabulary. In particular, when students are answering questions about experimental design, it is not
uncommon for them to respond to questions that were not asked, leaving less time and space to respond
effectively to the question that was asked. For example, if asked to identify a potential confounding variable
in a particular scenario, it is not required nor is it necessarily helpful for students to provide a general
definition of a confounding variable. If the intent of the question is to elicit such a definition, the wording
will direct students to do so (see, for example, free-response question 3 on the 1999 exam).
Some students adopt a shotgun strategy and attempt to regurgitate everything they remember
about confounding variables in hopes that they will stumble on something relevant to the question. With
holistic grading, it is more likely that the lack of focus in their answers will count against them. Students
are advised to be careful when using statistical terms such as blocking, blinding, confounding, and the like.
These words need to be used precisely and in context or a deduction is likely. The same caution applies to
students use of vocabulary in sampling design versus experimental design.
216
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
Random Thoughts
Students sometimes demonstrate confusion about the differing purposes of random selection versus random
assignment in statistical studies. Below is a summary that my students have found helpful in clarifying this
important distinction.
Random selection is a method of obtaining a sample from a population of interest. Choosing a sample at
random helps ensure that the individuals in the sample represent the population well. Random selection allows
researchers to generalize sample results to the population as a whole.
Random assignment of subjects to treatment groups in an experiment is the researchers best attempt to create
groups that are as similar as possible before the treatments are administered. If the groups show significantly
different responses, then researchers can attribute that difference to the treatments. In other words, random
assignment helps researchers draw cause-and-effect conclusions from an experiment. Because the subjects
in an experiment are usually not selected at random, this limits researchers ability to generalize findings to a
larger population of individuals. Both random selection and random assignment introduce chance variation into
a statistical study. Statisticians use sampling distributions to quantify this chance variation when they construct
confidence intervals or perform significance tests. The distinction becomes important in determining the scope
of conclusions one can draw from the study.
The chart below (adapted from The Statistical Sleuth by Ramsey and Schafer) summarizes the different
implications of random selection and random assignment in statistical studies.
Were
subjects
randomly
assigned?
NO
YES
The researcher:
may infer cause and effect; and
may generalize findings to the
population.
The researcher:
may infer cause and effect; but
may not generalize findings to the
population.
NO
The researcher:
may not infer cause and effect; but
may generalize findings to the
population.
The researcher:
may not infer cause and effect; and
may not generalize findings to the
population.
Daren Starnes, The Lawrenceville School,
Lawrenceville, New Jersey
Probability
Probability questions are the most mathlike questions on the AP Statistics Exam, and students who know
how to solve these problems should be relatively comfortable doing so. The difficulties that they may have
in this area tend to be more organizational than conceptual. Here are some simple strategies students can
use to improve their chances of doing well on probability questions.
Students should state what formula they are using in their calculations and substitute values from
the problem appropriatelyat that point, not before, they should pick up their calculator. If students
are using a particular probability distribution, they should identify the distribution with appropriate
parameters. For example: This is a binomial distribution with n = 24 and p = 0.35.
a question has multiple dependent parts and a student makes an error on one of the early ones, the
evaluation of successive parts will be based on whether the work presented is consistent with the
work done earlier. That is, an error in part (a) will not automatically invalidate answers in parts (b),
(c), and so on. Giving credit in the face of earlier errors depends on being able to trace the thread of
reasoning through the problem.
217
Chapter 4
1
Take advantage of graphic representations of the problem and response. Displays of Venn diagrams
and tree diagrams and shading of normal curves can effectively convey students understanding of
probability problems, as well as reduce ambiguity in the algebraic presentation of responses.
Because probability questions are mathlike, it may be easy for students to forget that the question is
presented in a context. They should not stop at just getting a numerical answer; the answer should
also be embedded in the context of the problem as a complete sentence: for example, the probability
of a randomly selected fish weighing between 2.3 and 4.1 pounds is 0.2157, or as a probability
statement such as P(2.3 < X < 4.1) = 0.2157.
Continue to caution against using calculator-speak. Writing something like binomcdf (12,0.4,7)
= 0.9427 does not indicate to the Reader whether the student understands what the parameters for
the distribution really are, nor does this count as showing your work. A more appropriate response
would be: in a binomial distribution with n = 12 and p = 0.4, P(x < 8) = 0.9427. For examples
on scoring such responses, see the scoring guidelines for question 3(b) on the 2007 AP Exam and
question 3 on the 2006 exam. Emphasize the importance of effective communication.
Credit is never given for just an answer. Some supporting work must be shown.
Students should step back and make sure their answers are reasonable: for example, no probabilities
greater than 1.
Inference
Answers to inference questions tend to be stylistic in nature, although presentations in textbooks are
slightly different. Complete responses to inference questions in which the student uses hypothesis testing
will generally require five components:
1. The correct statement of a set of hypotheses. Null and alternative hypotheses must be stated, correctly
defining any notation used. H0, , and , for example, are standard symbolic notations and need
not be defined. However, the use of the symbols should be specified: for example, Let A represent
the population mean height of corn under treatment A. The symbols as presented on the formula
sheet should be regarded as defined and meaningful; other notation should be defined before use.
A common error is to specify the symbols a and b but then fail to link them to the particular
populations under discussion.
2. Identification of an appropriate test procedure. The procedure and test statistic must be clearly
specified. This should be in the usual statistical notation, avoiding the calculator form or listing
the procedures for button pushing. The correct formula for the test statistic is usually the least
ambiguous identification of a procedure, although a statement such as two-sample t test for
independent means is also acceptable.
3. Identifying and checking the validity of appropriate assumptions. An important part of using
inferential procedures is recognizing that all statistical models depend on assumptions that
underlie and justify the procedures used in that model. If these assumptions are violated, then
the procedures may produce inappropriate conclusions. The problem is that these assumptions are
typically about populations and models and cannot be directly verified. Many times we know little
about the population, so it is not reasonable to check whether such assumptions are true or not.
Some assumptions, in fact, are unverifiable, and we just have to decide whether or not we believe
they are true. If we have data, we can often decide if an assumption about the population or model is
reasonable by checking a related condition based on the sample data to see if it is plausible to believe
that the assumption about the population is true. For example, one of the assumptions for inference
218
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
procedures about a single mean is that the data were drawn from a normal population. Since we
typically do not have access to the population data, we have no way to verify this assumption.
Instead, we look for signs that this assumption is not reasonable. So the condition we check is
whether there is evidence to convince us that it is unreasonable to believe the sample data came
from a normal population. With a small data set, we have to worry about outliers and skewness,
and we commonly check this condition using graphs: constructing a histogram, dotplot, or
probability plot of the data. If there are no outliers or other indications of skewness, then the
t-procedure can be justified. For complete communication, these graphs need to be included in the
student response. Simply stating that there are no outliers, without including graphical evidence,
is not sufficient.
With the t-procedures, even if we have reason to believe the population is not normal, the procedure
is still considered valid if the sample size is large, as then the sampling distribution of the sample
mean is approximately normal. Notice this large sample size in no way implies that the original
population was normal. How large the sample size needs to be varies by textbook (30 or 40 are
common cut-offs) and also by the level of skewness in the data. Students should also exercise care
when using is normal and is approximately normal. Rarely are we working with exactly normal
distributions, so the qualifier approximately is important.
Similarly with categorical data, different texts will counsel slightly different requirements, and no
specific requirement is enforced by the questions scoring guidelines, though a few are commonly
accepted in the statistical community. For example, requirements for using the large-sample z test
for a single population proportion are usually stated in the format, np k , n 1 p k , but the
actual value for k will differ depending on the text. What is important is that the student knows
there are assumptions that underpin inferential procedures and recognizes which are appropriate
conditions for the selected procedure and explicitly checks them, including appropriate justification.
A common omission is the actual checking of the condition by substituting values for n, p, k and
evaluating whether the conditions are metfor example, many students will write np ! 10 (or use
some other value for k) and then put a check mark next to it thinking that they have checked the
assumption or condition. In all cases, simply stating the conditions without checking them explicitly
is not sufficient for a complete response.
An excellent aid to understanding the difference between assumptions and conditions is Dave
Bocks article, Is That an Assumption or a Condition? It can be found on the AP Statistics Course
Home Page by scrolling down to Teaching Resource Materials and then to Statistical Inference. As
Dave suggests, start making this distinction early in the year.
4. The correct mechanics. This is usually a matter of showing intermediate steps in an organized
manner. The correct values of the test statistic, the level of significance, and the P-value,
appropriately identified in the body of the work, are essential.
5. Correct conclusions stated in the context of the problem. Test statistics must be used to arrive at the
correct conclusion, either via the P-value approach or a rejection region approach. Linkage between
the conclusion and test result should be stated clearly; for example: Because the P-value is less than
.05, the null hypothesis is rejected. Of critical importance is the conclusion stated in the context
of the problem, consistent with the defined hypotheses. That is, a rejection of a null hypothesis
should then be correctly interpreted as, say, providing evidence of a difference in the population
parameters.
219
Chapter 4
1
If confidence intervals are used for making inferences about population parameters, the
considerations above still apply. One particular omission that seems to occur when confidence
intervals are used is the check of conditions for the procedure. Both confidence intervals and
hypothesis testing are based on the sampling distribution, and both procedures require checks of the
conditions! If a confidence interval approach is used, a correct confidence interval statement is also
required. Students frequently err by making an incorrect probability statement, or indicate that they
have confidence that a sample value rather than a population value is in a certain interval.
Rounding Answers
Remind your students that it is best not to round numbers at intermediate steps in a calculation. Answers
should be rounded only at the end and then not too much. For example, a z-score should be rounded to two
decimal places in order to use the table, but each step in the calculation should not be rounded at all, or the
final z-score may be quite different from what it would have been otherwise.
A very general rule of thumb is that most answers can be rounded to two decimal places. Yet even
then, an exception is made for calculating probabilities, which should be kept to four decimal places, thus
matching the tables students will use during the exam.
Students may be asked to make a choice between two alternatives. Not only should they make a
decision and marshal their arguments for it; they must also explain why this choice is better by
pointing to the weaknesses of the alternative approach.
When asked to compare two distributions, students are not likely to receive credit if they just make
a list of the attributes. Comparative wordsgreater than, less than, about the sameneed to be used
when comparing center and spread; for example: There is less variability in the distribution of the
weights of female bears than in the distribution of the weights of male bears.
Directions to justify or explain the answer mean exactly that. These usually accompany questions
that require a choice between alternatives, as mentioned above, or the answer to a yes or
no question. Students are expected to explain why they chose that answer, using a statistical
justification. Justifying an answer can also mean showing enough work so that the Reader can
follow the logic. Answers without work will not receive credit, even if the question does not
explicitly ask students to justify or explain. Students are expected to read the instructions at the
beginning of the free-response questions; they will not be reminded along the way that they need to
show their work and justify their answers.
Using your answer in part (a) questions must have some reference to the work done in that
part. Students must cite evidence that includes the calculation from part (a). If there is an error in
the calculation of the first part, and the incorrect value (if it is plausible for the problem) is used
correctly in subsequent calculations, students will only lose credit for the first mistake.
If instructions in part (c) say using only your answers in parts (a) and (b), this usually means that
no further calculations are necessary to answer this part. Students should explicitly reference and
synthesize previous work in answering part (c). Those who go off in a new direction are wasting
precious time and might actually incur a deduction.
220
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
Instructions such as include appropriate statistical evidence may mean that students should
conduct some inference procedure or calculate a probability or some other statistical analysis as part
of the justification for their answer.
All work should be in the context of the problem. If students are asked to interpret a value,
relationship, or concept, such as slope, correlation, a scatterplot, or confounding, they should not use
generic terminology. For example: There is a strong negative linear relationship between the age of
a driver and the distance at which highway exit signs can be clearly read by the driver.
Prove Yourself
Justify your answer. These words commonly appear on AP Statistics Exam free-response questions,
but students are sometimes unsure about exactly what this phrase is asking them to do. For many of
these questions the actual answer is very short, sometimes consisting of a single sentence. But along
with a correct answer to the question, students must also convince the Exam Reader that they have
answered as they have for a sound, statistically correct reason. My advice to students is to always think
of their answer in three parts: first, make a clear statement of the answer. Next, state the statistical
concept that supports their answer. Then, finally, show how the stated concept supports the answer in
the context of this question. This final link demonstrates that the student can accurately and confidently
connect the details of a particular problem to his or her statistical knowledge.
Peter Flanagan-Hyde, Phoenix Country Day School,
Phoenix, Arizona
221
Chapter 4
1
How do you prepare students for the investigative task? We teachers personally have probably had
little preparation for this sort of question, either in our own education or in many of the textbooks we
use. Surveying past investigative tasks can be instructive as to what was off the board curriculum-wise
that year, and it can help students understand what is investigative about a problem and how they can
approach it based on what they do know; however, looking at past investigations will not tell us what might
happen on future exams. Some teachers have tried writing their own investigations; suggestions for such
activities have occasionally been posted on the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion Group. It is worth noting
that in recent years students have been doing better on the investigative task. Readers are not seeing as
many blank papers, because students are being encouraged by their teachers to think creatively and to do
something reasonable on these challenging problems.
The important thing for students to remember is not to panic. What they are being asked to do is
step outside their comfort zone for a moment and to think statistically, going beyond just knowledge of
formulas and procedures. Such a request appears as one part of one question on a three-hour exam.
Year-End Review
The best way to adequately prepare students for the AP Exam is to deliver a solid, well-grounded course
throughout the school year. By this reasoning, exam preparation begins on the first day, but there is still
the need to allow adequate time for exam review and preparation. For many teachers this is somewhere
between two and four weeks. There are many strategies for conducting a successful review. Some of these
have been illustrated in the sample syllabi in chapter 3. Others are listed below.
Use one of the available review books. A number of these are listed in chapter 5, Resources for
Teachers.
If you do not have the AP Released Exams in your possession, you might be able to acquire them
from experienced teachers. They can also be purchased online at store.collegeboard.com.
Give your students the Statistics Practice Exam available on AP Central to teachers whose syllabi
have met the course audit requirements.
Work with your schools AP Coordinator to ensure that students are aware of all the rules and
procedures associated with the exam so that extraneous factors will not add to their stress level.
Some schools hold a mock exam on a Saturday morning sometime in April, using one of the
Released Exams. This event allows students to actually experience the testing conditions they will
experience on exam day and helps them develop a better sense of how to manage their time so as
to get though both sections of the exam, especially the free-response section. Some schools do this
individually if traveling is problematic, whereas others conduct it in cooperation with other high
schools in their area. (See the Review for the AP Exam section of Jeane Swaynoss syllabus for her
description of the mock exam at Seminole High School.) All teachers agree beforehand not to use
the problems from the proposed mock exam during the rest of the year. If you have a local AP
Statistics support group, it could serve as the organizational vehicle to disseminate information and
get the ball rolling.
Share and discuss sample student responses and scoring guidelines when you do past AP Exam
questions in class (all are available on AP Central). Additional student responses can be obtained at
one- and two-day or weeklong College Board workshops. Let your students grade their classmates
work, if your school has no policy prohibiting this. If such a policy exists, then have them grade
their own work. I have successfully used the following approach: I choose an AP problem based on
the current or a past topic and give it as an in-class, timed (12 to 15 minutes) writing assignment.
Once students have completed the assignment, I review the scoring guidelines with them. Then the
222
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
class practices evaluating a set of sample student responses drawn from workshops and AP Central.
They score several papers, and I discuss the score that the paper actually received and why. Finally,
they score their own response to the problem given at the beginning of the period. I then pick up the
papers and recheck their judgments.
Incorporate old AP Exam questions either on tests or as independent problem sets. Quite a few
teachers include an AP free-response question on each test throughout the year. Starting early in
the year, I also give students one or two free-response problems each week, which I call an AP set
(see chapter 3). Students have five or six days to work on this set and then turn it in. They may use
their notes and textbook, but they must work alone. I then score their work using the published
guidelines (which I share with them), return it, and discuss the questions. It is important for
students to understand precisely how the AP Exam is scored and what is valued. There is no more
educational moment than the revelation that computations alone do not get them very far without
accompanying explanations, interpretations, and justifications. The problem-set strategy has been
particularly effective for me. I direct you to several of the syllabi in chapter 3, where the authors
among them Josh Tabor, Dora Daniluk, and Michael Allwooddiscuss some of their favorite AP
problems.
Build cumulative review exercises into your homework assignments. Most statistics textbooks do not
use a spiral approach nor do they contain much in the way of cumulative reviews. Because the exam
is not organized by topic, students need to have some practice in applying and integrating statistical
procedures that were studied early in the course and have not been used for a while. You can also try
to adopt a statistical process approach to all problems from the beginning of the course, thinking
about issues of design, analysis, and scope of conclusions every time.
Go to the Exam Tips: Statistics link on the AP Statistics Course Home Page. Here you will find
observations from the Chief Reader and exam tips for teachers and students.
Share the instructions for the exam with students. For example, some AP Exams are to be done
in pen, whereas others are strictly pencil. The AP Statistics Exam can be written in pen or pencil.
Review with students the acceptable use policies concerning calculator enhancements. These can be
found on the AP Statistics Course Home Page. A complete set of exam instructions can be found in
the Released Exams or obtained from your schools AP Coordinator.
The tone of the year-end reviews should be positive and upbeat. Students are in the home stretch and may
begin to wane in their enthusiasm. A pep talk may be helpful. I try to convey my belief that they can do
well on the AP Exam, but that they need to work hard and stay focused through the review to gain the best
advantage they can. After all, you and your students are in this together. None of us know what questions
will be on the exam. A brief perusal of the experimental design questions, for example, shows that each one
has been quite different and that using past problems to predict future questions is probably not useful. The
common goal for everyone is a job well done. I am their cheerleader in this. I also remind them that they
should be well rested. Despite the claim of many students that they work well under pressure, last minute,
late-night cramming can be highly counterproductive.
My second trimester exam in February is a three-hour mock AP Exam. There are 40 multiple-choice
questions, drawn from the 1997 exam, the multiple-choice questions in the several editions of the Course
Description, and some of my own, along with six free-response questions from past AP Exams. Because
students have already done the three-hour exam, I do not feel the necessity of repeating the experience
during the intense review time at the end of the year.
The first week of review is a category-by-category synopsisone day each on experimental design,
exploratory data analysis, probability and random variables, regression, and sampling distributions.
223
Chapter 4
1
Assignments during this week include some of the released free-response problems I havent yet used,
several investigative tasks, and several sets of multiple-choice questions I have assembled over the years. On
Friday of this review week, the students are given the 2002 Released Exam to complete on their own time. I
ask them to set aside two blocks of 90 minutes over the next four days to accomplish this, using only their
formula sheets and tables from the exam, plus their calculators. This extended time period allows students
to schedule the exam around their other academic and family obligations. Once they turn it in, I grade it,
and we go over it using the scoring guidelines for the free-response questions. We fill in any remaining
review time with free-response problems remaining from past exams.
Each syllabus in chapter 3 has some suggestions for student activities, including projects. For
example, both Josh Tabor and Jared Derksen describe projects exploring the concept of bias.
There are many suggestions listed in the article After the Exam: Activities and Projects, listed
under Teacher Resource Materials on the AP Statistics Course Home Page.
You can also find quite a few examples of past projects on several of the experienced teacher Web
sites (an excellent source is Al Coons, www.bbn-school.org/us/math/ap_stats).
Below are some specific projects that students might enjoy researching:
A project might not suit everyones needs, so here are several other suggestions:
Some teachers show one of the films or videos listed under Multimedia Resources in chapter 5.
These teachers have developed several handouts and worksheets that can be found by searching the
discussion archives.
Chapter 5 also contains a list of suggested popular books that you might find useful. These include
several titles by John Allen Paulos, Damned Lies and Statistics by Joel Best, Freakonomics by Steven
Levitt and Stephen Dubner, and Polling Matters by Frank Newport.
Teach a few additional topics. Chapters on multiple regression and ANOVA are frequently included
in textbooks and are not very hard to introduce to students who have completed the AP Statistics
Topic Outline.
224
The APAbout
ExamAP
in Statistics
225
Chapter 4
1
Using the AP Instructional Planning Report
Schools receive the AP Instructional Planning Report for each of their AP classes in September. The
report compares your students performance on specific topics in the AP Exam to the performance of
students worldwide on those same topics, helping you target areas for increased attention and focus in the
curriculum. To get the most out of the report, please read the interpretive information on the document.
It explains how the data, when used correctly, can provide valuable information for instructional and
curricular assessment as well as for planning and development. Contact your schools AP Coordinator for
this report.
Many factors can influence exam results. Differences in performance between your students and the
worldwide group may be the result of any number of factors. Some of these might be different instructional
methods, differences in emphasis or preparation on particular parts of the examination, differences in
curriculum during the pre-AP years, or differences in student background and preparation in comparison
with the global group.
Using the AP Instructional Planning Report you can compare your students performance to the global
group on the multiple-choice and free-response sections of the exam. Scores are broken down into four
categories: lowest, second, third, and highest quartiles. The quartiles do not correspond to the final AP
grades of 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5. The report also compares the global group to your students results for the four
content areas of the multiple-choice questionsexploring data, probability and simulation, statistical
inference, and sampling and experimentation. For example, if your students seem to be scoring in the
lowest fourth on the sampling and experimental design multiple-choice questions, it may indicate a content
area to which you should devote more attention next year. Or it may mean that your students just need
more practice completing multiple-choice questions about sampling and design.
Each of the six free-response questions uses the same performance categories of quartiles. Examine
each question carefully, looking for similarities and differences between your students performance and
that of the global group. Is the mean performance for your students the same as the global mean? How
difficult did your students find the question (or group of questions) compared with the global group?
If your group is below the global population only on free-response questions, for example, writing and
organizational skills may need to be emphasized in the future. The AP Instructional Planning Report is
meant to provide valuable feedback in order to help you assess the progress of your course and point to
areas of success as well as areas that may need more attention. Be sure to take advantage of it.
226
Chapter 5
Resources for Teachers
Useful Information Sources
The following resources will be helpful to both new and experienced teachers of AP Statistics. Some of
these sources contain information that may be at a more advanced level than the AP Statistics course, and
they are included to assist teachers who wish to extend their knowledge in specific or general statistical
areas. Others are relevant to the teaching of statistics in general, or to particular topics in the AP Statistics
curriculum. Because such a large amount of material is available, you should approach your acquisition
of resources in stages. As you expand your collection of resources, you can begin to add textbook support
materials, news articles, magazines, journals, newsletters, movies, and other multimedia items.
The first thing you will want to choose is the textbook that best suits the needs of your students. Next,
essential information about the AP Exam can be found in the Course Description, in AP Statistics Released
Exams, and on AP Central. The Course Description, discussed in chapter 1, is available in downloadable
format on AP Central. In this book you will find about a dozen multiple-choice questions indicative of
those that appear on the AP Exam. Note that they are not computational in nature and not calculatordriven. If you have an older version of the Course Description (before 2004) or happen to know someone
who does, the multiple-choice set in that book is different. You might try to get your hands on this older set
in order to have more multiple-choice questions available for your use.
Printed versions of complete AP Exams are usually released every four or five years. The 2007 and
2002 AP Statistics Exams are currently available at store.collegeboard.com. Each Released Exam contains
both the multiple-choice and free-response questions and solutions, along with scoring guidelines and
commentary on the scoring. The Released Exam is where you can read about how the exam is developed
and scored, how Readers are trained to score the free-response questions, the instructions that students
will be given on the day of the actual exam, and the scoring worksheet and comments on how the actual
AP grade is determined.
Free-response questions and scoring guidelines from past years are available at no cost on the AP
Statistics Exam Page on AP Central. This includes free-response questions from recent Form B exams
(the overseas exam). In addition, there are three actual student responses for each question, along with
commentary on the scoring of each response. Be sure to also avail yourself of the AP Statistics Practice
Exam (which includes both multiple-choice and free-response questions) that is available as a free
download if your syllabus has been approved in the AP Course Audit process.
The following compilation was current as of the writing of this publication; however, the reader should
be aware that new books and teaching aids are being introduced all the time. A continuing source for
learning about the latest resources is the AP Central Web site, which is described in detail in chapter 2.
Some of the resources included here are also listed at AP Central, with descriptions and evaluations by
statisticians and teachers of AP Statistics. (Note: This list of resources is not meant as an endorsement by
the College Board or the AP Statistics Development Committee of any particular publication or author.)
227
Chapter 5
1
Print Resources
Basic Textbooks
There is no one textbook that will be the best for all students in all situations. The information presented
here is meant to provide you with some of the basics of each text. Carefully consider the merits of each
book as they apply to your students. You may want to obtain sample copies (available from the publishers
Web sites) and look through them, comparing the style of presentation, examples provided in the body
of the text, and practice exercises. Are the problems interesting, varied, and of sufficient number to
provide several assignments as well as review? One way you might approach this is to choose a topic,
such as one-sample confidence intervals, and read through the appropriate chapter in each text you are
considering. Does the style of writing and presentation fit with your style of teaching and how you think
about statistics? How accessible are the writing and problems to your students? Some of the books include
calculator instructions and keystrokes in the body of the examples and reading, whereas others list them at
the end of the chapter or in separate sections within the chapter. Even though it is essential that students
have intimate knowledge of the statistical capabilities of the calculator, you need to consider when that
instruction will occur.
In addition, most of these texts have companion Web sites that contain demonstration applets for
student and teacher use, test banks, solutions manuals, an instructors guide, and/or supplemental review
materials. You will want to examine these as well. Some are accompanied by a CD-ROM of data sets from
the textbook that are easily downloadable in various formats to statistical software. Statistical software
can also be bundled with several of the texts for an additional charge. The best place to gather information
about this support material is to go to the publishers Web site. Although you may be using one publishers
textbook you may, in fact, prefer to use the AP review material from another. Look at the various guides,
or ask someone who is currently teaching the course for advice. With that in mind, the following list
includes those texts that are most often cited, discussed, and recommended on the AP Statistics Electronic
Discussion Group (EDG). They are in alphabetical order by lead author.
Bock, David E., Paul F. Velleman, and Richard D. De Veaux. Stats: Modeling the World. 2nd ed. Boston:
Pearson/Addison-Wesley, 2007.
The style of this textbook is a bit more informal and colloquial than several of the other texts. There are
lots of exercises to choose from, and in some cases the same data are used in more than one context.
For example, an exercise that appears in the chapter on probability may also be used in the inference
chapter on comparing counts (chi-square). The teachers edition comes bundled with a CD containing
ActivStats. An AP Exam review guide with four mock exams is also available (see the Exam Review
Guides section later in this chapter).
Moore, David S., and George P. McCabe. Introduction to the Practice of Statistics. 5th ed. New York:
W. H. Freeman, 2006.
This text can be somewhat daunting. Some of the sections are quite long, and breaking them up into
manageable chunks takes some experience and a good sense of organization. On the other hand, it
is very well written, and a wealth of support material is available, including a CD containing data
sets and practice problems. The fifth edition has been updated with lots of new exercises, and sample
output screens have been added for Minitab, SPSS, JMP, T1-83/84, and Crunchit! This text can be a bit
overwhelming for a first-year teacher of the course, but if you are reasonably confident of your statistics
background, it can be a very effective book. Because it is a college text, it lacks some of the flavor of
AP-type problems, which you will have to find through other sources.
228
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Peck, Roxy, Chris Olsen, and Jay Devore. Introduction to Statistics and Data Analysis. 3rd ed. Belmont,
Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2008.
The authors are well known and have been highly involved with the AP Statistics program. Roxy Peck
is a former Chief Reader for the AP Statistics Exam, and Chris Olsen was on the original Development
Committee and is a very frequent contributor to the EDG. This was one of the first texts to be written
specifically for AP Statistics. A large resource binder and a complete test bank are available.
Watkins, Ann E., Richard L. Scheaffer, and George W. Cobb. Statistics in Action: Understanding a World
of Data. Emeryville, Calif.: Key Curriculum Press, 2004.
The philosophy of the authors, who are known nationally in the field of statistics education, is that
statistical work is much more active than it was a generation ago. Gathering data, exploring data, and
making inferences from data should be a hands-on experience. This text is an activity-based approach
that will be familiar to those who have seen Activity-Based Statistics (see the Supplementary Textbooks
section below).
Yates, Daniel S., David S. Moore, and Daren S. Starnes. The Practice of Statistics: TI 83/84/89 Graphing
Calculator Enhanced. 3rd ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2007.
This text is an updated version of the 1999 first edition by Yates, Moore, and McCabe (one of the first
to be geared toward a high school audience) and the 2003 second edition by Yates, Moore, and Starnes.
As with the other texts, the companion Web site contains plenty of fine support material, applets, and
online demonstrations. Ancillary resources in the Golden Resource Binder are considered outstanding
by many teachers. The third edition includes a new AP Exam prep guide (see the Exam Review Guides
section below).
Other textbooks will most certainly be published in the future that will align with the AP Statistics
curriculum. I urge you to regularly visit the AP Statistics Course Home Page at AP Central. There you
will find more than 150 reviews of teaching resources, including current and newly published textbooks,
all written by experienced statistics instructors. There are lots of textbooks available, but many were not
written with this course in mind. Please consider your choices carefully. A good textbook is an essential
element for a successful course and for making your life a bit easier.
Supplementary Textbooks
In addition to the primary textbook that you select for your course, there are many other fine textbooks
on the market that present challenging statistical concepts particularly well, for both your understanding
and that of your students. Some of these are listed below. Commentaries are included for selected books in
this list.
Chance, Beth L., and Allan J. Rossman. Investigating Statistical Concepts, Applications, and Methods. Pacific
Grove, Calif: Duxbury Press, 2005.
Chatterjee, Samprit, Mark S. Handcock, and Jeffrey S. Simonoff. A Casebook for a First Course in Statistics
and Data Analysis. New York: Wiley, 1995.
Freedman, David, Robert Pisani, and Roger Purves. Statistics. 4th ed. New York: W. W. Norton, 2007. This
is a text that I usually turn to first when I need to check some concept.
Hand, D. J. et al., eds. A Handbook of Small Data Sets. New York: Chapman and Hall, 1994.
229
Chapter 5
1
McClave, James T., and Terry Sincich. Statistics. 11th ed. Upper Saddle River, N.J.: Pearson/Prentice Hall,
2007.
Moore, David S. The Basic Practice of Statistics. 4th ed. New York: W. H. Freeman, 2007.
Moore, David S., and William I. Notz. Statistics: Concepts and Controversies. 6th ed. New York: W. H.
Freeman, 2006. This is an excellent source of ideas for free-response questions and writing exercises.
Peck, Roxy et al. Statistics: A Guide to the Unknown. 4th ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2006.
A compendium of well-written essays and case studies on applications of statistics from the fields of
business and industry, public policy and social science, biology and medicine, and others. This is an
excellent source of supplemental readings to enhance any introductory statistics course.
Ramsey, Fred L, and Daniel W. Schafer. The Statistical Sleuth: A Course in Methods of Data Analysis.
2nd ed. Pacific Grove, Calif.: Thomson/Duxbury, 2002. It would be difficult to find a book that matches
the philosophy of the AP Statistics course as well as this one. Although it could not reasonably be used as
a textbook for the AP course, it is an ideal resource for teachers. It is organized around case studies, and
the data are very real and interesting.
Rossman, Allan J., and Beth L. Chance. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data. 2nd ed. Emeryville,
Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2001. The third edition will be published in 2008. The Workshop Statistics
books contain an excellent series of student-centered, hands-on activities that are well written and easy
to follow. Students can explore statistical principles, discover statistical concepts, and apply the various
statistical techniques to interesting data sets. Many teachers use this as a supplemental text to other
written sources, because some AP topics are not included in this book. Technology-specific versions are
also available: see the next three listings.
Rossman, Allan J., and Beth L. Chance. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data and Minitab. 2nd ed.
Emeryville, Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2001.
Rossman, Allan J., Beth L. Chance, and Robin H. Lock. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data and
Fathom. Emeryville, Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2001.
Rossman, Allan J., Beth L. Chance, and J. Barr von Oehsen. Workshop Statistics: Discovery with Data and
the Graphing Calculator. 2nd ed. Emeryville, Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2002.
Salsburg, David. The Lady Tasting Tea: How Statistics Revolutionized Science in the Twentieth Century.
New York: W. H. Freeman, 2001. This book is a wonderful supplement for those interested in the history
of statistics. Although not an easy read, I would recommend it as independent reading for any interested
student of statistics and as terrific background reading for teachers.
Scheaffer, Richard L., William Mendenhall III, and R. Lyman Ott. Elementary Survey Sampling. 6th ed.
Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2006.
Scheaffer, Richard L., Ann E. Watkins, Jeffrey A. Witmer, and Mrudulla Gnanadesikan. Revised by Tim
Erickson. Activity-Based Statistics. 2nd ed. Emeryville, Calif.: Key College Publishing, 2004.
Siegel, Andrew F., and Charles J. Morgan. Statistics and Data Analysis: An Introduction. 2nd ed. New York:
Wiley, 1996.
Tufte, Edward R. The Visual Display of Quantitative Information. 2nd ed. Cheshire, Conn.: Graphics
Press, 2001.
230
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Utts, Jessica M. Seeing Through Statistics. 3rd ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2005. Each
chapter starts with several interesting and useful thought questions. These make nice writing exercises.
Utts, Jessica M., and Robert F. Heckard. Mind on Statistics. 3rd ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole,
2007. One of my favorite books, this contains lots of nice problems and data sets.
Popular Reading
Below is a list of suggested readings for both students and teachers, gleaned from a variety of sources and
teachers recommendations. Some teachers have used these during their postAP Exam period, whereas
others have assigned parts of these works for summer reading.
Bernstein, Peter L. Against the Gods: The Remarkable Story of Risk. New York: Wiley, 1996.
231
Chapter 5
1
Best, Joel. Damned Lies and Statistics: Untangling Numbers from the Media, Politicians, and Activists.
Berkeley: University of California Press, 2001.
Crossen, Cynthia. Tainted Truth: The Manipulation of Fact in America. New York: Simon and Schuster,
1994. The author contends that we are continually awash in facts that originate from researchers
beholden to corporations.
Desrosires, Alain. The Politics of Large Numbers: A History of Statistical Reasoning. Cambridge, Mass.:
Harvard University Press, 1998. This is a quite demanding, complex, and sophisticated look at the
history of statistics and an analysis of its function within the state.
Dewdney, A. K. 200% of Nothing: An Eye-Opening Tour Through the Twists and Turns of Math Abuse and
Innumeracy. New York: Wiley, 1993.
Glassner, Barry. The Culture of Fear: Why Americans Are Afraid of the Wrong Things. New York: Basic
Books, 1999. The book deals with popular misconceptions of the relative risk of many activities.
Gould, Stephen Jay. Full House: The Spread of Excellence from Plato to Darwin. New York: Harmony Books,
1996. This one is challenging.
Huff, Darrell. How to Lie with Statistics. New York: W. W. Norton, 1954.
Levitt, Steven D., and Stephen J. Dubner. Freakonomics: A Rogue Economist Explores the Hidden Side of
Everything. New York: William Morrow, 2005.
Newport, Frank. Polling Matters: Why Leaders Must Listen to the Wisdom of the People. New York: Warner
Books, 2004.
Paulos, John Allen. Beyond Numeracy: Ruminations of a Numbers Man. New York: Knopf, 1991. Visit
Pauloss interesting and thought-provoking home page at www.math.temple.edu/~paulos.
Paulos, John Allen. Innumeracy: Mathematical Illiteracy and Its Consequences. New York: Hill and
Wang, 1988.
Paulos, John Allen. A Mathematician Plays the Stock Market. New York: Basic Books, 2003.
Paulos, John Allen. A Mathematician Reads the Newspaper. New York: Basic Books, 1995.
Paulos, John Allen. Once upon a Number: The Hidden Mathematical Logic of Stories. New York: Basic
Books, 1998.
Professional Reading
This collection of readings will provide you with additional content and pedagogy beyond the level of the
course. It may be useful for increasing your understanding of some of the courses key concepts and topics.
American Statistical Association. Guidelines for Assessment and Instruction in Statistics Education (GAISE)
Report. Alexandria, Va.: American Statistical Association, 2005.
www.amstat.org/education/gaise/.
Babbie, Earl. The Practice of Social Research. 11th ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson/Wadsworth, 2007.
232
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Book, Stephen A. Why n1 in the Formula for the Sample Standard Deviation? Two-Year College
Mathematics Journal 10 (1979): 330-33.
Box, George E. P., William G. Hunter, and J. Stuart Hunter. Statistics for Experimenters: An Introduction to
Design, Data Analysis, and Model Building. New York: Wiley, 1978.
Campbell, Donald T., and Julian C. Stanley. Experimental and Quasi-experimental Designs for Research.
Chicago: Rand McNally, 1963.
Cleveland, William S. Visualizing Data. Summit, N.J.: Hobart Press, 1993.
Cobb, George W. Introduction to Design and Analysis of Experiments. New York: Springer, 1998.
Cobb, George W. Teaching Statistics: More Data, Less Lecturing. In Heeding the Call for Change:
Suggestions for Curricular Action, ed. Lynn Arthur Steen. Washington, D.C.: Mathematical Association
of America, 1992.
Cobb, George W., and David S. Moore. Mathematics, Statistics, and Teaching. American Mathematical
Monthly 104 (November 1997): 801-23.
Everitt, B. S. The Cambridge Dictionary of Statistics. 3rd ed. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2006.
Gal, Iddo, and Joan B. Garfield, eds. The Assessment Challenge in Statistics Education. Amsterdam: IOS
Press, 1997.
Garfield, Joan. How Students Learn Statistics. International Statistical Review 63, no. 1 (1995): 2534.
Garfield, Joan, and Andrew Ahlgren. Difficulties in Learning Basic Concepts in Probability and Statistics:
Implications for Research. Journal for Research in Mathematics Education 19 (1988): 4463.
Garfield, Joan, and Iddo Gal. Assessment and Statistics Education: Current Challenges and Directions.
International Statistical Review 67, no. 1 (1999): 112.
Gelman, Andrew, and Deborah Nolan. Teaching Statistics: A Bag of Tricks. New York: Oxford University
Press, 2002.
Gordon, Florence, and Sheldon Gordon, eds. Statistics for the Twenty-first Century. Washington, D.C.:
Mathematical Association of America, 1992.
Hamilton, Lawrence C. Regression with Graphics: A Second Course in Applied Statistics. Pacific Grove,
Calif.: Brooks/Cole, 1992.
Hoaglin, David C., and David S. Moore, eds. Perspectives on Contemporary Statistics. Washington, D.C.:
Mathematical Association of America, 1992.
Law, Averill M. Simulation Modeling and Analysis. 4th ed. Boston: McGraw-Hill, 2006.
Lovett, Marcia C., and Joel B. Greenhouse. Applying Cognitive Theory to Statistics Instruction. American
Statistician 54, no. 3 (August 2000): 196206.
233
Chapter 5
1
Misra, S. Chandra, Hardeo Sahai, Anil P. Gore, and Joseph K. Garrett. A Bibliography on the Teaching of
Probability and Statistics. American Statistician 41, no. 4 (November 1987): 284310.
Moore, David S. New Pedagogy and New Content: The Case of Statistics. International Statistical Review
65, no. 2 (1997): 123-65.
Moore, Thomas L. Teaching Statistics: Resources for Undergraduate Instructors. Washington D.C.:
Mathematical Association of America, 2000.
National Council of Teachers of Mathematics. Principles and Standards for School Mathematics. Reston,
Va.: National Council of Teachers of Mathematics, 2000. Available electronically for 120-day free access
at http://standards.nctm.org.
National Council of Teachers of Mathematics. Thinking and Reasoning with Data and Chance: 68th NCTM
Yearbook. Reston, Va.: National Council of Teachers of Mathematics, 2006.
Peters, William Stanley. Counting for Something: Statistical Principles and Personalities. New York:
Springer, 1987.
Rosner, Bernard. Fundamentals of Biostatistics. 6th ed. Belmont, Calif.: Thomson Brooks/Cole, 2006.
Ross, Sheldon M. A First Course in Probability. 7th ed. Upper Saddle River, N.J.: Pearson/Prentice Hall,
2006.
Shaughnessy, J. Michael, and Beth L. Chance. Statistical Questions from the Classroom. Reston, Va.:
National Council of Teachers of Mathematics, 2005.
Singer, Judith D., and John B. Willett. Improving the Teaching of Applied Statistics: Putting the Data Back
into Data Analysis. American Statistician 44, no. 3 (August 1990): 223-30.
234
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Journal of Statistics Education.
www.amstat.org/publications/jse.
JSE is a publication of the American Statistical Association, disseminating knowledge for the
improvement of statistics education at all levels, including elementary, secondary, and postsecondary
education. It is distributed electronically and, in accord with its broad focus, publishes articles that
enhance the exchange of interesting and useful information among educators, practitioners, and
researchers around the world. The intended audience includes anyone who teaches statistics, as well as
those interested in research on statistical and probabilistic reasoning.
Mathematics Teacher.
www.nctm.org/publications.
This monthly magazine published by the National Council of Teachers of Mathematics offers activities,
lesson ideas, teaching strategies, and problems through in-depth articles, departments, and features.
Statistics Teacher Network.
www.amstat.org/education/stn.
This newsletter is published three times a year by the American Statistical Association and the
National Council of Teachers of Mathematics Joint Committee on Curriculum in Statistics and
Probability. STN is a free publication whose purpose is to keep grade K12 teachers informed about
statistical workshops, programs, and reviews of books, software, and calculators. In addition, articles
describing successful classroom statistical activities are included.
STATS: The Magazine for Students of Statistics.
www.amstat.org/publications/stats.
STATS magazine, published by the American Statistical Association, contains career information,
student experiences, current problems and case studies, humor, and stories from leaders in statistical
science. The goal of STATS is to promote the field of statistics and make its contributions accessible to
a broad audience.
Teaching Statistics: An International Journal for Teachers.
www.blackwell-synergy.com/loi/test?cookieSet=1.
This journal seeks to help teachers of biology, business studies, economics, geography, mathematics,
and the social sciences by showing how statistical ideas can illuminate their work and how to make
proper use of statistics in their teaching. It is also directed toward those who teach statistics as a
separate subject and to those who teach statistics in conjunction with mathematics courses. The
emphasis of the articles is on teaching and the classroom. Its aim is to inform, entertain, encourage
and enlighten all who use statistics in their teaching or who teach statistics per se.
Multimedia Resources
Multimedia, when used effectively, can be an engaging tool for students in the total learning process for AP
Statistics. The following software packages and videos are just some of the many that are available.
Computer Software
Teaching Software
ActivStats.
www.datadesk.com/products/mediadx/activstats.
235
Chapter 5
1
Fathom.
www.keypress.com/fathom.
Statistics Packages
Data Desk.
www.datadesk.com.
JMP.
www.jmpdiscovery.com.
Minitab.
www.minitab.com/products.
Note: Releases 14 and 15 have many excellent upgrades for elementary data displays. Network and
single-user versions are available.
Other Software
R statistical software.
www.r-project/org.
Available for free on the Web at the R Project for Statistical Computing.
R FAQs
http://cran.r-project.org/bin/windows/base/rw-FAQ.html.
StatCrunch: Data Analysis on the Web.
www.statcrunch.com.
This used to be free but now must be purchased. It can be downloaded from the Web site.
WinStat.
http://math.exeter.edu/rparris/winstats.html.
This software, by Rick Parris at Phillips Exeter Academy, will do pretty much anything statistical. It is
updated regularly.
Commercial Films
And the Band Played On. 1993. Directed by Roger Spottiswoode. HBO. 140 mins. This movie is based on a
book by Randy Shilts about the early years of the AIDS epidemicsomewhat controversial but contains
lots of statistics. See Zack Bigners Web site (linked through the AP Statistics FAQ site listed in the Web
Sites section of this chapter) for several worksheets about this movie. As in all teaching situations, it is
important to know your community norms when deciding whether to use a particular resource.
A Civil Action. 1998. Directed by Steven Zaillian. Touchstone Pictures. 115 mins. The subject is a lawsuit
brought against a company for polluting the environment. See the AP Statistics Electronic Discussion
Group of May 2004 for several worksheets on this movie.
Educational Films
Against All Odds: Inside Statistics. 1989. Written by David S. Moore. Lexington, Mass.: Consortium for
Mathematics and Its Applications (COMAP). 26 half-hour segments. VHS or DVD. Available for online
viewing (not downloading).
www.learner.org/resources/series65.html.
236
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Statistics: Decisions Through Data. 1992. Written by David S. Moore. Lexington, Mass.: Consortium for
Mathematics and Its Applications (COMAP). Five hour-long videos with users guide (total of 21 video
segments). VHS or DVD.
www.comap.com/product/?idx=200.
Web Sites
American Statistical Association. Links to useful applet sites.
www.amstat.org/sections/educ/applets.html.
AP Statistics Course Home Page.
apcentral.collegeboard.com/stats.
AP Central is the single, best source for all information and resources relating to AP Statistics. The
site is described extensively in chapter 2.
Boggs, Rex. Exploring Data.
http://exploringdata.cqu.edu.au.
This is an excellent site for AP Statistics teaching materials and downloadable activities.
Chance. Materials to help teach a Chance course (a quantitative literacy course).
www.dartmouth.edu/~chance.
Includes sample activities, videos, assessments, and archives of Chance Newsdescriptions of recent
news articles involving probability and statistics along with suggested discussion questions.
CIA World Factbook.
www.cia.gov/library/publications/the-world-factbook.
Consortium for the Advancement of Undergraduate Statistics Education (CAUSE).
www.causeweb.org.
CAUSE has many resources, among the most valuable to teachers being the extensive set of lesson
examples and applets available for teaching statistical concepts. Among the hundreds is one using the
criminal trials in the U.S. justice system to illustrate hypothesis testing; another features the creation
of 95 percent confidence intervals for the theoretical mean.
Coons, Al. BB&N AP Statistics. Al Coons AP Statistics class Web site.
www.bbn-school.org/us/math/ap_stats.
An excellent source of links to applets, tests, and projects.
Data and Story Library.
http://lib.stat.cmu.edu/DASL.
Derksen, Jared. AP Statistics FAQ.
www.mrderksen.com/faq.htm.
Frequently asked questions about statistical concepts for new teachers. This site is a subdivision of
MrDerksen.com (www.mrderksen.com) and is described in detail in chapter 2. It contains a wealth of
information culled from the AP Statistics EDG, along with links to experienced teachers Web sites, a
number of which are also listed here.
Gallup Organization.
www.gallup.com.
237
Chapter 5
1
Lock, Robin. WWW Resources for Teaching Statistics.
http://it.stlawu.edu/~rlock/maa51/www.html.
An excellent place to look for data sets and other online materials with some commentary.
McGrail, Sheila. AP Stat Resources.
www.ccds.charlotte.nc.us/mcgrail/apsres.htm.
Molesky, Jason. AP Statistics at Lakeville South High School in Minnesota.
http://web.mac.com/statsmonkey.
North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics. NCSSM Statistics Institutes.
http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Stat_Inst/links_to_all_stats_institutes.htm.
NCSSM has been a great incubator for the creation of teachers material for AP Statistics. Here you
will find a wonderful array of activities, lessons with teachers notes, and Web-based resources for
your use in class. For a new teacher, the material produced during the 2007 institute will the most
beneficial starting point.
Rice Virtual Lab in Statistics.
http://onlinestatbook.com/rvls.html
Great site for Java applets that illustrate sampling distributions (outstanding!) and demonstrations for
confidence intervals, normal approximation to the binomial, and power, among others.
Smart, Joyce. Mrs. Smarts AP Statistics Page. Teacher site.
www.lhs.logan.k12.ut.us/~jsmart/stats.html.
U.S. Census Bureau.
www.census.gov.
West, Webster. Java Applets.
www.stat.tamu.edu/~west/javahtml.
Assessment Sites
ARTIST (Assessment Resource Tools for Improving Statistical Thinking).
https://app.gen.umn.edu/artist/index.html.
Here students can take online multiple-choice quizzes that are topic specific. The site also offers preand post-tests, as well as a large database that can be searched for items to add to a test or quiz. It is
also possible to create a test or quiz at the site, then download it to your computer in Microsoft Word.
Schott, Brian, Georgia State University. Database of Sample Statistics Quiz Questions.
www.gsu.edu/~dscbms/ibs/ibsd.html.
Schott, Brian, Georgia State University. Practice Questions for Business Statistics.
www.gsu.edu/~dscbms/ibs/qcontent.html.
Through an NSF grant, the Department of Business Statistics at Georgia State University has
developed a large collection of useful test questions, both multiple-choice (see the previous entry) and
free-response (this one).
238
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Simon Fraser University, Department of Statistics and Actuarial Science. SFU Statistics
Multiple-Choice Questions.
www.stat.sfu.ca/~cschwarz/MultipleChoice
A wonderful assortment of multiple-choice questions, with answers, that can be used on tests and for
exam review preparation.
See also Long Answer Questions, also on the Simon Fraser site:
www.stat.sfu.ca/~cschwarz/LongAnswer/.
Professional Associations
As a new teacher of AP Statistics, another way to stay current in the discipline is to join one or more
professional organizations.
American Mathematical Association of Two-Year Colleges
Southwest Tennessee Community College
5983 Macon Cove
Memphis, TN 38134
901 333-4643
www.amatyc.org
E-mail: amatyc@amatyc.org
American Statistical Association
732 North Washington Street
Alexandria, VA 22314-1943
703 684-1221; 888 231-3473
www.amstat.org
E-mail: asainfo@amstat.org
Click on the Education link in the sidebar to bring up the Center for Statistics Education. The Education
menu also has a link to the Statistics Teacher Network, where you can sign up to receive the newsletter,
browse older issues, and link to materials for K12 statistics. A K12 school membership is currently $50.
You receive STATS and Chance magazines as part of the membership, as well as the Statistics Teacher
Network newsletter.
239
Chapter 5
1
Consortium for the Advancement of Undergraduate Statistics Education
Ohio State University, Department of Statistics
404 Cockins Hall
1958 Neil Avenue
Columbus, OH 43210-1247
614 292-3887
www.causeweb.org
E-mail: info@causeweb.org
Mathematical Association of America
1529 18th Street NW
Washington, DC 20036-1385
202 387-5200; 800 741-9415
www.maa.org
E-mail: maahq@maa.org
National Council of Teachers of Mathematics
1906 Association Drive
Reston, VA 22091-1502
703 620-9840
www.nctm.org
E-mail: inquiries@nctm.org
This section on information sources has presented a blueprint for establishing a core group of resources
and then adding to it over time. Given the large amount of material that I have assembled, this may
seem to be an overwhelming task. Just as a museum builds its art collection over time, so too should this
chapter be thought of as a long-term plan for the acquisition of a statistical collection. Do not expect it to
happen overnight. During my first year, in 1996, I concentrated on the textbook, gathered news articles
on a regular basis to use in class, screened some videos, and worked on some data-gathering activities. In
subsequent years I added to my repertoire. Be realistic about what you can accomplishmaybe it is just the
textbook, a review guide, some news articles, and a single project in your first year. Try to do a bit more the
second year.
I encourage you to regularly peruse the resources on AP Central and experienced teacher Web sites. If
you go to a conference, seek out the sessions that are about statistics. Talk to other statistics teachers, and
ask them not only what favorite resources they use but how they use them in the classroom. I have obtained
much useful information over a cup of coffee or standing in line waiting for a session.
Best wishes as you embark on a truly wonderful teaching experience. For me, AP Statistics has been a
richly rewarding and fun course to teach. As many students have said to me, I never had to ask, When am
I ever going to use this?
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Link to the College Board Store, where you can purchase Released Exams and supplemental
materials, such as the sampling and experimental design module
Spending Wisely
For those of us operating with a limited budget, the essential issue is how best to allocate what money
is available. Two items are not negotiable, in my opinion. The textbook must be modern enough to cover
the whole AP syllabus, and each student must have a graphing calculator with statistical capability. My
students all own their own calculators, but a classroom set purchased by the school will suffice if they
can use them at home.
Next in order of priority is access to computers with statistical software. Students are expected
to know how to read computer output when they take the AP Statistics Exam. Clearly, students
understanding will improve if they produce the output, so even one computer for individual student use or
demonstrations is advisable. At my school we bought a site license for the software and have it installed
on computers in a computer lab. I just need to reserve the lab in advance to take the class there.
There are creative ways to overcome either budget or size restrictions. I have been doing an experiment
comparing brands of paper towels by trading classrooms with a science teacher so we have access to
water. (This experiment is modeled after one done at a Statistics Leadership Institute held at the North
Carolina School of Science and Mathematics; see http://courses.ncssm.edu/math/Stat_Inst/PDFS/
PaperTow.pdf.)
We have also used local supermarkets for data collection activities, such as recording the sugar content
shown on the boxes in the cereal aisle. Each student purchases a small bag of Skittles so that we
can check distribution of colors in the bags. These days a lot of product and/or nutritional information
is available directly from stores and restaurants or can be accessed online. Finding free or inexpensive
materials for your course shouldnt be difficult: a little imagination is all that is required.
Dennis Holland, The Derryfield School,
Manchester, New Hampshire
Here are some other strategies that may help you deal with limited resources.
Form a support group by finding other statistics teachers in your area. If you attend an AP Summer
Institute (which I absolutely recommend) or a local/regional workshop, be on the lookout for others
in your area. Post a sign-up list at the conference to get your local group started. Try to meet several
times a year to discuss statistics. Pool your resources by sharing tests, quizzes, activities that worked
well, review materials, textbooks, and supplies. Sometimes buying in bulk makes it worthwhile.
You may be the only statistics teacher in your school, with no one to talk to on a regular basis.
Maintain contact with your group via e-mail.
241
Chapter 5
1
If you attend an AP Summer Institute, the lead teacher is likely to provide you with lots of good
material. Try to maintain a relationship with that person. I am still in contact with participants from
six or seven years ago, who will occasionally e-mail me a question.
The College Board, through the AP Fellows program, can help qualified candidates with funding
so that they can attend AP Summer Institutes. See the subsection on AP Grants in the Professional
Development section that begins on the next page.
Use free online statistical software if you are unable to purchase software or do not have direct
access to a computer lab (see the list of software that appeared earlier in this chapter).
Make full use of your textbooks Web site. There are likely to be lots of support materials there
tests and quizzes, textbook solutions, applets, and classroom demonstrations.
If you order enough textbooks, many companies will include the ancillary materials at no cost. Ask!
Collaborate with a local university. Find a professor who teaches statistics, and establish a
collaborative relationship. Invite the professor to give a guest lecture. Contact the ASA to find out if
any members live in your area. Many are interested in helping out.
Develop a plan to ensure that all students have access to a graphing calculator.
Look for a local company that might be willing to partner with the statistics program in your school
to provide funds for some extra teaching materials, calculators, or other useful items that would
otherwise break your departments budget.
Investigate whether your state has special funds for AP Programs that you can access.
Look for simple things to do that might be free.
Get Creative with Small Classes
In a small school setting, resources may be scarce, but that does not mean that the instruction provided
must suffer. Although it is essential that each student has a text and a calculator with statistics functions
that can be brought home to use on homework, a course can easily be supplemented without purchasing
statistics software. An abundance of Web sites are available with applets that work very well for
demonstrating major topics. Many other demonstrations and simulations can easily be conducted on a
calculator.
A teacher must be creative in other ways as well, especially when class sizes are very small (10 or fewer).
Sampling students in a small class is not as effective as in a large one, but you might be able to collect
data from the whole school. In some ways this is better, as students have to decide on reasonable ways
to randomize while obtaining a sample large enough to draw meaningful conclusions. Pooling results
in a simulation, for example, may require that each student repeat the process quite a few times. The
data from one year can be saved and added to the next. Inexpensive materials such as breakfast cereal,
colored candies, or paper clips may be used for data.
Chris True, Lincoln Southwest High School,
Lincoln, Nebraska
242
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
Talk Is Cheap
Each year after the AP Statistics Exam, I invite a guest speaker to address my classes. The speakers
have always exceeded my expectations. They describe their education-to-career journey as well as
the ways they use statistics in their work. Past speakers have been a university professor, an information
researcher, and two pharmaceutical statisticians. One good practice is to have students write questions
ahead of time and e-mail them to the speaker.
It is not hard to find engaging speakers. One was the parent of one of my students; one was discovered
by simply e-mailing a company with a concise description of what I was looking for; and another was
located by e-mailing the local ASA chapter for a contact. All methods have produced competent and
willing (and free!) speakers.
Dave Ferris, Noblesville High School,
Noblesville, Indiana
Professional Development
In this section, the College Board outlines its professional development opportunities in support of AP
educators.
The teachers, administrators, and AP Coordinators involved in the AP and Pre-AP Programs compose
a dedicated, engaged, vibrant community of educational professionals. Welcome!
We invite you to become an active participant in the community. The College Board offers a variety
of professional development opportunities designed to educate, support, and invigorate both new and
experienced AP teachers and educational professionals. These year-round offerings range from half-day
workshops to intensive weeklong summer institutes, from the AP Annual Conference to AP Central, and
from participation in an AP Reading to Development Committee membership.
243
Chapter 5
1
course-specific teaching resources. Many locations offer guest speakers, field trips, and other hands-on
activities. Each institute is managed individually by staff at the sponsoring institution under the guidelines
provided by the College Board.
Participants in College Board professional development workshops and summer institutes are eligible
for continuing education units (CEUs). The College Board is authorized by the International Association
for Continuing Education and Training (IACET) to offer CEUs. IACET is an internationally recognized
organization that provides standards and authorization for continuing education and training.
Workshop and institute offerings for the AP Statistics teacher (or potential teacher) range from
introductory to topic-specific events and include offerings tailored to teachers in the Pre-AP years. To learn
more about scheduled workshops and summer institutes near you, visit the Institutes and Workshops area
on AP Central: apcentral.collegeboard.com/events.
Online Events
The College Board offers a wide variety of online events, which are presented by College Boardendorsed
consultants and recognized subject-matter experts to participants via a Web-based, real-time interface.
Online events range from one hour to several days and are interactive, allowing for exchanges between the
presenter and participants and between participants. Like face-to-face workshops, online events vary in
focus from introductory themes to specific topics, and many offer CEUs for participants. For a complete
list of upcoming and archived online events, visit apcentral.collegeboard.com/onlineevents/schedule.
Archives of past online events are available for free. Archived events can be viewed on your computer
at your convenience.
AP Central
AP Central is the College Boards online home for AP professionals and Pre-AP. The site offers a wealth
of resources, including Course Descriptions, sample syllabi, exam questions, a vast database of teaching
resource reviews, lesson plans, course-specific feature articles, and much more. Bookmark the AP Statistics
Home Page on AP Central to gain quick access to updated resources and information about AP Statistics.
AP Program information is also available on the site, including exam calendars, fee and fee-reduction
policies, student performance data, participation forms, research reports, college and university AP grade
acceptance policies, and more.
AP professionals are encouraged to contribute to the resources on AP Central by submitting articles,
adding comments to Teachers Resources reviews, and serving as an AP Central Content Advisor.
244
Resources
About AP
for Statistics
Teachers
AP Annual Conference
The AP Annual Conference (APAC) is a gathering of the AP and Pre-AP communities, including teachers,
secondary school administrators, and college faculty. The APAC is the only national conference that
focuses on providing complete strategies for middle and high school teachers and administrators involved
in the AP Program. Conference events include presentations by each courses Development Committee,
course- and topic-specific sessions, guest speakers, and pre- and postconference workshops for new and
experienced teachers. To learn more about the event, please visit collegeboard.com/apac.
AP professionals are encouraged to lead workshops and presentations at the conference. Proposals are
due in the fall of each year prior to the event (visit AP Central for specific deadlines and requirements).
Professional Opportunities
College Board Consultants and Contributors
Experienced AP teachers and educational professionals share their techniques, best practices, materials,
and expertise with other educators by serving as College Board consultants and contributors. They may
lead workshops and summer institutes, sharing their proven techniques and best practices with new and
experienced AP teachers, AP Coordinators, and administrators. They may also contribute to AP course
and exam development (writing exam questions or serving on a Development Committee) or evaluate
AP Exams at the annual AP Reading. Consultants and contributors may be teachers, postsecondary faculty,
counselors, administrators, and retired educators. They receive an honorarium for their work and are
reimbursed for expenses. To learn more about becoming a workshop consultant, visit apcentral
.collegeboard.com/consultant.
AP Exam Readers
High school and college faculty members from around the world gather in the United States each
June to evaluate and score the free-response sections of the AP Exams at the annual AP Reading. AP
Exam Readers are led by a Chief Reader, a college professor who has the responsibility of ensuring that
students receive grades that accurately reflect college-level achievement. Readers describe the experience
as providing unparalleled insight into the exam evaluation process and as an opportunity for intensive
collegial exchange between high school and college faculty. (More than 10,500 Readers participated in
the 2008 Reading.) High school Readers receive certificates awarding professional development hours and
CEUs for their participation in the AP Reading. To apply to become an AP Reader, go to apcentral
.collegeboard.com/readers.
AP Grants
The College Board offers a suite of competitive grants that provide financial and technical assistance to
schools and teachers interested in expanding access to AP. The suite consists of three grant programs:
College Board AP Fellows, College Board Pre-AP Fellows, and the AP Start-Up Grant, totaling over
245
Chapter 5
1
$600,000 in annual support for professional development and classroom resources. The programs provide
stipends for teachers and schools that want to start an AP program or expand their current program.
Schools and teachers that serve minority and/or low-income students who have been traditionally
underrepresented in AP courses are given preference. To learn more, visit apcentral.collegeboard.com/
apgrants.
246